mirror of
https://github.com/wiidev/usbloadergx.git
synced 2024-11-17 16:59:17 +01:00
Support newer versions of devkitPPC
This commit is contained in:
parent
c1e8ea5ca8
commit
e25c4e25f0
19
Makefile
19
Makefile
@ -78,13 +78,14 @@ endif
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# any extra libraries we wish to link with the project
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
LIBS := -lwolfssl -lcustomfat -lcustomntfs -lcustomext2fs -lvorbisidec -lmad -lfreetype \
|
||||
-lgd -ljpeg -lpng -lzip -lm -lz -lwiiuse -lwiidrc -lbte -lasnd -logc -lruntimeiospatch
|
||||
LIBS := -lwolfssl -lcustomfat -lcustomntfs -lcustomext2fs -lvorbisidec -logg \
|
||||
-lmad -lfreetype -lgd -ljpeg -lpng -lzip -lm -lz -lwiiuse -lwiidrc \
|
||||
-lbte -lasnd -logc -lruntimeiospatch
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# list of directories containing libraries, this must be the top level containing
|
||||
# include and lib
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
LIBDIRS := $(DEVKITPPC)/lib $(CURDIR)
|
||||
LIBDIRS := $(CURDIR)/portlibs
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# no real need to edit anything past this point unless you need to add additional
|
||||
# rules for different file extensions
|
||||
@ -139,17 +140,15 @@ export OFILES := $(CPPFILES:.cpp=.o) $(CFILES:.c=.o) \
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
export INCLUDE := $(foreach dir,$(INCLUDES),-I$(CURDIR)/$(dir)) \
|
||||
$(foreach dir,$(LIBDIRS),-I$(dir)/include) \
|
||||
-I$(CURDIR)/$(BUILD) -I$(LIBOGC_INC) \
|
||||
-I$(PORTLIBS)/include -I$(PORTLIBS)/include/freetype2
|
||||
-I$(CURDIR)/$(BUILD) -I$(LIBOGC_INC)
|
||||
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
# build a list of library paths
|
||||
#---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
||||
export LIBPATHS := $(foreach dir,$(LIBDIRS),-L$(dir)/lib) -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libfat/ \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libntfs/ -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libext2fs/ \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libruntimeiospatch/ -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libdrc/ \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libwolfssl/ \
|
||||
-L$(LIBOGC_LIB) -L$(PORTLIBS)/lib
|
||||
export LIBPATHS := $(foreach dir,$(LIBDIRS),-L$(dir)/lib) -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libdrc/ \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libext2fs -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libfat \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libntfs -L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libruntimeiospatch \
|
||||
-L$(CURDIR)/source/libs/libwolfssl -L$(LIBOGC_LIB)
|
||||
|
||||
export OUTPUT := $(CURDIR)/$(TARGET)
|
||||
.PHONY: $(BUILD) lang all clean
|
||||
|
10
gitver.sh
10
gitver.sh
@ -1,5 +1,13 @@
|
||||
#! /bin/bash
|
||||
commit_id=$(git rev-parse --short=7 HEAD 2>/dev/null)
|
||||
|
||||
# Correct the path on Windows so that git works correctly
|
||||
if [[ $(uname -s) == MSYS* ]]; then
|
||||
winpath=$(cmd //c REG QUERY "HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\SYSTEM\CurrentControlSet\Control\Session Manager\Environment" -v PATH | grep '^ PATH'| sed 's/ PATH REG_SZ //')
|
||||
winpath=$(echo /$winpath | sed 's/://g' | sed -e 's/;/:\//g' | sed 's/\\/\//g' | sed 's/:\/$//')
|
||||
PATH=$PATH:$winpath
|
||||
fi
|
||||
|
||||
commit_id=$(git rev-parse HEAD 2>/dev/null | head -c 7)
|
||||
[ -z "$commit_id" ] && commit_id="0000001"
|
||||
commit_message=$(git show -s --format="%<(52,trunc)%s" $commit_id 2>/dev/null | sed -e 's/[[:space:]]*$//')
|
||||
[ -z "$commit_message" ] && commit_message="unable to get the commit message"
|
||||
|
477
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftconfig.h
Normal file
477
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftconfig.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,477 @@
|
||||
/* ftconfig.h. Generated from ftconfig.in by configure. */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftconfig.in */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* UNIX-specific configuration file (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This header file contains a number of macro definitions that are used */
|
||||
/* by the rest of the engine. Most of the macros here are automatically */
|
||||
/* determined at compile time, and you should not need to change it to */
|
||||
/* port FreeType, except to compile the library with a non-ANSI */
|
||||
/* compiler. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note however that if some specific modifications are needed, we */
|
||||
/* advise you to place a modified copy in your build directory. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The build directory is usually `freetype/builds/<system>', and */
|
||||
/* contains system-specific files that are always included first when */
|
||||
/* building the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTCONFIG_H__
|
||||
#define __FTCONFIG_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H
|
||||
#include FT_CONFIG_STANDARD_LIBRARY_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* PLATFORM-SPECIFIC CONFIGURATION MACROS */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* These macros can be toggled to suit a specific system. The current */
|
||||
/* ones are defaults used to compile FreeType in an ANSI C environment */
|
||||
/* (16bit compilers are also supported). Copy this file to your own */
|
||||
/* `freetype/builds/<system>' directory, and edit it to port the engine. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define HAVE_UNISTD_H 1
|
||||
#define HAVE_FCNTL_H 1
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDINT_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* There are systems (like the Texas Instruments 'C54x) where a `char' */
|
||||
/* has 16 bits. ANSI C says that sizeof(char) is always 1. Since an */
|
||||
/* `int' has 16 bits also for this system, sizeof(int) gives 1 which */
|
||||
/* is probably unexpected. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* `CHAR_BIT' (defined in limits.h) gives the number of bits in a */
|
||||
/* `char' type. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CHAR_BIT
|
||||
#define FT_CHAR_BIT CHAR_BIT
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* #undef FT_USE_AUTOCONF_SIZEOF_TYPES */
|
||||
#ifdef FT_USE_AUTOCONF_SIZEOF_TYPES
|
||||
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_INT 4
|
||||
#define SIZEOF_LONG 4
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_INT SIZEOF_INT
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_LONG SIZEOF_LONG
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* !FT_USE_AUTOCONF_SIZEOF_TYPES */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Following cpp computation of the bit length of int and long */
|
||||
/* is copied from default include/freetype/config/ftconfig.h. */
|
||||
/* If any improvement is required for this file, it should be */
|
||||
/* applied to the original header file for the builders that */
|
||||
/* does not use configure script. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of an `int' type. */
|
||||
#if FT_UINT_MAX == 0xFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_INT (16 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#elif FT_UINT_MAX == 0xFFFFFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_INT (32 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#elif FT_UINT_MAX > 0xFFFFFFFFUL && FT_UINT_MAX == 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_INT (64 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#error "Unsupported size of `int' type!"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The size of a `long' type. A five-byte `long' (as used e.g. on the */
|
||||
/* DM642) is recognized but avoided. */
|
||||
#if FT_ULONG_MAX == 0xFFFFFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_LONG (32 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#elif FT_ULONG_MAX > 0xFFFFFFFFUL && FT_ULONG_MAX == 0xFFFFFFFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_LONG (32 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#elif FT_ULONG_MAX > 0xFFFFFFFFUL && FT_ULONG_MAX == 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFUL
|
||||
#define FT_SIZEOF_LONG (64 / FT_CHAR_BIT)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#error "Unsupported size of `long' type!"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_USE_AUTOCONF_SIZEOF_TYPES */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Preferred alignment of data */
|
||||
#define FT_ALIGNMENT 8
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* FT_UNUSED is a macro used to indicate that a given parameter is not */
|
||||
/* used -- this is only used to get rid of unpleasant compiler warnings */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_UNUSED
|
||||
#define FT_UNUSED( arg ) ( (arg) = (arg) )
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* AUTOMATIC CONFIGURATION MACROS */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* These macros are computed from the ones defined above. Don't touch */
|
||||
/* their definition, unless you know precisely what you are doing. No */
|
||||
/* porter should need to mess with them. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Mac support */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This is the only necessary change, so it is defined here instead */
|
||||
/* providing a new configuration file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#if ( defined( __APPLE__ ) && !defined( DARWIN_NO_CARBON ) ) || \
|
||||
( defined( __MWERKS__ ) && defined( macintosh ) )
|
||||
/* no Carbon frameworks for 64bit 10.4.x */
|
||||
#include "AvailabilityMacros.h"
|
||||
#if defined( __LP64__ ) && \
|
||||
( MAC_OS_X_VERSION_MIN_REQUIRED <= MAC_OS_X_VERSION_10_4 )
|
||||
#define DARWIN_NO_CARBON 1
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_MACINTOSH 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( __SC__ ) || defined( __MRC__ )
|
||||
/* Classic MacOS compilers */
|
||||
#include "ConditionalMacros.h"
|
||||
#if TARGET_OS_MAC
|
||||
#define FT_MACINTOSH 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Fix compiler warning with sgi compiler */
|
||||
#if defined( __sgi ) && !defined( __GNUC__ )
|
||||
#if defined( _COMPILER_VERSION ) && ( _COMPILER_VERSION >= 730 )
|
||||
#pragma set woff 3505
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* IntN types */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Used to guarantee the size of some specific integers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed short FT_Int16;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short FT_UInt16;
|
||||
|
||||
#if FT_SIZEOF_INT == 4
|
||||
|
||||
typedef signed int FT_Int32;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int FT_UInt32;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif FT_SIZEOF_LONG == 4
|
||||
|
||||
typedef signed long FT_Int32;
|
||||
typedef unsigned long FT_UInt32;
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#error "no 32bit type found -- please check your configuration files"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* look up an integer type that is at least 32 bits */
|
||||
#if FT_SIZEOF_INT >= 4
|
||||
|
||||
typedef int FT_Fast;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int FT_UFast;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif FT_SIZEOF_LONG >= 4
|
||||
|
||||
typedef long FT_Fast;
|
||||
typedef unsigned long FT_UFast;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* determine whether we have a 64-bit int type for platforms without */
|
||||
/* Autoconf */
|
||||
#if FT_SIZEOF_LONG == 8
|
||||
|
||||
/* FT_LONG64 must be defined if a 64-bit type is available */
|
||||
#define FT_LONG64
|
||||
#define FT_INT64 long
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( _MSC_VER ) && _MSC_VER >= 900 /* Visual C++ (and Intel C++) */
|
||||
|
||||
/* this compiler provides the __int64 type */
|
||||
#define FT_LONG64
|
||||
#define FT_INT64 __int64
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( __BORLANDC__ ) /* Borland C++ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* XXXX: We should probably check the value of __BORLANDC__ in order */
|
||||
/* to test the compiler version. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* this compiler provides the __int64 type */
|
||||
#define FT_LONG64
|
||||
#define FT_INT64 __int64
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( __WATCOMC__ ) /* Watcom C++ */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Watcom doesn't provide 64-bit data types */
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( __MWERKS__ ) /* Metrowerks CodeWarrior */
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_LONG64
|
||||
#define FT_INT64 long long int
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined( __GNUC__ )
|
||||
|
||||
/* GCC provides the `long long' type */
|
||||
#define FT_LONG64
|
||||
#define FT_INT64 long long int
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* FT_SIZEOF_LONG == 8 */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* A 64-bit data type will create compilation problems if you compile */
|
||||
/* in strict ANSI mode. To avoid them, we disable its use if __STDC__ */
|
||||
/* is defined. You can however ignore this rule by defining the */
|
||||
/* FT_CONFIG_OPTION_FORCE_INT64 configuration macro. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#if defined( FT_LONG64 ) && !defined( FT_CONFIG_OPTION_FORCE_INT64 )
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __STDC__
|
||||
|
||||
/* Undefine the 64-bit macros in strict ANSI compilation mode. */
|
||||
/* Since `#undef' doesn't survive in configuration header files */
|
||||
/* we use the postprocessing facility of AC_CONFIG_HEADERS to */
|
||||
/* replace the leading `/' with `#'. */
|
||||
#undef FT_LONG64
|
||||
#undef FT_INT64
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __STDC__ */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* FT_LONG64 && !FT_CONFIG_OPTION_FORCE_INT64 */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_BEGIN_STMNT do {
|
||||
#define FT_END_STMNT } while ( 0 )
|
||||
#define FT_DUMMY_STMNT FT_BEGIN_STMNT FT_END_STMNT
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_NO_ASSEMBLER
|
||||
/* Provide assembler fragments for performance-critical functions. */
|
||||
/* These must be defined `static __inline__' with GCC. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __GNUC__
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined( __arm__ ) && !defined( __thumb__ )
|
||||
#define FT_MULFIX_ASSEMBLER FT_MulFix_arm
|
||||
|
||||
static __inline__ FT_Int32
|
||||
FT_MulFix_arm( FT_Int32 a,
|
||||
FT_Int32 b )
|
||||
{
|
||||
register FT_Int32 t, t2;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
__asm__ __volatile__ (
|
||||
"smull %1, %2, %4, %3\n\t" /* (lo=%1,hi=%2) = a*b */
|
||||
"mov %0, %2, asr #31\n\t" /* %0 = (hi >> 31) */
|
||||
"add %0, %0, #0x8000\n\t" /* %0 += 0x8000 */
|
||||
"adds %1, %1, %0\n\t" /* %1 += %0 */
|
||||
"adc %2, %2, #0\n\t" /* %2 += carry */
|
||||
"mov %0, %1, lsr #16\n\t" /* %0 = %1 >> 16 */
|
||||
"orr %0, %0, %2, lsl #16\n\t" /* %0 |= %2 << 16 */
|
||||
: "=r"(a), "=&r"(t2), "=&r"(t)
|
||||
: "r"(a), "r"(b) );
|
||||
return a;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __arm__ && !__thumb__ */
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined( __i386__ )
|
||||
#define FT_MULFIX_ASSEMBLER FT_MulFix_i386
|
||||
|
||||
static __inline__ FT_Int32
|
||||
FT_MulFix_i386( FT_Int32 a,
|
||||
FT_Int32 b )
|
||||
{
|
||||
register FT_Int32 result;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
__asm__ __volatile__ (
|
||||
"imul %%edx\n"
|
||||
"movl %%edx, %%ecx\n"
|
||||
"sarl $31, %%ecx\n"
|
||||
"addl $0x8000, %%ecx\n"
|
||||
"addl %%ecx, %%eax\n"
|
||||
"adcl $0, %%edx\n"
|
||||
"shrl $16, %%eax\n"
|
||||
"shll $16, %%edx\n"
|
||||
"addl %%edx, %%eax\n"
|
||||
: "=a"(result), "+d"(b)
|
||||
: "a"(a)
|
||||
: "%ecx" );
|
||||
return result;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* i386 */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __GNUC__ */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_CONFIG_OPTION_NO_ASSEMBLER */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_INLINE_MULFIX
|
||||
#ifdef FT_MULFIX_ASSEMBLER
|
||||
#define FT_MULFIX_INLINED FT_MULFIX_ASSEMBLER
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_MAKE_OPTION_SINGLE_OBJECT
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL( x ) static x
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL_DEF( x ) static x
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL_DEF( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL( x ) extern x
|
||||
#define FT_LOCAL_DEF( x ) x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* FT_MAKE_OPTION_SINGLE_OBJECT */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_BASE
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_BASE( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_BASE( x ) extern x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_BASE */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_BASE_DEF
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_BASE_DEF( x ) x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_BASE_DEF( x ) x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_BASE_DEF */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_EXPORT
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT( x ) extern x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_EXPORT */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_EXPORT_DEF
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT_DEF( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT_DEF( x ) extern x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_EXPORT_DEF */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_EXPORT_VAR
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT_VAR( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_EXPORT_VAR( x ) extern x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_EXPORT_VAR */
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following macros are needed to compile the library with a */
|
||||
/* C++ compiler and with 16bit compilers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/* This is special. Within C++, you must specify `extern "C"' for */
|
||||
/* functions which are used via function pointers, and you also */
|
||||
/* must do that for structures which contain function pointers to */
|
||||
/* assure C linkage -- it's not possible to have (local) anonymous */
|
||||
/* functions which are accessed by (global) function pointers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_CALLBACK_DEF is used to _define_ a callback function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_CALLBACK_TABLE is used to _declare_ a constant variable that */
|
||||
/* contains pointers to callback functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_CALLBACK_TABLE_DEF is used to _define_ a constant variable */
|
||||
/* that contains pointers to callback functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Some 16bit compilers have to redefine these macros to insert */
|
||||
/* the infamous `_cdecl' or `__fastcall' declarations. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CALLBACK_DEF
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_DEF( x ) extern "C" x
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_DEF( x ) static x
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif /* FT_CALLBACK_DEF */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CALLBACK_TABLE
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_TABLE extern "C"
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_TABLE_DEF extern "C"
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_TABLE extern
|
||||
#define FT_CALLBACK_TABLE_DEF /* nothing */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif /* FT_CALLBACK_TABLE */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTCONFIG_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
780
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftheader.h
Normal file
780
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftheader.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,780 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftheader.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Build macros of the FreeType 2 library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FT_HEADER_H__
|
||||
#define __FT_HEADER_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*@***********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Macro> */
|
||||
/* FT_BEGIN_HEADER */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This macro is used in association with @FT_END_HEADER in header */
|
||||
/* files to ensure that the declarations within are properly */
|
||||
/* encapsulated in an `extern "C" { .. }' block when included from a */
|
||||
/* C++ compiler. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_BEGIN_HEADER extern "C" {
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_BEGIN_HEADER /* nothing */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*@***********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Macro> */
|
||||
/* FT_END_HEADER */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This macro is used in association with @FT_BEGIN_HEADER in header */
|
||||
/* files to ensure that the declarations within are properly */
|
||||
/* encapsulated in an `extern "C" { .. }' block when included from a */
|
||||
/* C++ compiler. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_END_HEADER }
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_END_HEADER /* nothing */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Aliases for the FreeType 2 public and configuration files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* header_file_macros */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Header File Macros */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Macro definitions used to #include specific header files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The following macros are defined to the name of specific */
|
||||
/* FreeType~2 header files. They can be used directly in #include */
|
||||
/* statements as in: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* #include FT_FREETYPE_H */
|
||||
/* #include FT_MULTIPLE_MASTERS_H */
|
||||
/* #include FT_GLYPH_H */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* There are several reasons why we are now using macros to name */
|
||||
/* public header files. The first one is that such macros are not */
|
||||
/* limited to the infamous 8.3~naming rule required by DOS (and */
|
||||
/* `FT_MULTIPLE_MASTERS_H' is a lot more meaningful than `ftmm.h'). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The second reason is that it allows for more flexibility in the */
|
||||
/* way FreeType~2 is installed on a given system. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* configuration files */
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CONFIG_CONFIG_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing
|
||||
* FreeType~2 configuration data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CONFIG_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_CONFIG_H <freetype/config/ftconfig.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CONFIG_STANDARD_LIBRARY_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing
|
||||
* FreeType~2 interface to the standard C library functions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CONFIG_STANDARD_LIBRARY_H
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_STANDARD_LIBRARY_H <freetype/config/ftstdlib.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing
|
||||
* FreeType~2 project-specific configuration options.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H <freetype/config/ftoption.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CONFIG_MODULES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* list of FreeType~2 modules that are statically linked to new library
|
||||
* instances in @FT_Init_FreeType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef FT_CONFIG_MODULES_H
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_MODULES_H <freetype/config/ftmodule.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/* public headers */
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* base FreeType~2 API.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_FREETYPE_H <freetype/freetype.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ERRORS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* list of FreeType~2 error codes (and messages).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is included by @FT_FREETYPE_H.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ERRORS_H <freetype/fterrors.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_MODULE_ERRORS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* list of FreeType~2 module error offsets (and messages).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_ERRORS_H <freetype/ftmoderr.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_SYSTEM_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 interface to low-level operations (i.e., memory management
|
||||
* and stream i/o).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is included by @FT_FREETYPE_H.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_SYSTEM_H <freetype/ftsystem.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_IMAGE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing type
|
||||
* definitions related to glyph images (i.e., bitmaps, outlines,
|
||||
* scan-converter parameters).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is included by @FT_FREETYPE_H.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_IMAGE_H <freetype/ftimage.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TYPES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* basic data types defined by FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is included by @FT_FREETYPE_H.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TYPES_H <freetype/fttypes.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_LIST_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* list management API of FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* (Most applications will never need to include this file.)
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_LIST_H <freetype/ftlist.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_OUTLINE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* scalable outline management API of FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_OUTLINE_H <freetype/ftoutln.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_SIZES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* API which manages multiple @FT_Size objects per face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_SIZES_H <freetype/ftsizes.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_MODULE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* module management API of FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_H <freetype/ftmodapi.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_RENDER_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* renderer module management API of FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_RENDER_H <freetype/ftrender.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TYPE1_TABLES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* types and API specific to the Type~1 format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TYPE1_TABLES_H <freetype/t1tables.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_IDS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* enumeration values which identify name strings, languages, encodings,
|
||||
* etc. This file really contains a _large_ set of constant macro
|
||||
* definitions, taken from the TrueType and OpenType specifications.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TRUETYPE_IDS_H <freetype/ttnameid.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_TABLES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* types and API specific to the TrueType (as well as OpenType) format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TRUETYPE_TABLES_H <freetype/tttables.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_TAGS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of TrueType four-byte `tags' which identify blocks in
|
||||
* SFNT-based font formats (i.e., TrueType and OpenType).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TRUETYPE_TAGS_H <freetype/tttags.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_BDF_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of an API which accesses BDF-specific strings from a
|
||||
* face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_BDF_H <freetype/ftbdf.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CID_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of an API which access CID font information from a
|
||||
* face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CID_H <freetype/ftcid.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_GZIP_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of an API which supports gzip-compressed files.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_GZIP_H <freetype/ftgzip.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_LZW_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of an API which supports LZW-compressed files.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_LZW_H <freetype/ftlzw.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_WINFONTS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* definitions of an API which supports Windows FNT files.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_WINFONTS_H <freetype/ftwinfnt.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_GLYPH_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* API of the optional glyph management component.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_GLYPH_H <freetype/ftglyph.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_BITMAP_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* API of the optional bitmap conversion component.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_BITMAP_H <freetype/ftbitmap.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_BBOX_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* API of the optional exact bounding box computation routines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_BBOX_H <freetype/ftbbox.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CACHE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* API of the optional FreeType~2 cache sub-system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CACHE_IMAGE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* `glyph image' API of the FreeType~2 cache sub-system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is used to define a cache for @FT_Glyph elements. You can also
|
||||
* use the API defined in @FT_CACHE_SMALL_BITMAPS_H if you only need to
|
||||
* store small glyph bitmaps, as it will use less memory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This macro is deprecated. Simply include @FT_CACHE_H to have all
|
||||
* glyph image-related cache declarations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_IMAGE_H FT_CACHE_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CACHE_SMALL_BITMAPS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* `small bitmaps' API of the FreeType~2 cache sub-system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is used to define a cache for small glyph bitmaps in a relatively
|
||||
* memory-efficient way. You can also use the API defined in
|
||||
* @FT_CACHE_IMAGE_H if you want to cache arbitrary glyph images,
|
||||
* including scalable outlines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This macro is deprecated. Simply include @FT_CACHE_H to have all
|
||||
* small bitmaps-related cache declarations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_SMALL_BITMAPS_H FT_CACHE_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_CACHE_CHARMAP_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* `charmap' API of the FreeType~2 cache sub-system.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This macro is deprecated. Simply include @FT_CACHE_H to have all
|
||||
* charmap-based cache declarations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_CHARMAP_H FT_CACHE_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_MAC_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* Macintosh-specific FreeType~2 API. The latter is used to access
|
||||
* fonts embedded in resource forks.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This header file must be explicitly included by client applications
|
||||
* compiled on the Mac (note that the base API still works though).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_MAC_H <freetype/ftmac.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_MULTIPLE_MASTERS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* optional multiple-masters management API of FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_MULTIPLE_MASTERS_H <freetype/ftmm.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_SFNT_NAMES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* optional FreeType~2 API which accesses embedded `name' strings in
|
||||
* SFNT-based font formats (i.e., TrueType and OpenType).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_SFNT_NAMES_H <freetype/ftsnames.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_OPENTYPE_VALIDATE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* optional FreeType~2 API which validates OpenType tables (BASE, GDEF,
|
||||
* GPOS, GSUB, JSTF).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_OPENTYPE_VALIDATE_H <freetype/ftotval.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_GX_VALIDATE_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* optional FreeType~2 API which validates TrueTypeGX/AAT tables (feat,
|
||||
* mort, morx, bsln, just, kern, opbd, trak, prop).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_GX_VALIDATE_H <freetype/ftgxval.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_PFR_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which accesses PFR-specific data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_PFR_H <freetype/ftpfr.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which provides functions to stroke outline paths.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_STROKER_H <freetype/ftstroke.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_SYNTHESIS_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which performs artificial obliquing and emboldening.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_SYNTHESIS_H <freetype/ftsynth.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_XFREE86_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which provides functions specific to the XFree86 and
|
||||
* X.Org X11 servers.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_XFREE86_H <freetype/ftxf86.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_TRIGONOMETRY_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which performs trigonometric computations (e.g.,
|
||||
* cosines and arc tangents).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_TRIGONOMETRY_H <freetype/fttrigon.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which performs color filtering for subpixel rendering.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_LCD_FILTER_H <freetype/ftlcdfil.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_UNPATENTED_HINTING_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which performs color filtering for subpixel rendering.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_UNPATENTED_HINTING_H <freetype/ttunpat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_INCREMENTAL_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which performs color filtering for subpixel rendering.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_INCREMENTAL_H <freetype/ftincrem.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_GASP_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which returns entries from the TrueType GASP table.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_H <freetype/ftgasp.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ADVANCES_H
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A macro used in #include statements to name the file containing the
|
||||
* FreeType~2 API which returns individual and ranged glyph advances.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ADVANCES_H <freetype/ftadvanc.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_ERROR_DEFINITIONS_H <freetype/fterrdef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* The internals of the cache sub-system are no longer exposed. We */
|
||||
/* default to FT_CACHE_H at the moment just in case, but we know of */
|
||||
/* no rogue client that uses them. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_MANAGER_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_MRU_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_MANAGER_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_CACHE_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_GLYPH_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_IMAGE_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
#define FT_CACHE_INTERNAL_SBITS_H <freetype/ftcache.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_INCREMENTAL_H <freetype/ftincrem.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_TRUETYPE_UNPATENTED_H <freetype/ttunpat.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Include internal headers definitions from <freetype/internal/...>
|
||||
* only when building the library.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef FT2_BUILD_LIBRARY
|
||||
#define FT_INTERNAL_INTERNAL_H <freetype/internal/internal.h>
|
||||
#include FT_INTERNAL_INTERNAL_H
|
||||
#endif /* FT2_BUILD_LIBRARY */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FT2_BUILD_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
20
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftmodule.h
Normal file
20
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftmodule.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
|
||||
/* This is a generated file. */
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, tt_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, t1_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, cff_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, t1cid_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, pfr_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, t42_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, winfnt_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, pcf_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Driver_ClassRec, bdf_driver_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Module_Class, sfnt_module_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Module_Class, autofit_module_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Module_Class, pshinter_module_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Renderer_Class, ft_raster1_renderer_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Renderer_Class, ft_smooth_renderer_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Renderer_Class, ft_smooth_lcd_renderer_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Renderer_Class, ft_smooth_lcdv_renderer_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Module_Class, psaux_module_class )
|
||||
FT_USE_MODULE( FT_Module_Class, psnames_module_class )
|
||||
/* EOF */
|
733
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftoption.h
Normal file
733
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftoption.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,733 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftoption.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* User-selectable configuration macros (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, */
|
||||
/* 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTOPTION_H__
|
||||
#define __FTOPTION_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* USER-SELECTABLE CONFIGURATION MACROS */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file contains the default configuration macro definitions for */
|
||||
/* a standard build of the FreeType library. There are three ways to */
|
||||
/* use this file to build project-specific versions of the library: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - You can modify this file by hand, but this is not recommended in */
|
||||
/* cases where you would like to build several versions of the */
|
||||
/* library from a single source directory. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - You can put a copy of this file in your build directory, more */
|
||||
/* precisely in `$BUILD/freetype/config/ftoption.h', where `$BUILD' */
|
||||
/* is the name of a directory that is included _before_ the FreeType */
|
||||
/* include path during compilation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The default FreeType Makefiles and Jamfiles use the build */
|
||||
/* directory `builds/<system>' by default, but you can easily change */
|
||||
/* that for your own projects. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - Copy the file <ft2build.h> to `$BUILD/ft2build.h' and modify it */
|
||||
/* slightly to pre-define the macro FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H used to */
|
||||
/* locate this file during the build. For example, */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTIONS_H <myftoptions.h> */
|
||||
/* #include <freetype/config/ftheader.h> */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* will use `$BUILD/myftoptions.h' instead of this file for macro */
|
||||
/* definitions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note also that you can similarly pre-define the macro */
|
||||
/* FT_CONFIG_MODULES_H used to locate the file listing of the modules */
|
||||
/* that are statically linked to the library at compile time. By */
|
||||
/* default, this file is <freetype/config/ftmodule.h>. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* We highly recommend using the third method whenever possible. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/**** G E N E R A L F R E E T Y P E 2 C O N F I G U R A T I O N ****/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Uncomment the line below if you want to activate sub-pixel rendering */
|
||||
/* (a.k.a. LCD rendering, or ClearType) in this build of the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that this feature is covered by several Microsoft patents */
|
||||
/* and should not be activated in any default build of the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This macro has no impact on the FreeType API, only on its */
|
||||
/* _implementation_. For example, using FT_RENDER_MODE_LCD when calling */
|
||||
/* FT_Render_Glyph still generates a bitmap that is 3 times wider than */
|
||||
/* the original size in case this macro isn't defined; however, each */
|
||||
/* triplet of subpixels has R=G=B. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This is done to allow FreeType clients to run unmodified, forcing */
|
||||
/* them to display normal gray-level anti-aliased glyphs. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SUBPIXEL_RENDERING */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Many compilers provide a non-ANSI 64-bit data type that can be used */
|
||||
/* by FreeType to speed up some computations. However, this will create */
|
||||
/* some problems when compiling the library in strict ANSI mode. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* For this reason, the use of 64-bit integers is normally disabled when */
|
||||
/* the __STDC__ macro is defined. You can however disable this by */
|
||||
/* defining the macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_FORCE_INT64 here. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* For most compilers, this will only create compilation warnings when */
|
||||
/* building the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ObNote: The compiler-specific 64-bit integers are detected in the */
|
||||
/* file `ftconfig.h' either statically or through the */
|
||||
/* `configure' script on supported platforms. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#undef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_FORCE_INT64
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If this macro is defined, do not try to use an assembler version of */
|
||||
/* performance-critical functions (e.g. FT_MulFix). You should only do */
|
||||
/* that to verify that the assembler function works properly, or to */
|
||||
/* execute benchmark tests of the various implementations. */
|
||||
/* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_NO_ASSEMBLER */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If this macro is defined, try to use an inlined assembler version of */
|
||||
/* the `FT_MulFix' function, which is a `hotspot' when loading and */
|
||||
/* hinting glyphs, and which should be executed as fast as possible. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that if your compiler or CPU is not supported, this will default */
|
||||
/* to the standard and portable implementation found in `ftcalc.c'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_INLINE_MULFIX
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* LZW-compressed file support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType now handles font files that have been compressed with the */
|
||||
/* `compress' program. This is mostly used to parse many of the PCF */
|
||||
/* files that come with various X11 distributions. The implementation */
|
||||
/* uses NetBSD's `zopen' to partially uncompress the file on the fly */
|
||||
/* (see src/lzw/ftgzip.c). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define this macro if you want to enable this `feature'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_LZW
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Gzip-compressed file support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType now handles font files that have been compressed with the */
|
||||
/* `gzip' program. This is mostly used to parse many of the PCF files */
|
||||
/* that come with XFree86. The implementation uses `zlib' to */
|
||||
/* partially uncompress the file on the fly (see src/gzip/ftgzip.c). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define this macro if you want to enable this `feature'. See also */
|
||||
/* the macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SYSTEM_ZLIB below. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_ZLIB
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ZLib library selection */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This macro is only used when FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_ZLIB is defined. */
|
||||
/* It allows FreeType's `ftgzip' component to link to the system's */
|
||||
/* installation of the ZLib library. This is useful on systems like */
|
||||
/* Unix or VMS where it generally is already available. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If you let it undefined, the component will use its own copy */
|
||||
/* of the zlib sources instead. These have been modified to be */
|
||||
/* included directly within the component and *not* export external */
|
||||
/* function names. This allows you to link any program with FreeType */
|
||||
/* _and_ ZLib without linking conflicts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Do not #undef this macro here since the build system might define */
|
||||
/* it for certain configurations only. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SYSTEM_ZLIB */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* DLL export compilation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* When compiling FreeType as a DLL, some systems/compilers need a */
|
||||
/* special keyword in front OR after the return type of function */
|
||||
/* declarations. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Two macros are used within the FreeType source code to define */
|
||||
/* exported library functions: FT_EXPORT and FT_EXPORT_DEF. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_EXPORT( return_type ) */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* is used in a function declaration, as in */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_EXPORT( FT_Error ) */
|
||||
/* FT_Init_FreeType( FT_Library* alibrary ); */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_EXPORT_DEF( return_type ) */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* is used in a function definition, as in */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_EXPORT_DEF( FT_Error ) */
|
||||
/* FT_Init_FreeType( FT_Library* alibrary ) */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* ... some code ... */
|
||||
/* return FT_Err_Ok; */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You can provide your own implementation of FT_EXPORT and */
|
||||
/* FT_EXPORT_DEF here if you want. If you leave them undefined, they */
|
||||
/* will be later automatically defined as `extern return_type' to */
|
||||
/* allow normal compilation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Do not #undef these macros here since the build system might define */
|
||||
/* them for certain configurations only. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_EXPORT(x) extern x */
|
||||
/* #define FT_EXPORT_DEF(x) x */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Glyph Postscript Names handling */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* By default, FreeType 2 is compiled with the `psnames' module. This */
|
||||
/* module is in charge of converting a glyph name string into a */
|
||||
/* Unicode value, or return a Macintosh standard glyph name for the */
|
||||
/* use with the TrueType `post' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Undefine this macro if you do not want `psnames' compiled in your */
|
||||
/* build of FreeType. This has the following effects: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - The TrueType driver will provide its own set of glyph names, */
|
||||
/* if you build it to support postscript names in the TrueType */
|
||||
/* `post' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - The Type 1 driver will not be able to synthesize a Unicode */
|
||||
/* charmap out of the glyphs found in the fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You would normally undefine this configuration macro when building */
|
||||
/* a version of FreeType that doesn't contain a Type 1 or CFF driver. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_POSTSCRIPT_NAMES
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Postscript Names to Unicode Values support */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* By default, FreeType 2 is built with the `PSNames' module compiled */
|
||||
/* in. Among other things, the module is used to convert a glyph name */
|
||||
/* into a Unicode value. This is especially useful in order to */
|
||||
/* synthesize on the fly a Unicode charmap from the CFF/Type 1 driver */
|
||||
/* through a big table named the `Adobe Glyph List' (AGL). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Undefine this macro if you do not want the Adobe Glyph List */
|
||||
/* compiled in your `PSNames' module. The Type 1 driver will not be */
|
||||
/* able to synthesize a Unicode charmap out of the glyphs found in the */
|
||||
/* fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_ADOBE_GLYPH_LIST
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Support for Mac fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define this macro if you want support for outline fonts in Mac */
|
||||
/* format (mac dfont, mac resource, macbinary containing a mac */
|
||||
/* resource) on non-Mac platforms. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that the `FOND' resource isn't checked. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_MAC_FONTS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Guessing methods to access embedded resource forks */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Enable extra Mac fonts support on non-Mac platforms (e.g. */
|
||||
/* GNU/Linux). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Resource forks which include fonts data are stored sometimes in */
|
||||
/* locations which users or developers don't expected. In some cases, */
|
||||
/* resource forks start with some offset from the head of a file. In */
|
||||
/* other cases, the actual resource fork is stored in file different */
|
||||
/* from what the user specifies. If this option is activated, */
|
||||
/* FreeType tries to guess whether such offsets or different file */
|
||||
/* names must be used. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that normal, direct access of resource forks is controlled via */
|
||||
/* the FT_CONFIG_OPTION_MAC_FONTS option. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifdef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_MAC_FONTS
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_GUESSING_EMBEDDED_RFORK
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Allow the use of FT_Incremental_Interface to load typefaces that */
|
||||
/* contain no glyph data, but supply it via a callback function. */
|
||||
/* This is required by clients supporting document formats which */
|
||||
/* supply font data incrementally as the document is parsed, such */
|
||||
/* as the Ghostscript interpreter for the PostScript language. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_INCREMENTAL
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The size in bytes of the render pool used by the scan-line converter */
|
||||
/* to do all of its work. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This must be greater than 4KByte if you use FreeType to rasterize */
|
||||
/* glyphs; otherwise, you may set it to zero to avoid unnecessary */
|
||||
/* allocation of the render pool. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_RENDER_POOL_SIZE 16384L
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_MAX_MODULES */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The maximum number of modules that can be registered in a single */
|
||||
/* FreeType library object. 32 is the default. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_MAX_MODULES 32
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Debug level */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType can be compiled in debug or trace mode. In debug mode, */
|
||||
/* errors are reported through the `ftdebug' component. In trace */
|
||||
/* mode, additional messages are sent to the standard output during */
|
||||
/* execution. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_ERROR to build the library in debug mode. */
|
||||
/* Define FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_TRACE to build it in trace mode. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Don't define any of these macros to compile in `release' mode! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Do not #undef these macros here since the build system might define */
|
||||
/* them for certain configurations only. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_ERROR */
|
||||
/* #define FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_TRACE */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Memory Debugging */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType now comes with an integrated memory debugger that is */
|
||||
/* capable of detecting simple errors like memory leaks or double */
|
||||
/* deletes. To compile it within your build of the library, you */
|
||||
/* should define FT_DEBUG_MEMORY here. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that the memory debugger is only activated at runtime when */
|
||||
/* when the _environment_ variable `FT2_DEBUG_MEMORY' is defined also! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Do not #undef this macro here since the build system might define */
|
||||
/* it for certain configurations only. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_DEBUG_MEMORY */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Module errors */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If this macro is set (which is _not_ the default), the higher byte */
|
||||
/* of an error code gives the module in which the error has occurred, */
|
||||
/* while the lower byte is the real error code. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Setting this macro makes sense for debugging purposes only, since */
|
||||
/* it would break source compatibility of certain programs that use */
|
||||
/* FreeType 2. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* More details can be found in the files ftmoderr.h and fterrors.h. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#undef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Position Independent Code */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If this macro is set (which is _not_ the default), FreeType2 will */
|
||||
/* avoid creating constants that require address fixups. Instead the */
|
||||
/* constants will be moved into a struct and additional intialization */
|
||||
/* code will be used. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Setting this macro is needed for systems that prohibit address */
|
||||
/* fixups, such as BREW. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_PIC */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/**** S F N T D R I V E R C O N F I G U R A T I O N ****/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_EMBEDDED_BITMAPS if you want to support */
|
||||
/* embedded bitmaps in all formats using the SFNT module (namely */
|
||||
/* TrueType & OpenType). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_EMBEDDED_BITMAPS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_POSTSCRIPT_NAMES if you want to be able to */
|
||||
/* load and enumerate the glyph Postscript names in a TrueType or */
|
||||
/* OpenType file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that when you do not compile the `PSNames' module by undefining */
|
||||
/* the above FT_CONFIG_OPTION_POSTSCRIPT_NAMES, the `sfnt' module will */
|
||||
/* contain additional code used to read the PS Names table from a font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* (By default, the module uses `PSNames' to extract glyph names.) */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_POSTSCRIPT_NAMES
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_SFNT_NAMES if your applications need to */
|
||||
/* access the internal name table in a SFNT-based format like TrueType */
|
||||
/* or OpenType. The name table contains various strings used to */
|
||||
/* describe the font, like family name, copyright, version, etc. It */
|
||||
/* does not contain any glyph name though. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Accessing SFNT names is done through the functions declared in */
|
||||
/* `freetype/ftsnames.h'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_SFNT_NAMES
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* TrueType CMap support */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Here you can fine-tune which TrueType CMap table format shall be */
|
||||
/* supported. */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_0
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_2
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_4
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_6
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_8
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_10
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_12
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_13
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_CMAP_FORMAT_14
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/**** T R U E T Y P E D R I V E R C O N F I G U R A T I O N ****/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER if you want to compile */
|
||||
/* a bytecode interpreter in the TrueType driver. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* By undefining this, you will only compile the code necessary to load */
|
||||
/* TrueType glyphs without hinting. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Do not #undef this macro here, since the build system might */
|
||||
/* define it for certain configurations only. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If you define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING, a special version */
|
||||
/* of the TrueType bytecode interpreter is used that doesn't implement */
|
||||
/* any of the patented opcodes and algorithms. The patents related to */
|
||||
/* TrueType hinting have expired worldwide since May 2010; this option */
|
||||
/* is now deprecated. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that the TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING macro is *ignored* */
|
||||
/* if you define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER; in other words, */
|
||||
/* either define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER or */
|
||||
/* TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING but not both at the same time. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This macro is only useful for a small number of font files (mostly */
|
||||
/* for Asian scripts) that require bytecode interpretation to properly */
|
||||
/* load glyphs. For all other fonts, this produces unpleasant results, */
|
||||
/* thus the unpatented interpreter is never used to load glyphs from */
|
||||
/* TrueType fonts unless one of the following two options is used. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - The unpatented interpreter is explicitly activated by the user */
|
||||
/* through the FT_PARAM_TAG_UNPATENTED_HINTING parameter tag */
|
||||
/* when opening the FT_Face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - FreeType detects that the FT_Face corresponds to one of the */
|
||||
/* `trick' fonts (e.g., `Mingliu') it knows about. The font engine */
|
||||
/* contains a hard-coded list of font names and other matching */
|
||||
/* parameters (see function `tt_face_init' in file */
|
||||
/* `src/truetype/ttobjs.c'). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Here a sample code snippet for using FT_PARAM_TAG_UNPATENTED_HINTING. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* FT_Parameter parameter; */
|
||||
/* FT_Open_Args open_args; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* parameter.tag = FT_PARAM_TAG_UNPATENTED_HINTING; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* open_args.flags = FT_OPEN_PATHNAME | FT_OPEN_PARAMS; */
|
||||
/* open_args.pathname = my_font_pathname; */
|
||||
/* open_args.num_params = 1; */
|
||||
/* open_args.params = ¶meter; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* error = FT_Open_Face( library, &open_args, index, &face ); */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_INTERPRETER_SWITCH to compile the TrueType */
|
||||
/* bytecode interpreter with a huge switch statement, rather than a call */
|
||||
/* table. This results in smaller and faster code for a number of */
|
||||
/* architectures. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note however that on some compiler/processor combinations, undefining */
|
||||
/* this macro will generate faster, though larger, code. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_INTERPRETER_SWITCH
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_COMPONENT_OFFSET_SCALED to compile the */
|
||||
/* TrueType glyph loader to use Apple's definition of how to handle */
|
||||
/* component offsets in composite glyphs. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Apple and MS disagree on the default behavior of component offsets */
|
||||
/* in composites. Apple says that they should be scaled by the scaling */
|
||||
/* factors in the transformation matrix (roughly, it's more complex) */
|
||||
/* while MS says they should not. OpenType defines two bits in the */
|
||||
/* composite flags array which can be used to disambiguate, but old */
|
||||
/* fonts will not have them. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* http://partners.adobe.com/asn/developer/opentype/glyf.html */
|
||||
/* http://fonts.apple.com/TTRefMan/RM06/Chap6glyf.html */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#undef TT_CONFIG_OPTION_COMPONENT_OFFSET_SCALED
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_GX_VAR_SUPPORT if you want to include */
|
||||
/* support for Apple's distortable font technology (fvar, gvar, cvar, */
|
||||
/* and avar tables). This has many similarities to Type 1 Multiple */
|
||||
/* Masters support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_GX_VAR_SUPPORT
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BDF if you want to include support for */
|
||||
/* an embedded `BDF ' table within SFNT-based bitmap formats. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BDF
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/**** T Y P E 1 D R I V E R C O N F I G U R A T I O N ****/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* T1_MAX_DICT_DEPTH is the maximal depth of nest dictionaries and */
|
||||
/* arrays in the Type 1 stream (see t1load.c). A minimum of 4 is */
|
||||
/* required. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_DICT_DEPTH 5
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* T1_MAX_SUBRS_CALLS details the maximum number of nested sub-routine */
|
||||
/* calls during glyph loading. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_SUBRS_CALLS 16
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* T1_MAX_CHARSTRING_OPERANDS is the charstring stack's capacity. A */
|
||||
/* minimum of 16 is required. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The Chinese font MingTiEG-Medium (CNS 11643 character set) needs 256. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_CHARSTRINGS_OPERANDS 256
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define this configuration macro if you want to prevent the */
|
||||
/* compilation of `t1afm', which is in charge of reading Type 1 AFM */
|
||||
/* files into an existing face. Note that if set, the T1 driver will be */
|
||||
/* unable to produce kerning distances. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#undef T1_CONFIG_OPTION_NO_AFM
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Define this configuration macro if you want to prevent the */
|
||||
/* compilation of the Multiple Masters font support in the Type 1 */
|
||||
/* driver. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#undef T1_CONFIG_OPTION_NO_MM_SUPPORT
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/**** A U T O F I T M O D U L E C O N F I G U R A T I O N ****/
|
||||
/**** ****/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Compile autofit module with CJK (Chinese, Japanese, Korean) script */
|
||||
/* support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define AF_CONFIG_OPTION_CJK
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Compile autofit module with Indic script support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define AF_CONFIG_OPTION_INDIC
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Define this variable if you want to keep the layout of internal
|
||||
* structures that was used prior to FreeType 2.2. This also compiles in
|
||||
* a few obsolete functions to avoid linking problems on typical Unix
|
||||
* distributions.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* For embedded systems or building a new distribution from scratch, it
|
||||
* is recommended to disable the macro since it reduces the library's code
|
||||
* size and activates a few memory-saving optimizations as well.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_OLD_INTERNALS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* To detect legacy cache-lookup call from a rogue client (<= 2.1.7),
|
||||
* we restrict the number of charmaps in a font. The current API of
|
||||
* FTC_CMapCache_Lookup() takes cmap_index & charcode, but old API
|
||||
* takes charcode only. To determine the passed value is for cmap_index
|
||||
* or charcode, the possible cmap_index is restricted not to exceed
|
||||
* the minimum possible charcode by a rogue client. It is also very
|
||||
* unlikely that a rogue client is interested in Unicode values 0 to 15.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* NOTE: The original threshold was 4 deduced from popular number of
|
||||
* cmap subtables in UCS-4 TrueType fonts, but now it is not
|
||||
* irregular for OpenType fonts to have more than 4 subtables,
|
||||
* because variation selector subtables are available for Apple
|
||||
* and Microsoft platforms.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_OLD_INTERNALS
|
||||
#define FT_MAX_CHARMAP_CACHEABLE 15
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* This macro is defined if either unpatented or native TrueType
|
||||
* hinting is requested by the definitions above.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef TT_CONFIG_OPTION_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER
|
||||
#define TT_USE_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER
|
||||
#undef TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING
|
||||
#elif defined TT_CONFIG_OPTION_UNPATENTED_HINTING
|
||||
#define TT_USE_BYTECODE_INTERPRETER
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTOPTION_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
173
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftstdlib.h
Normal file
173
portlibs/include/freetype/config/ftstdlib.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,173 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftstdlib.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ANSI-specific library and header configuration file (specification */
|
||||
/* only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is used to group all #includes to the ANSI C library that */
|
||||
/* FreeType normally requires. It also defines macros to rename the */
|
||||
/* standard functions within the FreeType source code. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Load a file which defines __FTSTDLIB_H__ before this one to override */
|
||||
/* it. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTSTDLIB_H__
|
||||
#define __FTSTDLIB_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_ptrdiff_t ptrdiff_t
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* integer limits */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* UINT_MAX and ULONG_MAX are used to automatically compute the size */
|
||||
/* of `int' and `long' in bytes at compile-time. So far, this works */
|
||||
/* for all platforms the library has been tested on. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that on the extremely rare platforms that do not provide */
|
||||
/* integer types that are _exactly_ 16 and 32 bits wide (e.g. some */
|
||||
/* old Crays where `int' is 36 bits), we do not make any guarantee */
|
||||
/* about the correct behaviour of FT2 with all fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* In these case, `ftconfig.h' will refuse to compile anyway with a */
|
||||
/* message like `couldn't find 32-bit type' or something similar. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <limits.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_CHAR_BIT CHAR_BIT
|
||||
#define FT_INT_MAX INT_MAX
|
||||
#define FT_INT_MIN INT_MIN
|
||||
#define FT_UINT_MAX UINT_MAX
|
||||
#define FT_ULONG_MAX ULONG_MAX
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* character and string processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_memchr memchr
|
||||
#define ft_memcmp memcmp
|
||||
#define ft_memcpy memcpy
|
||||
#define ft_memmove memmove
|
||||
#define ft_memset memset
|
||||
#define ft_strcat strcat
|
||||
#define ft_strcmp strcmp
|
||||
#define ft_strcpy strcpy
|
||||
#define ft_strlen strlen
|
||||
#define ft_strncmp strncmp
|
||||
#define ft_strncpy strncpy
|
||||
#define ft_strrchr strrchr
|
||||
#define ft_strstr strstr
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* file handling */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_FILE FILE
|
||||
#define ft_fclose fclose
|
||||
#define ft_fopen fopen
|
||||
#define ft_fread fread
|
||||
#define ft_fseek fseek
|
||||
#define ft_ftell ftell
|
||||
#define ft_sprintf sprintf
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* sorting */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdlib.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_qsort qsort
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* memory allocation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_scalloc calloc
|
||||
#define ft_sfree free
|
||||
#define ft_smalloc malloc
|
||||
#define ft_srealloc realloc
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* miscellaneous */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_atol atol
|
||||
#define ft_labs labs
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* execution control */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/**********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <setjmp.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_jmp_buf jmp_buf /* note: this cannot be a typedef since */
|
||||
/* jmp_buf is defined as a macro */
|
||||
/* on certain platforms */
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_longjmp longjmp
|
||||
#define ft_setjmp( b ) setjmp( *(jmp_buf*) &(b) ) /* same thing here */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* the following is only used for debugging purposes, i.e., if */
|
||||
/* FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_ERROR or FT_DEBUG_LEVEL_TRACE are defined */
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdarg.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTSTDLIB_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
3919
portlibs/include/freetype/freetype.h
Normal file
3919
portlibs/include/freetype/freetype.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
179
portlibs/include/freetype/ftadvanc.h
Normal file
179
portlibs/include/freetype/ftadvanc.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,179 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftadvanc.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Quick computation of advance widths (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTADVANC_H__
|
||||
#define __FTADVANC_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* quick_advance
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* Quick retrieval of advance values
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* Retrieve horizontal and vertical advance values without processing
|
||||
* glyph outlines, if possible.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This section contains functions to quickly extract advance values
|
||||
* without handling glyph outlines, if possible.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Const> */
|
||||
/* FT_ADVANCE_FLAG_FAST_ONLY */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A bit-flag to be OR-ed with the `flags' parameter of the */
|
||||
/* @FT_Get_Advance and @FT_Get_Advances functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If set, it indicates that you want these functions to fail if the */
|
||||
/* corresponding hinting mode or font driver doesn't allow for very */
|
||||
/* quick advance computation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Typically, glyphs which are either unscaled, unhinted, bitmapped, */
|
||||
/* or light-hinted can have their advance width computed very */
|
||||
/* quickly. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Normal and bytecode hinted modes, which require loading, scaling, */
|
||||
/* and hinting of the glyph outline, are extremely slow by */
|
||||
/* comparison. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_ADVANCE_FLAG_FAST_ONLY 0x20000000UL
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Advance */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the advance value of a given glyph outline in an */
|
||||
/* @FT_Face. By default, the unhinted advance is returned in font */
|
||||
/* units. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: The source @FT_Face handle. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* gindex :: The glyph index. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* load_flags :: A set of bit flags similar to those used when */
|
||||
/* calling @FT_Load_Glyph, used to determine what kind */
|
||||
/* of advances you need. */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* padvance :: The advance value, in either font units or 16.16 */
|
||||
/* format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If @FT_LOAD_VERTICAL_LAYOUT is set, this is the */
|
||||
/* vertical advance corresponding to a vertical layout. */
|
||||
/* Otherwise, it is the horizontal advance in a */
|
||||
/* horizontal layout. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0 means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function may fail if you use @FT_ADVANCE_FLAG_FAST_ONLY and */
|
||||
/* if the corresponding font backend doesn't have a quick way to */
|
||||
/* retrieve the advances. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* A scaled advance is returned in 16.16 format but isn't transformed */
|
||||
/* by the affine transformation specified by @FT_Set_Transform. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_Advance( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt gindex,
|
||||
FT_Int32 load_flags,
|
||||
FT_Fixed *padvance );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Advances */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the advance values of several glyph outlines in an */
|
||||
/* @FT_Face. By default, the unhinted advances are returned in font */
|
||||
/* units. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: The source @FT_Face handle. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* start :: The first glyph index. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* count :: The number of advance values you want to retrieve. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* load_flags :: A set of bit flags similar to those used when */
|
||||
/* calling @FT_Load_Glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* padvance :: The advances, in either font units or 16.16 format. */
|
||||
/* This array must contain at least `count' elements. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If @FT_LOAD_VERTICAL_LAYOUT is set, these are the */
|
||||
/* vertical advances corresponding to a vertical layout. */
|
||||
/* Otherwise, they are the horizontal advances in a */
|
||||
/* horizontal layout. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0 means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function may fail if you use @FT_ADVANCE_FLAG_FAST_ONLY and */
|
||||
/* if the corresponding font backend doesn't have a quick way to */
|
||||
/* retrieve the advances. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Scaled advances are returned in 16.16 format but aren't */
|
||||
/* transformed by the affine transformation specified by */
|
||||
/* @FT_Set_Transform. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_Advances( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt start,
|
||||
FT_UInt count,
|
||||
FT_Int32 load_flags,
|
||||
FT_Fixed *padvances );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTADVANC_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
94
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbbox.h
Normal file
94
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbbox.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,94 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftbbox.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType exact bbox computation (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2003, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This component has a _single_ role: to compute exact outline bounding */
|
||||
/* boxes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It is separated from the rest of the engine for various technical */
|
||||
/* reasons. It may well be integrated in `ftoutln' later. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTBBOX_H__
|
||||
#define __FTBBOX_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* outline_processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_BBox */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Compute the exact bounding box of an outline. This is slower */
|
||||
/* than computing the control box. However, it uses an advanced */
|
||||
/* algorithm which returns _very_ quickly when the two boxes */
|
||||
/* coincide. Otherwise, the outline Bézier arcs are traversed to */
|
||||
/* extract their extrema. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the source outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* abbox :: The outline's exact bounding box. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Get_BBox( FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_BBox *abbox );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTBBOX_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Local Variables: */
|
||||
/* coding: utf-8 */
|
||||
/* End: */
|
209
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbdf.h
Normal file
209
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbdf.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,209 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftbdf.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for accessing BDF-specific strings (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTBDF_H__
|
||||
#define __FTBDF_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* bdf_fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* BDF and PCF Files */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* BDF and PCF specific API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of functions specific to BDF */
|
||||
/* and PCF fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_PropertyType
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of BDF property types.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_NONE ::
|
||||
* Value~0 is used to indicate a missing property.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_ATOM ::
|
||||
* Property is a string atom.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_INTEGER ::
|
||||
* Property is a 32-bit signed integer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_CARDINAL ::
|
||||
* Property is a 32-bit unsigned integer.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum BDF_PropertyType_
|
||||
{
|
||||
BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_NONE = 0,
|
||||
BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_ATOM = 1,
|
||||
BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_INTEGER = 2,
|
||||
BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_CARDINAL = 3
|
||||
|
||||
} BDF_PropertyType;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* BDF_Property
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A handle to a @BDF_PropertyRec structure to model a given
|
||||
* BDF/PCF property.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct BDF_PropertyRec_* BDF_Property;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* BDF_PropertyRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This structure models a given BDF/PCF property.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @fields:
|
||||
* type ::
|
||||
* The property type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* u.atom ::
|
||||
* The atom string, if type is @BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_ATOM.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* u.integer ::
|
||||
* A signed integer, if type is @BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_INTEGER.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* u.cardinal ::
|
||||
* An unsigned integer, if type is @BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_CARDINAL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct BDF_PropertyRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
BDF_PropertyType type;
|
||||
union {
|
||||
const char* atom;
|
||||
FT_Int32 integer;
|
||||
FT_UInt32 cardinal;
|
||||
|
||||
} u;
|
||||
|
||||
} BDF_PropertyRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_BDF_Charset_ID
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve a BDF font character set identity, according to
|
||||
* the BDF specification.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* acharset_encoding ::
|
||||
* Charset encoding, as a C~string, owned by the face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* acharset_registry ::
|
||||
* Charset registry, as a C~string, owned by the face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with BDF faces, returning an error otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_BDF_Charset_ID( FT_Face face,
|
||||
const char* *acharset_encoding,
|
||||
const char* *acharset_registry );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_BDF_Property
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve a BDF property from a BDF or PCF font file.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* name :: The property name.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* aproperty :: The property.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function works with BDF _and_ PCF fonts. It returns an error
|
||||
* otherwise. It also returns an error if the property is not in the
|
||||
* font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A `property' is a either key-value pair within the STARTPROPERTIES
|
||||
* ... ENDPROPERTIES block of a BDF font or a key-value pair from the
|
||||
* `info->props' array within a `FontRec' structure of a PCF font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Integer properties are always stored as `signed' within PCF fonts;
|
||||
* consequently, @BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_CARDINAL is a possible return value
|
||||
* for BDF fonts only.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In case of error, `aproperty->type' is always set to
|
||||
* @BDF_PROPERTY_TYPE_NONE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_BDF_Property( FT_Face face,
|
||||
const char* prop_name,
|
||||
BDF_PropertyRec *aproperty );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTBDF_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
227
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbitmap.h
Normal file
227
portlibs/include/freetype/ftbitmap.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,227 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftbitmap.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType utility functions for bitmaps (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2004, 2005, 2006, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTBITMAP_H__
|
||||
#define __FTBITMAP_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* bitmap_handling */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Bitmap Handling */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Handling FT_Bitmap objects. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains functions for converting FT_Bitmap objects. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap_New */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Initialize a pointer to an @FT_Bitmap structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* abitmap :: A pointer to the bitmap structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Bitmap_New( FT_Bitmap *abitmap );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap_Copy */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Copy a bitmap into another one. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* source :: A handle to the source bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* target :: A handle to the target bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Bitmap_Copy( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const FT_Bitmap *source,
|
||||
FT_Bitmap *target);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap_Embolden */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Embolden a bitmap. The new bitmap will be about `xStrength' */
|
||||
/* pixels wider and `yStrength' pixels higher. The left and bottom */
|
||||
/* borders are kept unchanged. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* xStrength :: How strong the glyph is emboldened horizontally. */
|
||||
/* Expressed in 26.6 pixel format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* yStrength :: How strong the glyph is emboldened vertically. */
|
||||
/* Expressed in 26.6 pixel format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* bitmap :: A handle to the target bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The current implementation restricts `xStrength' to be less than */
|
||||
/* or equal to~8 if bitmap is of pixel_mode @FT_PIXEL_MODE_MONO. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If you want to embolden the bitmap owned by a @FT_GlyphSlotRec, */
|
||||
/* you should call @FT_GlyphSlot_Own_Bitmap on the slot first. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Bitmap_Embolden( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Bitmap* bitmap,
|
||||
FT_Pos xStrength,
|
||||
FT_Pos yStrength );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap_Convert */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Convert a bitmap object with depth 1bpp, 2bpp, 4bpp, or 8bpp to a */
|
||||
/* bitmap object with depth 8bpp, making the number of used bytes per */
|
||||
/* line (a.k.a. the `pitch') a multiple of `alignment'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* source :: The source bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* alignment :: The pitch of the bitmap is a multiple of this */
|
||||
/* parameter. Common values are 1, 2, or 4. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* target :: The target bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* It is possible to call @FT_Bitmap_Convert multiple times without */
|
||||
/* calling @FT_Bitmap_Done (the memory is simply reallocated). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Use @FT_Bitmap_Done to finally remove the bitmap object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The `library' argument is taken to have access to FreeType's */
|
||||
/* memory handling functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Bitmap_Convert( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const FT_Bitmap *source,
|
||||
FT_Bitmap *target,
|
||||
FT_Int alignment );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_GlyphSlot_Own_Bitmap */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Make sure that a glyph slot owns `slot->bitmap'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* slot :: The glyph slot. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function is to be used in combination with */
|
||||
/* @FT_Bitmap_Embolden. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot_Own_Bitmap( FT_GlyphSlot slot );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap_Done */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Destroy a bitmap object created with @FT_Bitmap_New. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* bitmap :: The bitmap object to be freed. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The `library' argument is taken to have access to FreeType's */
|
||||
/* memory handling functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Bitmap_Done( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Bitmap *bitmap );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTBITMAP_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
1125
portlibs/include/freetype/ftcache.h
Normal file
1125
portlibs/include/freetype/ftcache.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
103
portlibs/include/freetype/ftchapters.h
Normal file
103
portlibs/include/freetype/ftchapters.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,103 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file defines the structure of the FreeType reference. */
|
||||
/* It is used by the python script which generates the HTML files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Chapter> */
|
||||
/* general_remarks */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* General Remarks */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Sections> */
|
||||
/* user_allocation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Chapter> */
|
||||
/* core_api */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Core API */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Sections> */
|
||||
/* version */
|
||||
/* basic_types */
|
||||
/* base_interface */
|
||||
/* glyph_variants */
|
||||
/* glyph_management */
|
||||
/* mac_specific */
|
||||
/* sizes_management */
|
||||
/* header_file_macros */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Chapter> */
|
||||
/* format_specific */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Format-Specific API */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Sections> */
|
||||
/* multiple_masters */
|
||||
/* truetype_tables */
|
||||
/* type1_tables */
|
||||
/* sfnt_names */
|
||||
/* bdf_fonts */
|
||||
/* cid_fonts */
|
||||
/* pfr_fonts */
|
||||
/* winfnt_fonts */
|
||||
/* font_formats */
|
||||
/* gasp_table */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Chapter> */
|
||||
/* cache_subsystem */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Cache Sub-System */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Sections> */
|
||||
/* cache_subsystem */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Chapter> */
|
||||
/* support_api */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Support API */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Sections> */
|
||||
/* computations */
|
||||
/* list_processing */
|
||||
/* outline_processing */
|
||||
/* quick_advance */
|
||||
/* bitmap_handling */
|
||||
/* raster */
|
||||
/* glyph_stroker */
|
||||
/* system_interface */
|
||||
/* module_management */
|
||||
/* gzip */
|
||||
/* lzw */
|
||||
/* lcd_filtering */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
166
portlibs/include/freetype/ftcid.h
Normal file
166
portlibs/include/freetype/ftcid.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftcid.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for accessing CID font information (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2007, 2009 by Dereg Clegg, Michael Toftdal. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTCID_H__
|
||||
#define __FTCID_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* cid_fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* CID Fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* CID-keyed font specific API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of CID-keyed font specific */
|
||||
/* functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_CID_Registry_Ordering_Supplement
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the Registry/Ordering/Supplement triple (also known as the
|
||||
* "R/O/S") from a CID-keyed font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* registry ::
|
||||
* The registry, as a C~string, owned by the face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* ordering ::
|
||||
* The ordering, as a C~string, owned by the face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* supplement ::
|
||||
* The supplement.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with CID faces, returning an error
|
||||
* otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.6
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_CID_Registry_Ordering_Supplement( FT_Face face,
|
||||
const char* *registry,
|
||||
const char* *ordering,
|
||||
FT_Int *supplement);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_CID_Is_Internally_CID_Keyed
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the type of the input face, CID keyed or not. In
|
||||
* constrast to the @FT_IS_CID_KEYED macro this function returns
|
||||
* successfully also for CID-keyed fonts in an SNFT wrapper.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* is_cid ::
|
||||
* The type of the face as an @FT_Bool.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with CID faces and OpenType fonts,
|
||||
* returning an error otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.9
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_CID_Is_Internally_CID_Keyed( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Bool *is_cid );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_CID_From_Glyph_Index
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the CID of the input glyph index.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* glyph_index ::
|
||||
* The input glyph index.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* cid ::
|
||||
* The CID as an @FT_UInt.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with CID faces and OpenType fonts,
|
||||
* returning an error otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.9
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_CID_From_Glyph_Index( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt glyph_index,
|
||||
FT_UInt *cid );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTCID_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
244
portlibs/include/freetype/fterrdef.h
Normal file
244
portlibs/include/freetype/fterrdef.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,244 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* fterrdef.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType error codes (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2004, 2006, 2007, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** LIST OF ERROR CODES/MESSAGES *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* You need to define both FT_ERRORDEF_ and FT_NOERRORDEF_ before */
|
||||
/* including this file. */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* generic errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_NOERRORDEF_( Ok, 0x00, \
|
||||
"no error" )
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Cannot_Open_Resource, 0x01, \
|
||||
"cannot open resource" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Unknown_File_Format, 0x02, \
|
||||
"unknown file format" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_File_Format, 0x03, \
|
||||
"broken file" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Version, 0x04, \
|
||||
"invalid FreeType version" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Lower_Module_Version, 0x05, \
|
||||
"module version is too low" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Argument, 0x06, \
|
||||
"invalid argument" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Unimplemented_Feature, 0x07, \
|
||||
"unimplemented feature" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Table, 0x08, \
|
||||
"broken table" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Offset, 0x09, \
|
||||
"broken offset within table" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Array_Too_Large, 0x0A, \
|
||||
"array allocation size too large" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* glyph/character errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Glyph_Index, 0x10, \
|
||||
"invalid glyph index" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Character_Code, 0x11, \
|
||||
"invalid character code" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Glyph_Format, 0x12, \
|
||||
"unsupported glyph image format" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Cannot_Render_Glyph, 0x13, \
|
||||
"cannot render this glyph format" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Outline, 0x14, \
|
||||
"invalid outline" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Composite, 0x15, \
|
||||
"invalid composite glyph" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Hints, 0x16, \
|
||||
"too many hints" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Pixel_Size, 0x17, \
|
||||
"invalid pixel size" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* handle errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Handle, 0x20, \
|
||||
"invalid object handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Library_Handle, 0x21, \
|
||||
"invalid library handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Driver_Handle, 0x22, \
|
||||
"invalid module handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Face_Handle, 0x23, \
|
||||
"invalid face handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Size_Handle, 0x24, \
|
||||
"invalid size handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Slot_Handle, 0x25, \
|
||||
"invalid glyph slot handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_CharMap_Handle, 0x26, \
|
||||
"invalid charmap handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Cache_Handle, 0x27, \
|
||||
"invalid cache manager handle" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Stream_Handle, 0x28, \
|
||||
"invalid stream handle" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* driver errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Drivers, 0x30, \
|
||||
"too many modules" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Extensions, 0x31, \
|
||||
"too many extensions" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* memory errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Out_Of_Memory, 0x40, \
|
||||
"out of memory" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Unlisted_Object, 0x41, \
|
||||
"unlisted object" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* stream errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Cannot_Open_Stream, 0x51, \
|
||||
"cannot open stream" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Stream_Seek, 0x52, \
|
||||
"invalid stream seek" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Stream_Skip, 0x53, \
|
||||
"invalid stream skip" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Stream_Read, 0x54, \
|
||||
"invalid stream read" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Stream_Operation, 0x55, \
|
||||
"invalid stream operation" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Frame_Operation, 0x56, \
|
||||
"invalid frame operation" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Nested_Frame_Access, 0x57, \
|
||||
"nested frame access" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Frame_Read, 0x58, \
|
||||
"invalid frame read" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* raster errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Raster_Uninitialized, 0x60, \
|
||||
"raster uninitialized" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Raster_Corrupted, 0x61, \
|
||||
"raster corrupted" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Raster_Overflow, 0x62, \
|
||||
"raster overflow" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Raster_Negative_Height, 0x63, \
|
||||
"negative height while rastering" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* cache errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Caches, 0x70, \
|
||||
"too many registered caches" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* TrueType and SFNT errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Opcode, 0x80, \
|
||||
"invalid opcode" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Few_Arguments, 0x81, \
|
||||
"too few arguments" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Stack_Overflow, 0x82, \
|
||||
"stack overflow" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Code_Overflow, 0x83, \
|
||||
"code overflow" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Bad_Argument, 0x84, \
|
||||
"bad argument" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Divide_By_Zero, 0x85, \
|
||||
"division by zero" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Reference, 0x86, \
|
||||
"invalid reference" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Debug_OpCode, 0x87, \
|
||||
"found debug opcode" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( ENDF_In_Exec_Stream, 0x88, \
|
||||
"found ENDF opcode in execution stream" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Nested_DEFS, 0x89, \
|
||||
"nested DEFS" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_CodeRange, 0x8A, \
|
||||
"invalid code range" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Execution_Too_Long, 0x8B, \
|
||||
"execution context too long" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Function_Defs, 0x8C, \
|
||||
"too many function definitions" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Too_Many_Instruction_Defs, 0x8D, \
|
||||
"too many instruction definitions" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Table_Missing, 0x8E, \
|
||||
"SFNT font table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Horiz_Header_Missing, 0x8F, \
|
||||
"horizontal header (hhea) table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Locations_Missing, 0x90, \
|
||||
"locations (loca) table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Name_Table_Missing, 0x91, \
|
||||
"name table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( CMap_Table_Missing, 0x92, \
|
||||
"character map (cmap) table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Hmtx_Table_Missing, 0x93, \
|
||||
"horizontal metrics (hmtx) table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Post_Table_Missing, 0x94, \
|
||||
"PostScript (post) table missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Horiz_Metrics, 0x95, \
|
||||
"invalid horizontal metrics" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_CharMap_Format, 0x96, \
|
||||
"invalid character map (cmap) format" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_PPem, 0x97, \
|
||||
"invalid ppem value" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Vert_Metrics, 0x98, \
|
||||
"invalid vertical metrics" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Could_Not_Find_Context, 0x99, \
|
||||
"could not find context" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Post_Table_Format, 0x9A, \
|
||||
"invalid PostScript (post) table format" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Invalid_Post_Table, 0x9B, \
|
||||
"invalid PostScript (post) table" )
|
||||
|
||||
/* CFF, CID, and Type 1 errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Syntax_Error, 0xA0, \
|
||||
"opcode syntax error" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Stack_Underflow, 0xA1, \
|
||||
"argument stack underflow" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Ignore, 0xA2, \
|
||||
"ignore" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( No_Unicode_Glyph_Name, 0xA3, \
|
||||
"no Unicode glyph name found" )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* BDF errors */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Startfont_Field, 0xB0, \
|
||||
"`STARTFONT' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Font_Field, 0xB1, \
|
||||
"`FONT' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Size_Field, 0xB2, \
|
||||
"`SIZE' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Fontboundingbox_Field, 0xB3, \
|
||||
"`FONTBOUNDINGBOX' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Chars_Field, 0xB4, \
|
||||
"`CHARS' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Startchar_Field, 0xB5, \
|
||||
"`STARTCHAR' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Encoding_Field, 0xB6, \
|
||||
"`ENCODING' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Missing_Bbx_Field, 0xB7, \
|
||||
"`BBX' field missing" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Bbx_Too_Big, 0xB8, \
|
||||
"`BBX' too big" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Corrupted_Font_Header, 0xB9, \
|
||||
"Font header corrupted or missing fields" )
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF_( Corrupted_Font_Glyphs, 0xBA, \
|
||||
"Font glyphs corrupted or missing fields" )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
206
portlibs/include/freetype/fterrors.h
Normal file
206
portlibs/include/freetype/fterrors.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,206 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* fterrors.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code handling (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2004, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This special header file is used to define the handling of FT2 */
|
||||
/* enumeration constants. It can also be used to generate error message */
|
||||
/* strings with a small macro trick explained below. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* I - Error Formats */
|
||||
/* ----------------- */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The configuration macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS can be */
|
||||
/* defined in ftoption.h in order to make the higher byte indicate */
|
||||
/* the module where the error has happened (this is not compatible */
|
||||
/* with standard builds of FreeType 2). You can then use the macro */
|
||||
/* FT_ERROR_BASE macro to extract the generic error code from an */
|
||||
/* FT_Error value. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* II - Error Message strings */
|
||||
/* -------------------------- */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The error definitions below are made through special macros that */
|
||||
/* allow client applications to build a table of error message strings */
|
||||
/* if they need it. The strings are not included in a normal build of */
|
||||
/* FreeType 2 to save space (most client applications do not use */
|
||||
/* them). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* To do so, you have to define the following macros before including */
|
||||
/* this file: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_ERROR_START_LIST :: */
|
||||
/* This macro is called before anything else to define the start of */
|
||||
/* the error list. It is followed by several FT_ERROR_DEF calls */
|
||||
/* (see below). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_ERROR_DEF( e, v, s ) :: */
|
||||
/* This macro is called to define one single error. */
|
||||
/* `e' is the error code identifier (e.g. FT_Err_Invalid_Argument). */
|
||||
/* `v' is the error numerical value. */
|
||||
/* `s' is the corresponding error string. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_ERROR_END_LIST :: */
|
||||
/* This macro ends the list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Additionally, you have to undefine __FTERRORS_H__ before #including */
|
||||
/* this file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Here is a simple example: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* #undef __FTERRORS_H__ */
|
||||
/* #define FT_ERRORDEF( e, v, s ) { e, s }, */
|
||||
/* #define FT_ERROR_START_LIST { */
|
||||
/* #define FT_ERROR_END_LIST { 0, 0 } }; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* const struct */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* int err_code; */
|
||||
/* const char* err_msg; */
|
||||
/* } ft_errors[] = */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #include FT_ERRORS_H */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTERRORS_H__
|
||||
#define __FTERRORS_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* include module base error codes */
|
||||
#include FT_MODULE_ERRORS_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** SETUP MACROS *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_XCAT
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_CAT
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_ERR_XCAT( x, y ) x ## y
|
||||
#define FT_ERR_CAT( x, y ) FT_ERR_XCAT( x, y )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* FT_ERR_PREFIX is used as a prefix for error identifiers. */
|
||||
/* By default, we use `FT_Err_'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_ERR_PREFIX
|
||||
#define FT_ERR_PREFIX FT_Err_
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* FT_ERR_BASE is used as the base for module-specific errors. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifdef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_ERR_BASE
|
||||
#define FT_ERR_BASE FT_Mod_Err_Base
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_BASE
|
||||
#define FT_ERR_BASE 0
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* If FT_ERRORDEF is not defined, we need to define a simple */
|
||||
/* enumeration type. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_ERRORDEF
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_ERRORDEF( e, v, s ) e = v,
|
||||
#define FT_ERROR_START_LIST enum {
|
||||
#define FT_ERROR_END_LIST FT_ERR_CAT( FT_ERR_PREFIX, Max ) };
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_ERRORDEF */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* this macro is used to define an error */
|
||||
#define FT_ERRORDEF_( e, v, s ) \
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF( FT_ERR_CAT( FT_ERR_PREFIX, e ), v + FT_ERR_BASE, s )
|
||||
|
||||
/* this is only used for <module>_Err_Ok, which must be 0! */
|
||||
#define FT_NOERRORDEF_( e, v, s ) \
|
||||
FT_ERRORDEF( FT_ERR_CAT( FT_ERR_PREFIX, e ), v, s )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_ERROR_START_LIST
|
||||
FT_ERROR_START_LIST
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* now include the error codes */
|
||||
#include FT_ERROR_DEFINITIONS_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_ERROR_END_LIST
|
||||
FT_ERROR_END_LIST
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** SIMPLE CLEANUP *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_ERROR_START_LIST
|
||||
#undef FT_ERROR_END_LIST
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_ERRORDEF
|
||||
#undef FT_ERRORDEF_
|
||||
#undef FT_NOERRORDEF_
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_CONCAT
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_BASE
|
||||
|
||||
/* FT_KEEP_ERR_PREFIX is needed for ftvalid.h */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_KEEP_ERR_PREFIX
|
||||
#undef FT_ERR_PREFIX
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTERRORS_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
120
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgasp.h
Normal file
120
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgasp.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,120 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftgasp.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Access of TrueType's `gasp' table (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2007, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _FT_GASP_H_
|
||||
#define _FT_GASP_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* gasp_table
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* Gasp Table
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* Retrieving TrueType `gasp' table entries.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The function @FT_Get_Gasp can be used to query a TrueType or OpenType
|
||||
* font for specific entries in its `gasp' table, if any. This is
|
||||
* mainly useful when implementing native TrueType hinting with the
|
||||
* bytecode interpreter to duplicate the Windows text rendering results.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_GASP_XXX
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of values and/or bit-flags returned by the @FT_Get_Gasp
|
||||
* function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_GASP_NO_TABLE ::
|
||||
* This special value means that there is no GASP table in this face.
|
||||
* It is up to the client to decide what to do.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_GASP_DO_GRIDFIT ::
|
||||
* Grid-fitting and hinting should be performed at the specified ppem.
|
||||
* This *really* means TrueType bytecode interpretation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_GASP_DO_GRAY ::
|
||||
* Anti-aliased rendering should be performed at the specified ppem.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_GASP_SYMMETRIC_SMOOTHING ::
|
||||
* Smoothing along multiple axes must be used with ClearType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_GASP_SYMMETRIC_GRIDFIT ::
|
||||
* Grid-fitting must be used with ClearType's symmetric smoothing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* `ClearType' is Microsoft's implementation of LCD rendering, partly
|
||||
* protected by patents.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_NO_TABLE -1
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_DO_GRIDFIT 0x01
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_DO_GRAY 0x02
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_SYMMETRIC_SMOOTHING 0x08
|
||||
#define FT_GASP_SYMMETRIC_GRIDFIT 0x10
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @func:
|
||||
* FT_Get_Gasp
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Read the `gasp' table from a TrueType or OpenType font file and
|
||||
* return the entry corresponding to a given character pixel size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: The source face handle.
|
||||
* ppem :: The vertical character pixel size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* Bit flags (see @FT_GASP_XXX), or @FT_GASP_NO_TABLE if there is no
|
||||
* `gasp' table in the face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Int )
|
||||
FT_Get_Gasp( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt ppem );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _FT_GASP_H_ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
613
portlibs/include/freetype/ftglyph.h
Normal file
613
portlibs/include/freetype/ftglyph.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,613 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftglyph.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType convenience functions to handle glyphs (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2006, 2008, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file contains the definition of several convenience functions */
|
||||
/* that can be used by client applications to easily retrieve glyph */
|
||||
/* bitmaps and outlines from a given face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* These functions should be optional if you are writing a font server */
|
||||
/* or text layout engine on top of FreeType. However, they are pretty */
|
||||
/* handy for many other simple uses of the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTGLYPH_H__
|
||||
#define __FTGLYPH_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* glyph_management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Glyph Management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Generic interface to manage individual glyph data. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains definitions used to manage glyph data */
|
||||
/* through generic FT_Glyph objects. Each of them can contain a */
|
||||
/* bitmap, a vector outline, or even images in other formats. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* forward declaration to a private type */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Glyph_Class_ FT_Glyph_Class;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Handle to an object used to model generic glyph images. It is a */
|
||||
/* pointer to the @FT_GlyphRec structure and can contain a glyph */
|
||||
/* bitmap or pointer. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* Glyph objects are not owned by the library. You must thus release */
|
||||
/* them manually (through @FT_Done_Glyph) _before_ calling */
|
||||
/* @FT_Done_FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_GlyphRec_* FT_Glyph;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_GlyphRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The root glyph structure contains a given glyph image plus its */
|
||||
/* advance width in 16.16 fixed float format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the FreeType library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* clazz :: A pointer to the glyph's class. Private. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* format :: The format of the glyph's image. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* advance :: A 16.16 vector that gives the glyph's advance width. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_GlyphRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Library library;
|
||||
const FT_Glyph_Class* clazz;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Format format;
|
||||
FT_Vector advance;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_GlyphRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_BitmapGlyph */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to an object used to model a bitmap glyph image. This is */
|
||||
/* a sub-class of @FT_Glyph, and a pointer to @FT_BitmapGlyphRec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_BitmapGlyphRec_* FT_BitmapGlyph;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_BitmapGlyphRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used for bitmap glyph images. This really is a */
|
||||
/* `sub-class' of @FT_GlyphRec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* root :: The root @FT_Glyph fields. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* left :: The left-side bearing, i.e., the horizontal distance */
|
||||
/* from the current pen position to the left border of the */
|
||||
/* glyph bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* top :: The top-side bearing, i.e., the vertical distance from */
|
||||
/* the current pen position to the top border of the glyph */
|
||||
/* bitmap. This distance is positive for upwards~y! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* bitmap :: A descriptor for the bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* You can typecast an @FT_Glyph to @FT_BitmapGlyph if you have */
|
||||
/* `glyph->format == FT_GLYPH_FORMAT_BITMAP'. This lets you access */
|
||||
/* the bitmap's contents easily. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The corresponding pixel buffer is always owned by @FT_BitmapGlyph */
|
||||
/* and is thus created and destroyed with it. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_BitmapGlyphRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_GlyphRec root;
|
||||
FT_Int left;
|
||||
FT_Int top;
|
||||
FT_Bitmap bitmap;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_BitmapGlyphRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_OutlineGlyph */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to an object used to model an outline glyph image. This */
|
||||
/* is a sub-class of @FT_Glyph, and a pointer to @FT_OutlineGlyphRec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_OutlineGlyphRec_* FT_OutlineGlyph;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_OutlineGlyphRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used for outline (vectorial) glyph images. This */
|
||||
/* really is a `sub-class' of @FT_GlyphRec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* root :: The root @FT_Glyph fields. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* outline :: A descriptor for the outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* You can typecast an @FT_Glyph to @FT_OutlineGlyph if you have */
|
||||
/* `glyph->format == FT_GLYPH_FORMAT_OUTLINE'. This lets you access */
|
||||
/* the outline's content easily. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* As the outline is extracted from a glyph slot, its coordinates are */
|
||||
/* expressed normally in 26.6 pixels, unless the flag */
|
||||
/* @FT_LOAD_NO_SCALE was used in @FT_Load_Glyph() or @FT_Load_Char(). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The outline's tables are always owned by the object and are */
|
||||
/* destroyed with it. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_OutlineGlyphRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_GlyphRec root;
|
||||
FT_Outline outline;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_OutlineGlyphRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Glyph */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A function used to extract a glyph image from a slot. Note that */
|
||||
/* the created @FT_Glyph object must be released with @FT_Done_Glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* slot :: A handle to the source glyph slot. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* aglyph :: A handle to the glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_Glyph( FT_GlyphSlot slot,
|
||||
FT_Glyph *aglyph );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_Copy */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A function used to copy a glyph image. Note that the created */
|
||||
/* @FT_Glyph object must be released with @FT_Done_Glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* source :: A handle to the source glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* target :: A handle to the target glyph object. 0~in case of */
|
||||
/* error. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Copy( FT_Glyph source,
|
||||
FT_Glyph *target );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_Transform */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Transform a glyph image if its format is scalable. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* glyph :: A handle to the target glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* matrix :: A pointer to a 2x2 matrix to apply. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* delta :: A pointer to a 2d vector to apply. Coordinates are */
|
||||
/* expressed in 1/64th of a pixel. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code (if not 0, the glyph format is not scalable). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The 2x2 transformation matrix is also applied to the glyph's */
|
||||
/* advance vector. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Transform( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
FT_Matrix* matrix,
|
||||
FT_Vector* delta );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Enum> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_BBox_Mode */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The mode how the values of @FT_Glyph_Get_CBox are returned. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Values> */
|
||||
/* FT_GLYPH_BBOX_UNSCALED :: */
|
||||
/* Return unscaled font units. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_GLYPH_BBOX_SUBPIXELS :: */
|
||||
/* Return unfitted 26.6 coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_GLYPH_BBOX_GRIDFIT :: */
|
||||
/* Return grid-fitted 26.6 coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_GLYPH_BBOX_TRUNCATE :: */
|
||||
/* Return coordinates in integer pixels. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_GLYPH_BBOX_PIXELS :: */
|
||||
/* Return grid-fitted pixel coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef enum FT_Glyph_BBox_Mode_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_GLYPH_BBOX_UNSCALED = 0,
|
||||
FT_GLYPH_BBOX_SUBPIXELS = 0,
|
||||
FT_GLYPH_BBOX_GRIDFIT = 1,
|
||||
FT_GLYPH_BBOX_TRUNCATE = 2,
|
||||
FT_GLYPH_BBOX_PIXELS = 3
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Glyph_BBox_Mode;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Enum> */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_xxx */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* These constants are deprecated. Use the corresponding */
|
||||
/* @FT_Glyph_BBox_Mode values instead. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Values> */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_unscaled :: See @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_UNSCALED. */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_subpixels :: See @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_SUBPIXELS. */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_gridfit :: See @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_GRIDFIT. */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_truncate :: See @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_TRUNCATE. */
|
||||
/* ft_glyph_bbox_pixels :: See @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_PIXELS. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define ft_glyph_bbox_unscaled FT_GLYPH_BBOX_UNSCALED
|
||||
#define ft_glyph_bbox_subpixels FT_GLYPH_BBOX_SUBPIXELS
|
||||
#define ft_glyph_bbox_gridfit FT_GLYPH_BBOX_GRIDFIT
|
||||
#define ft_glyph_bbox_truncate FT_GLYPH_BBOX_TRUNCATE
|
||||
#define ft_glyph_bbox_pixels FT_GLYPH_BBOX_PIXELS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_Get_CBox */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return a glyph's `control box'. The control box encloses all the */
|
||||
/* outline's points, including Bézier control points. Though it */
|
||||
/* coincides with the exact bounding box for most glyphs, it can be */
|
||||
/* slightly larger in some situations (like when rotating an outline */
|
||||
/* which contains Bézier outside arcs). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Computing the control box is very fast, while getting the bounding */
|
||||
/* box can take much more time as it needs to walk over all segments */
|
||||
/* and arcs in the outline. To get the latter, you can use the */
|
||||
/* `ftbbox' component which is dedicated to this single task. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* glyph :: A handle to the source glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* mode :: The mode which indicates how to interpret the returned */
|
||||
/* bounding box values. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* acbox :: The glyph coordinate bounding box. Coordinates are */
|
||||
/* expressed in 1/64th of pixels if it is grid-fitted. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* Coordinates are relative to the glyph origin, using the y~upwards */
|
||||
/* convention. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If the glyph has been loaded with @FT_LOAD_NO_SCALE, `bbox_mode' */
|
||||
/* must be set to @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_UNSCALED to get unscaled font */
|
||||
/* units in 26.6 pixel format. The value @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_SUBPIXELS */
|
||||
/* is another name for this constant. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that the maximum coordinates are exclusive, which means that */
|
||||
/* one can compute the width and height of the glyph image (be it in */
|
||||
/* integer or 26.6 pixels) as: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* width = bbox.xMax - bbox.xMin; */
|
||||
/* height = bbox.yMax - bbox.yMin; */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note also that for 26.6 coordinates, if `bbox_mode' is set to */
|
||||
/* @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_GRIDFIT, the coordinates will also be grid-fitted, */
|
||||
/* which corresponds to: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* bbox.xMin = FLOOR(bbox.xMin); */
|
||||
/* bbox.yMin = FLOOR(bbox.yMin); */
|
||||
/* bbox.xMax = CEILING(bbox.xMax); */
|
||||
/* bbox.yMax = CEILING(bbox.yMax); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* To get the bbox in pixel coordinates, set `bbox_mode' to */
|
||||
/* @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_TRUNCATE. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* To get the bbox in grid-fitted pixel coordinates, set `bbox_mode' */
|
||||
/* to @FT_GLYPH_BBOX_PIXELS. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Get_CBox( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
FT_UInt bbox_mode,
|
||||
FT_BBox *acbox );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_To_Bitmap */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Convert a given glyph object to a bitmap glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* the_glyph :: A pointer to a handle to the target glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* render_mode :: An enumeration that describes how the data is */
|
||||
/* rendered. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* origin :: A pointer to a vector used to translate the glyph */
|
||||
/* image before rendering. Can be~0 (if no */
|
||||
/* translation). The origin is expressed in */
|
||||
/* 26.6 pixels. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* destroy :: A boolean that indicates that the original glyph */
|
||||
/* image should be destroyed by this function. It is */
|
||||
/* never destroyed in case of error. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function does nothing if the glyph format isn't scalable. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The glyph image is translated with the `origin' vector before */
|
||||
/* rendering. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The first parameter is a pointer to an @FT_Glyph handle, that will */
|
||||
/* be _replaced_ by this function (with newly allocated data). */
|
||||
/* Typically, you would use (omitting error handling): */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph glyph; */
|
||||
/* FT_BitmapGlyph glyph_bitmap; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // load glyph */
|
||||
/* error = FT_Load_Char( face, glyph_index, FT_LOAD_DEFAUT ); */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // extract glyph image */
|
||||
/* error = FT_Get_Glyph( face->glyph, &glyph ); */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // convert to a bitmap (default render mode + destroying old) */
|
||||
/* if ( glyph->format != FT_GLYPH_FORMAT_BITMAP ) */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* error = FT_Glyph_To_Bitmap( &glyph, FT_RENDER_MODE_NORMAL, */
|
||||
/* 0, 1 ); */
|
||||
/* if ( error ) // `glyph' unchanged */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // access bitmap content by typecasting */
|
||||
/* glyph_bitmap = (FT_BitmapGlyph)glyph; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // do funny stuff with it, like blitting/drawing */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // discard glyph image (bitmap or not) */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Glyph( glyph ); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Here another example, again without error handling: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph glyphs[MAX_GLYPHS] */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* for ( idx = 0; i < MAX_GLYPHS; i++ ) */
|
||||
/* error = FT_Load_Glyph( face, idx, FT_LOAD_DEFAULT ) || */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Glyph ( face->glyph, &glyph[idx] ); */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* for ( idx = 0; i < MAX_GLYPHS; i++ ) */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph bitmap = glyphs[idx]; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* // after this call, `bitmap' no longer points into */
|
||||
/* // the `glyphs' array (and the old value isn't destroyed) */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_To_Bitmap( &bitmap, FT_RENDER_MODE_MONO, 0, 0 ); */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Glyph( bitmap ); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ... */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* for ( idx = 0; i < MAX_GLYPHS; i++ ) */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Glyph( glyphs[idx] ); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_To_Bitmap( FT_Glyph* the_glyph,
|
||||
FT_Render_Mode render_mode,
|
||||
FT_Vector* origin,
|
||||
FT_Bool destroy );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Glyph */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Destroy a given glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* glyph :: A handle to the target glyph object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Done_Glyph( FT_Glyph glyph );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* other helpful functions */
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* computations */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Matrix_Multiply */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Perform the matrix operation `b = a*b'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* a :: A pointer to matrix `a'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* b :: A pointer to matrix `b'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The result is undefined if either `a' or `b' is zero. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Matrix_Multiply( const FT_Matrix* a,
|
||||
FT_Matrix* b );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Matrix_Invert */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Invert a 2x2 matrix. Return an error if it can't be inverted. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* matrix :: A pointer to the target matrix. Remains untouched in */
|
||||
/* case of error. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Matrix_Invert( FT_Matrix* matrix );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTGLYPH_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Local Variables: */
|
||||
/* coding: utf-8 */
|
||||
/* End: */
|
358
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgxval.h
Normal file
358
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgxval.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,358 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftgxval.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for validating TrueTypeGX/AAT tables (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2004, 2005, 2006 by */
|
||||
/* Masatake YAMATO, Redhat K.K, */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* gxvalid is derived from both gxlayout module and otvalid module. */
|
||||
/* Development of gxlayout is supported by the Information-technology */
|
||||
/* Promotion Agency(IPA), Japan. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTGXVAL_H__
|
||||
#define __FTGXVAL_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* gx_validation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* TrueTypeGX/AAT Validation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* An API to validate TrueTypeGX/AAT tables. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of functions to validate */
|
||||
/* some TrueTypeGX tables (feat, mort, morx, bsln, just, kern, opbd, */
|
||||
/* trak, prop, lcar). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Warning: Use FT_VALIDATE_XXX to validate a table. */
|
||||
/* Following definitions are for gxvalid developers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_feat_INDEX 0
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_mort_INDEX 1
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_morx_INDEX 2
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_bsln_INDEX 3
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_just_INDEX 4
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_kern_INDEX 5
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_opbd_INDEX 6
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_trak_INDEX 7
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_prop_INDEX 8
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_lcar_INDEX 9
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GX_LAST_INDEX FT_VALIDATE_lcar_INDEX
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GX_LENGTH
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The number of tables checked in this module. Use it as a parameter
|
||||
* for the `table-length' argument of function @FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GX_LENGTH (FT_VALIDATE_GX_LAST_INDEX + 1)
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Up to 0x1000 is used by otvalid.
|
||||
Ox2xxx is reserved for feature OT extension. */
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GX_START 0x4000
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( tag ) \
|
||||
( FT_VALIDATE_GX_START << FT_VALIDATE_##tag##_INDEX )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GXXXX
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of bit-field constants used with @FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate to
|
||||
* indicate which TrueTypeGX/AAT Type tables should be validated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_feat ::
|
||||
* Validate `feat' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_mort ::
|
||||
* Validate `mort' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_morx ::
|
||||
* Validate `morx' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_bsln ::
|
||||
* Validate `bsln' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_just ::
|
||||
* Validate `just' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_kern ::
|
||||
* Validate `kern' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_opbd ::
|
||||
* Validate `opbd' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_trak ::
|
||||
* Validate `trak' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_prop ::
|
||||
* Validate `prop' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_lcar ::
|
||||
* Validate `lcar' table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GX ::
|
||||
* Validate all TrueTypeGX tables (feat, mort, morx, bsln, just, kern,
|
||||
* opbd, trak, prop and lcar).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_feat FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( feat )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_mort FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( mort )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_morx FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( morx )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_bsln FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( bsln )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_just FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( just )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_kern FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( kern )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_opbd FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( opbd )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_trak FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( trak )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_prop FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( prop )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_lcar FT_VALIDATE_GX_BITFIELD( lcar )
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GX ( FT_VALIDATE_feat | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_mort | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_morx | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_bsln | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_just | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_kern | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_opbd | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_trak | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_prop | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_lcar )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Validate various TrueTypeGX tables to assure that all offsets and
|
||||
* indices are valid. The idea is that a higher-level library which
|
||||
* actually does the text layout can access those tables without
|
||||
* error checking (which can be quite time consuming).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* validation_flags ::
|
||||
* A bit field which specifies the tables to be validated. See
|
||||
* @FT_VALIDATE_GXXXX for possible values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* table_length ::
|
||||
* The size of the `tables' array. Normally, @FT_VALIDATE_GX_LENGTH
|
||||
* should be passed.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* tables ::
|
||||
* The array where all validated sfnt tables are stored.
|
||||
* The array itself must be allocated by a client.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with TrueTypeGX fonts, returning an error
|
||||
* otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After use, the application should deallocate the buffers pointed to by
|
||||
* each `tables' element, by calling @FT_TrueTypeGX_Free. A NULL value
|
||||
* indicates that the table either doesn't exist in the font, the
|
||||
* application hasn't asked for validation, or the validator doesn't have
|
||||
* the ability to validate the sfnt table.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt validation_flags,
|
||||
FT_Bytes tables[FT_VALIDATE_GX_LENGTH],
|
||||
FT_UInt table_length );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_TrueTypeGX_Free
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Free the buffer allocated by TrueTypeGX validator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* table ::
|
||||
* The pointer to the buffer allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function must be used to free the buffer allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_TrueTypeGX_Free( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Bytes table );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_CKERNXXX
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of bit-field constants used with @FT_ClassicKern_Validate
|
||||
* to indicate the classic kern dialect or dialects. If the selected
|
||||
* type doesn't fit, @FT_ClassicKern_Validate regards the table as
|
||||
* invalid.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_MS ::
|
||||
* Handle the `kern' table as a classic Microsoft kern table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_APPLE ::
|
||||
* Handle the `kern' table as a classic Apple kern table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_CKERN ::
|
||||
* Handle the `kern' as either classic Apple or Microsoft kern table.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_MS ( FT_VALIDATE_GX_START << 0 )
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_APPLE ( FT_VALIDATE_GX_START << 1 )
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_CKERN ( FT_VALIDATE_MS | FT_VALIDATE_APPLE )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_ClassicKern_Validate
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Validate classic (16-bit format) kern table to assure that the offsets
|
||||
* and indices are valid. The idea is that a higher-level library which
|
||||
* actually does the text layout can access those tables without error
|
||||
* checking (which can be quite time consuming).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The `kern' table validator in @FT_TrueTypeGX_Validate deals with both
|
||||
* the new 32-bit format and the classic 16-bit format, while
|
||||
* FT_ClassicKern_Validate only supports the classic 16-bit format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* validation_flags ::
|
||||
* A bit field which specifies the dialect to be validated. See
|
||||
* @FT_VALIDATE_CKERNXXX for possible values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* ckern_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the kern table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* After use, the application should deallocate the buffers pointed to by
|
||||
* `ckern_table', by calling @FT_ClassicKern_Free. A NULL value
|
||||
* indicates that the table doesn't exist in the font.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_ClassicKern_Validate( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt validation_flags,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *ckern_table );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_ClassicKern_Free
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Free the buffer allocated by classic Kern validator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* table ::
|
||||
* The pointer to the buffer that is allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_ClassicKern_Validate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function must be used to free the buffer allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_ClassicKern_Validate only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_ClassicKern_Free( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Bytes table );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTGXVAL_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
102
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgzip.h
Normal file
102
portlibs/include/freetype/ftgzip.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftgzip.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Gzip-compressed stream support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTGZIP_H__
|
||||
#define __FTGZIP_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* gzip */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* GZIP Streams */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Using gzip-compressed font files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of Gzip-specific functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stream_OpenGzip
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Open a new stream to parse gzip-compressed font files. This is
|
||||
* mainly used to support the compressed `*.pcf.gz' fonts that come
|
||||
* with XFree86.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stream ::
|
||||
* The target embedding stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* source ::
|
||||
* The source stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The source stream must be opened _before_ calling this function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Calling the internal function `FT_Stream_Close' on the new stream will
|
||||
* *not* call `FT_Stream_Close' on the source stream. None of the stream
|
||||
* objects will be released to the heap.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The stream implementation is very basic and resets the decompression
|
||||
* process each time seeking backwards is needed within the stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In certain builds of the library, gzip compression recognition is
|
||||
* automatically handled when calling @FT_New_Face or @FT_Open_Face.
|
||||
* This means that if no font driver is capable of handling the raw
|
||||
* compressed file, the library will try to open a gzipped stream from
|
||||
* it and re-open the face with it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function may return `FT_Err_Unimplemented_Feature' if your build
|
||||
* of FreeType was not compiled with zlib support.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stream_OpenGzip( FT_Stream stream,
|
||||
FT_Stream source );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTGZIP_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
1301
portlibs/include/freetype/ftimage.h
Normal file
1301
portlibs/include/freetype/ftimage.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
353
portlibs/include/freetype/ftincrem.h
Normal file
353
portlibs/include/freetype/ftincrem.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,353 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftincrem.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType incremental loading (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTINCREM_H__
|
||||
#define __FTINCREM_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* incremental
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* Incremental Loading
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* Custom Glyph Loading.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This section contains various functions used to perform so-called
|
||||
* `incremental' glyph loading. This is a mode where all glyphs loaded
|
||||
* from a given @FT_Face are provided by the client application,
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Apart from that, all other tables are loaded normally from the font
|
||||
* file. This mode is useful when FreeType is used within another
|
||||
* engine, e.g., a PostScript Imaging Processor.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* To enable this mode, you must use @FT_Open_Face, passing an
|
||||
* @FT_Parameter with the @FT_PARAM_TAG_INCREMENTAL tag and an
|
||||
* @FT_Incremental_Interface value. See the comments for
|
||||
* @FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec for an example.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* An opaque type describing a user-provided object used to implement
|
||||
* `incremental' glyph loading within FreeType. This is used to support
|
||||
* embedded fonts in certain environments (e.g., PostScript interpreters),
|
||||
* where the glyph data isn't in the font file, or must be overridden by
|
||||
* different values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* It is up to client applications to create and implement @FT_Incremental
|
||||
* objects, as long as they provide implementations for the methods
|
||||
* @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc, @FT_Incremental_FreeGlyphDataFunc
|
||||
* and @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* See the description of @FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec to understand how
|
||||
* to use incremental objects with FreeType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_IncrementalRec_* FT_Incremental;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_MetricsRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A small structure used to contain the basic glyph metrics returned
|
||||
* by the @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc method.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @fields:
|
||||
* bearing_x ::
|
||||
* Left bearing, in font units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* bearing_y ::
|
||||
* Top bearing, in font units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* advance ::
|
||||
* Horizontal component of glyph advance, in font units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* advance_v ::
|
||||
* Vertical component of glyph advance, in font units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* These correspond to horizontal or vertical metrics depending on the
|
||||
* value of the `vertical' argument to the function
|
||||
* @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Incremental_MetricsRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Long bearing_x;
|
||||
FT_Long bearing_y;
|
||||
FT_Long advance;
|
||||
FT_Long advance_v; /* since 2.3.12 */
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Incremental_MetricsRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_Metrics
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A handle to an @FT_Incremental_MetricsRec structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Incremental_MetricsRec_* FT_Incremental_Metrics;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function called by FreeType to access a given glyph's data bytes
|
||||
* during @FT_Load_Glyph or @FT_Load_Char if incremental loading is
|
||||
* enabled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that the format of the glyph's data bytes depends on the font
|
||||
* file format. For TrueType, it must correspond to the raw bytes within
|
||||
* the `glyf' table. For PostScript formats, it must correspond to the
|
||||
* *unencrypted* charstring bytes, without any `lenIV' header. It is
|
||||
* undefined for any other format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* incremental ::
|
||||
* Handle to an opaque @FT_Incremental handle provided by the client
|
||||
* application.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* glyph_index ::
|
||||
* Index of relevant glyph.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* adata ::
|
||||
* A structure describing the returned glyph data bytes (which will be
|
||||
* accessed as a read-only byte block).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If this function returns successfully the method
|
||||
* @FT_Incremental_FreeGlyphDataFunc will be called later to release
|
||||
* the data bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Nested calls to @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc can happen for
|
||||
* compound glyphs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc)( FT_Incremental incremental,
|
||||
FT_UInt glyph_index,
|
||||
FT_Data* adata );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_FreeGlyphDataFunc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to release the glyph data bytes returned by a
|
||||
* successful call to @FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* incremental ::
|
||||
* A handle to an opaque @FT_Incremental handle provided by the client
|
||||
* application.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* data ::
|
||||
* A structure describing the glyph data bytes (which will be accessed
|
||||
* as a read-only byte block).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Incremental_FreeGlyphDataFunc)( FT_Incremental incremental,
|
||||
FT_Data* data );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to retrieve the basic metrics of a given glyph index
|
||||
* before accessing its data. This is necessary because, in certain
|
||||
* formats like TrueType, the metrics are stored in a different place from
|
||||
* the glyph images proper.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* incremental ::
|
||||
* A handle to an opaque @FT_Incremental handle provided by the client
|
||||
* application.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* glyph_index ::
|
||||
* Index of relevant glyph.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* vertical ::
|
||||
* If true, return vertical metrics.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* ametrics ::
|
||||
* This parameter is used for both input and output.
|
||||
* The original glyph metrics, if any, in font units. If metrics are
|
||||
* not available all the values must be set to zero.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* ametrics ::
|
||||
* The replacement glyph metrics in font units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc)
|
||||
( FT_Incremental incremental,
|
||||
FT_UInt glyph_index,
|
||||
FT_Bool vertical,
|
||||
FT_Incremental_MetricsRec *ametrics );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_FuncsRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A table of functions for accessing fonts that load data
|
||||
* incrementally. Used in @FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @fields:
|
||||
* get_glyph_data ::
|
||||
* The function to get glyph data. Must not be null.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* free_glyph_data ::
|
||||
* The function to release glyph data. Must not be null.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* get_glyph_metrics ::
|
||||
* The function to get glyph metrics. May be null if the font does
|
||||
* not provide overriding glyph metrics.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Incremental_FuncsRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Incremental_GetGlyphDataFunc get_glyph_data;
|
||||
FT_Incremental_FreeGlyphDataFunc free_glyph_data;
|
||||
FT_Incremental_GetGlyphMetricsFunc get_glyph_metrics;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Incremental_FuncsRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A structure to be used with @FT_Open_Face to indicate that the user
|
||||
* wants to support incremental glyph loading. You should use it with
|
||||
* @FT_PARAM_TAG_INCREMENTAL as in the following example:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* {
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec inc_int;
|
||||
* FT_Parameter parameter;
|
||||
* FT_Open_Args open_args;
|
||||
*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // set up incremental descriptor
|
||||
* inc_int.funcs = my_funcs;
|
||||
* inc_int.object = my_object;
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // set up optional parameter
|
||||
* parameter.tag = FT_PARAM_TAG_INCREMENTAL;
|
||||
* parameter.data = &inc_int;
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // set up FT_Open_Args structure
|
||||
* open_args.flags = FT_OPEN_PATHNAME | FT_OPEN_PARAMS;
|
||||
* open_args.pathname = my_font_pathname;
|
||||
* open_args.num_params = 1;
|
||||
* open_args.params = ¶meter; // we use one optional argument
|
||||
*
|
||||
* // open the font
|
||||
* error = FT_Open_Face( library, &open_args, index, &face );
|
||||
* ...
|
||||
* }
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
const FT_Incremental_FuncsRec* funcs;
|
||||
FT_Incremental object;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Incremental_Interface
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A pointer to an @FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef FT_Incremental_InterfaceRec* FT_Incremental_Interface;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @constant:
|
||||
* FT_PARAM_TAG_INCREMENTAL
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A constant used as the tag of @FT_Parameter structures to indicate
|
||||
* an incremental loading object to be used by FreeType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_PARAM_TAG_INCREMENTAL FT_MAKE_TAG( 'i', 'n', 'c', 'r' )
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTINCREM_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
213
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlcdfil.h
Normal file
213
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlcdfil.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,213 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftlcdfil.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for color filtering of subpixel bitmap glyphs */
|
||||
/* (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2006, 2007, 2008, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FT_LCD_FILTER_H__
|
||||
#define __FT_LCD_FILTER_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* lcd_filtering
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* LCD Filtering
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* Reduce color fringes of LCD-optimized bitmaps.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The @FT_Library_SetLcdFilter API can be used to specify a low-pass
|
||||
* filter which is then applied to LCD-optimized bitmaps generated
|
||||
* through @FT_Render_Glyph. This is useful to reduce color fringes
|
||||
* which would occur with unfiltered rendering.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that no filter is active by default, and that this function is
|
||||
* *not* implemented in default builds of the library. You need to
|
||||
* #define FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SUBPIXEL_RENDERING in your `ftoption.h' file
|
||||
* in order to activate it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/****************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_LcdFilter
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of values to identify various types of LCD filters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_NONE ::
|
||||
* Do not perform filtering. When used with subpixel rendering, this
|
||||
* results in sometimes severe color fringes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_DEFAULT ::
|
||||
* The default filter reduces color fringes considerably, at the cost
|
||||
* of a slight blurriness in the output.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_LIGHT ::
|
||||
* The light filter is a variant that produces less blurriness at the
|
||||
* cost of slightly more color fringes than the default one. It might
|
||||
* be better, depending on taste, your monitor, or your personal vision.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_LEGACY ::
|
||||
* This filter corresponds to the original libXft color filter. It
|
||||
* provides high contrast output but can exhibit really bad color
|
||||
* fringes if glyphs are not extremely well hinted to the pixel grid.
|
||||
* In other words, it only works well if the TrueType bytecode
|
||||
* interpreter is enabled *and* high-quality hinted fonts are used.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This filter is only provided for comparison purposes, and might be
|
||||
* disabled or stay unsupported in the future.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_LcdFilter_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_LCD_FILTER_NONE = 0,
|
||||
FT_LCD_FILTER_DEFAULT = 1,
|
||||
FT_LCD_FILTER_LIGHT = 2,
|
||||
FT_LCD_FILTER_LEGACY = 16,
|
||||
|
||||
FT_LCD_FILTER_MAX /* do not remove */
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_LcdFilter;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @func:
|
||||
* FT_Library_SetLcdFilter
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This function is used to apply color filtering to LCD decimated
|
||||
* bitmaps, like the ones used when calling @FT_Render_Glyph with
|
||||
* @FT_RENDER_MODE_LCD or @FT_RENDER_MODE_LCD_V.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* library ::
|
||||
* A handle to the target library instance.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* filter ::
|
||||
* The filter type.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You can use @FT_LCD_FILTER_NONE here to disable this feature, or
|
||||
* @FT_LCD_FILTER_DEFAULT to use a default filter that should work
|
||||
* well on most LCD screens.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This feature is always disabled by default. Clients must make an
|
||||
* explicit call to this function with a `filter' value other than
|
||||
* @FT_LCD_FILTER_NONE in order to enable it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Due to *PATENTS* covering subpixel rendering, this function doesn't
|
||||
* do anything except returning `FT_Err_Unimplemented_Feature' if the
|
||||
* configuration macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SUBPIXEL_RENDERING is not
|
||||
* defined in your build of the library, which should correspond to all
|
||||
* default builds of FreeType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The filter affects glyph bitmaps rendered through @FT_Render_Glyph,
|
||||
* @FT_Outline_Get_Bitmap, @FT_Load_Glyph, and @FT_Load_Char.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It does _not_ affect the output of @FT_Outline_Render and
|
||||
* @FT_Outline_Get_Bitmap.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If this feature is activated, the dimensions of LCD glyph bitmaps are
|
||||
* either larger or taller than the dimensions of the corresponding
|
||||
* outline with regards to the pixel grid. For example, for
|
||||
* @FT_RENDER_MODE_LCD, the filter adds up to 3~pixels to the left, and
|
||||
* up to 3~pixels to the right.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The bitmap offset values are adjusted correctly, so clients shouldn't
|
||||
* need to modify their layout and glyph positioning code when enabling
|
||||
* the filter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.3.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Library_SetLcdFilter( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_LcdFilter filter );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @func:
|
||||
* FT_Library_SetLcdFilterWeights
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Use this function to override the filter weights selected by
|
||||
* @FT_Library_SetLcdFilter. By default, FreeType uses the quintuple
|
||||
* (0x00, 0x55, 0x56, 0x55, 0x00) for FT_LCD_FILTER_LIGHT, and (0x10,
|
||||
* 0x40, 0x70, 0x40, 0x10) for FT_LCD_FILTER_DEFAULT and
|
||||
* FT_LCD_FILTER_LEGACY.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* library ::
|
||||
* A handle to the target library instance.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* weights ::
|
||||
* A pointer to an array; the function copies the first five bytes and
|
||||
* uses them to specify the filter weights.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* Due to *PATENTS* covering subpixel rendering, this function doesn't
|
||||
* do anything except returning `FT_Err_Unimplemented_Feature' if the
|
||||
* configuration macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_SUBPIXEL_RENDERING is not
|
||||
* defined in your build of the library, which should correspond to all
|
||||
* default builds of FreeType.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function must be called after @FT_Library_SetLcdFilter to have
|
||||
* any effect.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.4.0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Library_SetLcdFilterWeights( FT_Library library,
|
||||
unsigned char *weights );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FT_LCD_FILTER_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
277
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlist.h
Normal file
277
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlist.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,277 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftlist.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Generic list support for FreeType (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2003, 2007, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file implements functions relative to list processing. Its */
|
||||
/* data structures are defined in `freetype.h'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTLIST_H__
|
||||
#define __FTLIST_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* list_processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* List Processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Simple management of lists. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains various definitions related to list */
|
||||
/* processing using doubly-linked nodes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Order> */
|
||||
/* FT_List */
|
||||
/* FT_ListNode */
|
||||
/* FT_ListRec */
|
||||
/* FT_ListNodeRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Add */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Insert */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Find */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Remove */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Up */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Iterate */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Iterator */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Finalize */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Destructor */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Find */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Find the list node for a given listed object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* list :: A pointer to the parent list. */
|
||||
/* data :: The address of the listed object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* List node. NULL if it wasn't found. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_ListNode )
|
||||
FT_List_Find( FT_List list,
|
||||
void* data );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Add */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Append an element to the end of a list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* list :: A pointer to the parent list. */
|
||||
/* node :: The node to append. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_List_Add( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_ListNode node );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Insert */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Insert an element at the head of a list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* list :: A pointer to parent list. */
|
||||
/* node :: The node to insert. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_List_Insert( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_ListNode node );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Remove */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Remove a node from a list. This function doesn't check whether */
|
||||
/* the node is in the list! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* node :: The node to remove. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* list :: A pointer to the parent list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_List_Remove( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_ListNode node );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Up */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Move a node to the head/top of a list. Used to maintain LRU */
|
||||
/* lists. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* list :: A pointer to the parent list. */
|
||||
/* node :: The node to move. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_List_Up( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_ListNode node );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Iterator */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* An FT_List iterator function which is called during a list parse */
|
||||
/* by @FT_List_Iterate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* node :: The current iteration list node. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* user :: A typeless pointer passed to @FT_List_Iterate. */
|
||||
/* Can be used to point to the iteration's state. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_List_Iterator)( FT_ListNode node,
|
||||
void* user );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Iterate */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Parse a list and calls a given iterator function on each element. */
|
||||
/* Note that parsing is stopped as soon as one of the iterator calls */
|
||||
/* returns a non-zero value. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* list :: A handle to the list. */
|
||||
/* iterator :: An iterator function, called on each node of the list. */
|
||||
/* user :: A user-supplied field which is passed as the second */
|
||||
/* argument to the iterator. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* The result (a FreeType error code) of the last iterator call. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_List_Iterate( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_List_Iterator iterator,
|
||||
void* user );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Destructor */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* An @FT_List iterator function which is called during a list */
|
||||
/* finalization by @FT_List_Finalize to destroy all elements in a */
|
||||
/* given list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* system :: The current system object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* data :: The current object to destroy. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* user :: A typeless pointer passed to @FT_List_Iterate. It can */
|
||||
/* be used to point to the iteration's state. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_List_Destructor)( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
void* data,
|
||||
void* user );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_List_Finalize */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Destroy all elements in the list as well as the list itself. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* list :: A handle to the list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* destroy :: A list destructor that will be applied to each element */
|
||||
/* of the list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* memory :: The current memory object which handles deallocation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* user :: A user-supplied field which is passed as the last */
|
||||
/* argument to the destructor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function expects that all nodes added by @FT_List_Add or */
|
||||
/* @FT_List_Insert have been dynamically allocated. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_List_Finalize( FT_List list,
|
||||
FT_List_Destructor destroy,
|
||||
FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
void* user );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTLIST_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
99
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlzw.h
Normal file
99
portlibs/include/freetype/ftlzw.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftlzw.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* LZW-compressed stream support. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2004, 2006 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTLZW_H__
|
||||
#define __FTLZW_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* lzw */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* LZW Streams */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Using LZW-compressed font files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of LZW-specific functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stream_OpenLZW
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Open a new stream to parse LZW-compressed font files. This is
|
||||
* mainly used to support the compressed `*.pcf.Z' fonts that come
|
||||
* with XFree86.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stream :: The target embedding stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* source :: The source stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The source stream must be opened _before_ calling this function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Calling the internal function `FT_Stream_Close' on the new stream will
|
||||
* *not* call `FT_Stream_Close' on the source stream. None of the stream
|
||||
* objects will be released to the heap.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The stream implementation is very basic and resets the decompression
|
||||
* process each time seeking backwards is needed within the stream
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In certain builds of the library, LZW compression recognition is
|
||||
* automatically handled when calling @FT_New_Face or @FT_Open_Face.
|
||||
* This means that if no font driver is capable of handling the raw
|
||||
* compressed file, the library will try to open a LZW stream from it
|
||||
* and re-open the face with it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function may return `FT_Err_Unimplemented_Feature' if your build
|
||||
* of FreeType was not compiled with LZW support.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stream_OpenLZW( FT_Stream stream,
|
||||
FT_Stream source );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTLZW_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
274
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmac.h
Normal file
274
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmac.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,274 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftmac.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Additional Mac-specific API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2004, 2006, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* Just van Rossum, David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* NOTE: Include this file after <freetype/freetype.h> and after any */
|
||||
/* Mac-specific headers (because this header uses Mac types such as */
|
||||
/* Handle, FSSpec, FSRef, etc.) */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTMAC_H__
|
||||
#define __FTMAC_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* gcc-3.4.1 and later can warn about functions tagged as deprecated */
|
||||
#ifndef FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE
|
||||
#if defined(__GNUC__) && \
|
||||
((__GNUC__ >= 4) || ((__GNUC__ == 3) && (__GNUC_MINOR__ >= 1)))
|
||||
#define FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE __attribute__((deprecated))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* mac_specific */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Mac Specific Interface */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Only available on the Macintosh. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The following definitions are only available if FreeType is */
|
||||
/* compiled on a Macintosh. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_New_Face_From_FOND */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Create a new face object from a FOND resource. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library resource. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* fond :: A FOND resource. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: Only supported for the -1 `sanity check' special */
|
||||
/* case. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* aface :: A handle to a new face object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Notes> */
|
||||
/* This function can be used to create @FT_Face objects from fonts */
|
||||
/* that are installed in the system as follows. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* fond = GetResource( 'FOND', fontName ); */
|
||||
/* error = FT_New_Face_From_FOND( library, fond, 0, &face ); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_New_Face_From_FOND( FT_Library library,
|
||||
Handle fond,
|
||||
FT_Long face_index,
|
||||
FT_Face *aface )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_GetFile_From_Mac_Name */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return an FSSpec for the disk file containing the named font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* fontName :: Mac OS name of the font (e.g., Times New Roman */
|
||||
/* Bold). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* pathSpec :: FSSpec to the file. For passing to */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: Index of the face. For passing to */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_GetFile_From_Mac_Name( const char* fontName,
|
||||
FSSpec* pathSpec,
|
||||
FT_Long* face_index )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_GetFile_From_Mac_ATS_Name */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return an FSSpec for the disk file containing the named font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* fontName :: Mac OS name of the font in ATS framework. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* pathSpec :: FSSpec to the file. For passing to */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: Index of the face. For passing to */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_GetFile_From_Mac_ATS_Name( const char* fontName,
|
||||
FSSpec* pathSpec,
|
||||
FT_Long* face_index )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_GetFilePath_From_Mac_ATS_Name */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return a pathname of the disk file and face index for given font */
|
||||
/* name which is handled by ATS framework. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* fontName :: Mac OS name of the font in ATS framework. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* path :: Buffer to store pathname of the file. For passing */
|
||||
/* to @FT_New_Face. The client must allocate this */
|
||||
/* buffer before calling this function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxPathSize :: Lengths of the buffer `path' that client allocated. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: Index of the face. For passing to @FT_New_Face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_GetFilePath_From_Mac_ATS_Name( const char* fontName,
|
||||
UInt8* path,
|
||||
UInt32 maxPathSize,
|
||||
FT_Long* face_index )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Create a new face object from a given resource and typeface index */
|
||||
/* using an FSSpec to the font file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library resource. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* spec :: FSSpec to the font file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: The index of the face within the resource. The */
|
||||
/* first face has index~0. */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* aface :: A handle to a new face object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec is identical to @FT_New_Face except */
|
||||
/* it accepts an FSSpec instead of a path. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_New_Face_From_FSSpec( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const FSSpec *spec,
|
||||
FT_Long face_index,
|
||||
FT_Face *aface )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_New_Face_From_FSRef */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Create a new face object from a given resource and typeface index */
|
||||
/* using an FSRef to the font file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library resource. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* spec :: FSRef to the font file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* face_index :: The index of the face within the resource. The */
|
||||
/* first face has index~0. */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* aface :: A handle to a new face object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Face_From_FSRef is identical to @FT_New_Face except */
|
||||
/* it accepts an FSRef instead of a path. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_New_Face_From_FSRef( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const FSRef *ref,
|
||||
FT_Long face_index,
|
||||
FT_Face *aface )
|
||||
FT_DEPRECATED_ATTRIBUTE;
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTMAC_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
378
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmm.h
Normal file
378
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmm.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,378 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftmm.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType Multiple Master font interface (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTMM_H__
|
||||
#define __FTMM_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_TYPE1_TABLES_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* multiple_masters */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Multiple Masters */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* How to manage Multiple Masters fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The following types and functions are used to manage Multiple */
|
||||
/* Master fonts, i.e., the selection of specific design instances by */
|
||||
/* setting design axis coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* George Williams has extended this interface to make it work with */
|
||||
/* both Type~1 Multiple Masters fonts and GX distortable (var) */
|
||||
/* fonts. Some of these routines only work with MM fonts, others */
|
||||
/* will work with both types. They are similar enough that a */
|
||||
/* consistent interface makes sense. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_MM_Axis */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple structure used to model a given axis in design space for */
|
||||
/* Multiple Masters fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This structure can't be used for GX var fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* name :: The axis's name. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* minimum :: The axis's minimum design coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maximum :: The axis's maximum design coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_MM_Axis_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_String* name;
|
||||
FT_Long minimum;
|
||||
FT_Long maximum;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_MM_Axis;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Multi_Master */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model the axes and space of a Multiple Masters */
|
||||
/* font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This structure can't be used for GX var fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* num_axis :: Number of axes. Cannot exceed~4. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* num_designs :: Number of designs; should be normally 2^num_axis */
|
||||
/* even though the Type~1 specification strangely */
|
||||
/* allows for intermediate designs to be present. This */
|
||||
/* number cannot exceed~16. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* axis :: A table of axis descriptors. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Multi_Master_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UInt num_axis;
|
||||
FT_UInt num_designs;
|
||||
FT_MM_Axis axis[T1_MAX_MM_AXIS];
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Multi_Master;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Var_Axis */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple structure used to model a given axis in design space for */
|
||||
/* Multiple Masters and GX var fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* name :: The axis's name. */
|
||||
/* Not always meaningful for GX. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* minimum :: The axis's minimum design coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* def :: The axis's default design coordinate. */
|
||||
/* FreeType computes meaningful default values for MM; it */
|
||||
/* is then an integer value, not in 16.16 format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maximum :: The axis's maximum design coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* tag :: The axis's tag (the GX equivalent to `name'). */
|
||||
/* FreeType provides default values for MM if possible. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* strid :: The entry in `name' table (another GX version of */
|
||||
/* `name'). */
|
||||
/* Not meaningful for MM. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Var_Axis_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_String* name;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Fixed minimum;
|
||||
FT_Fixed def;
|
||||
FT_Fixed maximum;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong tag;
|
||||
FT_UInt strid;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Var_Axis;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Var_Named_Style */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple structure used to model a named style in a GX var font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This structure can't be used for MM fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* coords :: The design coordinates for this style. */
|
||||
/* This is an array with one entry for each axis. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* strid :: The entry in `name' table identifying this style. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Var_Named_Style_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed* coords;
|
||||
FT_UInt strid;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Var_Named_Style;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_MM_Var */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model the axes and space of a Multiple Masters */
|
||||
/* or GX var distortable font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Some fields are specific to one format and not to the other. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* num_axis :: The number of axes. The maximum value is~4 for */
|
||||
/* MM; no limit in GX. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* num_designs :: The number of designs; should be normally */
|
||||
/* 2^num_axis for MM fonts. Not meaningful for GX */
|
||||
/* (where every glyph could have a different */
|
||||
/* number of designs). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* num_namedstyles :: The number of named styles; only meaningful for */
|
||||
/* GX which allows certain design coordinates to */
|
||||
/* have a string ID (in the `name' table) */
|
||||
/* associated with them. The font can tell the */
|
||||
/* user that, for example, Weight=1.5 is `Bold'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* axis :: A table of axis descriptors. */
|
||||
/* GX fonts contain slightly more data than MM. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* namedstyles :: A table of named styles. */
|
||||
/* Only meaningful with GX. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_MM_Var_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UInt num_axis;
|
||||
FT_UInt num_designs;
|
||||
FT_UInt num_namedstyles;
|
||||
FT_Var_Axis* axis;
|
||||
FT_Var_Named_Style* namedstyle;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_MM_Var;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Multi_Master */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the Multiple Master descriptor of a given font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function can't be used with GX fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* amaster :: The Multiple Masters descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_Multi_Master( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Multi_Master *amaster );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_MM_Var */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the Multiple Master/GX var descriptor of a given font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* amaster :: The Multiple Masters/GX var descriptor. */
|
||||
/* Allocates a data structure, which the user must free */
|
||||
/* (a single call to FT_FREE will do it). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_MM_Var( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_MM_Var* *amaster );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_MM_Design_Coordinates */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* For Multiple Masters fonts, choose an interpolated font design */
|
||||
/* through design coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function can't be used with GX fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* num_coords :: The number of design coordinates (must be equal to */
|
||||
/* the number of axes in the font). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* coords :: An array of design coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Set_MM_Design_Coordinates( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt num_coords,
|
||||
FT_Long* coords );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_Var_Design_Coordinates */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* For Multiple Master or GX Var fonts, choose an interpolated font */
|
||||
/* design through design coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* num_coords :: The number of design coordinates (must be equal to */
|
||||
/* the number of axes in the font). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* coords :: An array of design coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Set_Var_Design_Coordinates( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt num_coords,
|
||||
FT_Fixed* coords );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_MM_Blend_Coordinates */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* For Multiple Masters and GX var fonts, choose an interpolated font */
|
||||
/* design through normalized blend coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* num_coords :: The number of design coordinates (must be equal to */
|
||||
/* the number of axes in the font). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* coords :: The design coordinates array (each element must be */
|
||||
/* between 0 and 1.0). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Set_MM_Blend_Coordinates( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt num_coords,
|
||||
FT_Fixed* coords );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_Var_Blend_Coordinates */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This is another name of @FT_Set_MM_Blend_Coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Set_Var_Blend_Coordinates( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt num_coords,
|
||||
FT_Fixed* coords );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTMM_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
483
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmodapi.h
Normal file
483
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmodapi.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,483 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftmodapi.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType modules public interface (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2006, 2008, 2009, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTMODAPI_H__
|
||||
#define __FTMODAPI_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* module_management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Module Management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* How to add, upgrade, and remove modules from FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The definitions below are used to manage modules within FreeType. */
|
||||
/* Modules can be added, upgraded, and removed at runtime. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* module bit flags */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_FONT_DRIVER 1 /* this module is a font driver */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_RENDERER 2 /* this module is a renderer */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_HINTER 4 /* this module is a glyph hinter */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_STYLER 8 /* this module is a styler */
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_DRIVER_SCALABLE 0x100 /* the driver supports */
|
||||
/* scalable fonts */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_DRIVER_NO_OUTLINES 0x200 /* the driver does not */
|
||||
/* support vector outlines */
|
||||
#define FT_MODULE_DRIVER_HAS_HINTER 0x400 /* the driver provides its */
|
||||
/* own hinter */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* deprecated values */
|
||||
#define ft_module_font_driver FT_MODULE_FONT_DRIVER
|
||||
#define ft_module_renderer FT_MODULE_RENDERER
|
||||
#define ft_module_hinter FT_MODULE_HINTER
|
||||
#define ft_module_styler FT_MODULE_STYLER
|
||||
|
||||
#define ft_module_driver_scalable FT_MODULE_DRIVER_SCALABLE
|
||||
#define ft_module_driver_no_outlines FT_MODULE_DRIVER_NO_OUTLINES
|
||||
#define ft_module_driver_has_hinter FT_MODULE_DRIVER_HAS_HINTER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Pointer FT_Module_Interface;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_Module_Constructor */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A function used to initialize (not create) a new module object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* module :: The module to initialize. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Module_Constructor)( FT_Module module );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_Module_Destructor */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A function used to finalize (not destroy) a given module object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* module :: The module to finalize. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Module_Destructor)( FT_Module module );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_Module_Requester */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A function used to query a given module for a specific interface. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* module :: The module to finalize. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* name :: The name of the interface in the module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef FT_Module_Interface
|
||||
(*FT_Module_Requester)( FT_Module module,
|
||||
const char* name );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Module_Class */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The module class descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* module_flags :: Bit flags describing the module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_size :: The size of one module object/instance in */
|
||||
/* bytes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_name :: The name of the module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_version :: The version, as a 16.16 fixed number */
|
||||
/* (major.minor). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_requires :: The version of FreeType this module requires, */
|
||||
/* as a 16.16 fixed number (major.minor). Starts */
|
||||
/* at version 2.0, i.e., 0x20000. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_init :: The initializing function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_done :: The finalizing function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* get_interface :: The interface requesting function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Module_Class_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_ULong module_flags;
|
||||
FT_Long module_size;
|
||||
const FT_String* module_name;
|
||||
FT_Fixed module_version;
|
||||
FT_Fixed module_requires;
|
||||
|
||||
const void* module_interface;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Module_Constructor module_init;
|
||||
FT_Module_Destructor module_done;
|
||||
FT_Module_Requester get_interface;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Module_Class;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Add_Module */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Add a new module to a given library instance. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* clazz :: A pointer to class descriptor for the module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* An error will be returned if a module already exists by that name, */
|
||||
/* or if the module requires a version of FreeType that is too great. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Add_Module( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const FT_Module_Class* clazz );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Module */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Find a module by its name. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* module_name :: The module's name (as an ASCII string). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* A module handle. 0~if none was found. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* FreeType's internal modules aren't documented very well, and you */
|
||||
/* should look up the source code for details. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Module )
|
||||
FT_Get_Module( FT_Library library,
|
||||
const char* module_name );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Remove_Module */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Remove a given module from a library instance. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* module :: A handle to a module object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The module object is destroyed by the function in case of success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Remove_Module( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Module module );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Reference_Library */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A counter gets initialized to~1 at the time an @FT_Library */
|
||||
/* structure is created. This function increments the counter. */
|
||||
/* @FT_Done_Library then only destroys a library if the counter is~1, */
|
||||
/* otherwise it simply decrements the counter. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function helps in managing life-cycles of structures which */
|
||||
/* reference @FT_Library objects. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a target library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Since> */
|
||||
/* 2.4.2 */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Reference_Library( FT_Library library );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_New_Library */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This function is used to create a new FreeType library instance */
|
||||
/* from a given memory object. It is thus possible to use libraries */
|
||||
/* with distinct memory allocators within the same program. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Normally, you would call this function (followed by a call to */
|
||||
/* @FT_Add_Default_Modules or a series of calls to @FT_Add_Module) */
|
||||
/* instead of @FT_Init_FreeType to initialize the FreeType library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Don't use @FT_Done_FreeType but @FT_Done_Library to destroy a */
|
||||
/* library instance. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* memory :: A handle to the original memory object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* alibrary :: A pointer to handle of a new library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* See the discussion of reference counters in the description of */
|
||||
/* @FT_Reference_Library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_New_Library( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
FT_Library *alibrary );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Library */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Discard a given library object. This closes all drivers and */
|
||||
/* discards all resource objects. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the target library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* See the discussion of reference counters in the description of */
|
||||
/* @FT_Reference_Library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Done_Library( FT_Library library );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_DebugHook_Func)( void* arg );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_Debug_Hook */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Set a debug hook function for debugging the interpreter of a font */
|
||||
/* format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* hook_index :: The index of the debug hook. You should use the */
|
||||
/* values defined in `ftobjs.h', e.g., */
|
||||
/* `FT_DEBUG_HOOK_TRUETYPE'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* debug_hook :: The function used to debug the interpreter. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* Currently, four debug hook slots are available, but only two (for */
|
||||
/* the TrueType and the Type~1 interpreter) are defined. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Since the internal headers of FreeType are no longer installed, */
|
||||
/* the symbol `FT_DEBUG_HOOK_TRUETYPE' isn't available publicly. */
|
||||
/* This is a bug and will be fixed in a forthcoming release. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Set_Debug_Hook( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_UInt hook_index,
|
||||
FT_DebugHook_Func debug_hook );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Add_Default_Modules */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Add the set of default drivers to a given library object. */
|
||||
/* This is only useful when you create a library object with */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Library (usually to plug a custom memory manager). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a new library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Add_Default_Modules( FT_Library library );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* truetype_engine
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* The TrueType Engine
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* TrueType bytecode support.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This section contains a function used to query the level of TrueType
|
||||
* bytecode support compiled in this version of the library.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_TrueTypeEngineType
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of values describing which kind of TrueType bytecode
|
||||
* engine is implemented in a given FT_Library instance. It is used
|
||||
* by the @FT_Get_TrueType_Engine_Type function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_NONE ::
|
||||
* The library doesn't implement any kind of bytecode interpreter.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_UNPATENTED ::
|
||||
* The library implements a bytecode interpreter that doesn't
|
||||
* support the patented operations of the TrueType virtual machine.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Its main use is to load certain Asian fonts which position and
|
||||
* scale glyph components with bytecode instructions. It produces
|
||||
* bad output for most other fonts.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_PATENTED ::
|
||||
* The library implements a bytecode interpreter that covers
|
||||
* the full instruction set of the TrueType virtual machine (this
|
||||
* was governed by patents until May 2010, hence the name).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.2
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_TrueTypeEngineType_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_NONE = 0,
|
||||
FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_UNPATENTED,
|
||||
FT_TRUETYPE_ENGINE_TYPE_PATENTED
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_TrueTypeEngineType;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @func:
|
||||
* FT_Get_TrueType_Engine_Type
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return an @FT_TrueTypeEngineType value to indicate which level of
|
||||
* the TrueType virtual machine a given library instance supports.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* library ::
|
||||
* A library instance.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* A value indicating which level is supported.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @since:
|
||||
* 2.2
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_TrueTypeEngineType )
|
||||
FT_Get_TrueType_Engine_Type( FT_Library library );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTMODAPI_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
155
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmoderr.h
Normal file
155
portlibs/include/freetype/ftmoderr.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,155 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftmoderr.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType module error offsets (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is used to define the FreeType module error offsets. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The lower byte gives the error code, the higher byte gives the */
|
||||
/* module. The base module has error offset 0. For example, the error */
|
||||
/* `FT_Err_Invalid_File_Format' has value 0x003, the error */
|
||||
/* `TT_Err_Invalid_File_Format' has value 0x1103, the error */
|
||||
/* `T1_Err_Invalid_File_Format' has value 0x1203, etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Undefine the macro FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS in ftoption.h */
|
||||
/* to make the higher byte always zero (disabling the module error */
|
||||
/* mechanism). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It can also be used to create a module error message table easily */
|
||||
/* with something like */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* #undef __FTMODERR_H__ */
|
||||
/* #define FT_MODERRDEF( e, v, s ) { FT_Mod_Err_ ## e, s }, */
|
||||
/* #define FT_MODERR_START_LIST { */
|
||||
/* #define FT_MODERR_END_LIST { 0, 0 } }; */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* const struct */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* int mod_err_offset; */
|
||||
/* const char* mod_err_msg */
|
||||
/* } ft_mod_errors[] = */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* #include FT_MODULE_ERRORS_H */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* To use such a table, all errors must be ANDed with 0xFF00 to remove */
|
||||
/* the error code. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTMODERR_H__
|
||||
#define __FTMODERR_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** SETUP MACROS *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FT_MODERRDEF
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_CONFIG_OPTION_USE_MODULE_ERRORS
|
||||
#define FT_MODERRDEF( e, v, s ) FT_Mod_Err_ ## e = v,
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FT_MODERRDEF( e, v, s ) FT_Mod_Err_ ## e = 0,
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_MODERR_START_LIST enum {
|
||||
#define FT_MODERR_END_LIST FT_Mod_Err_Max };
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
#define FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* !FT_MODERRDEF */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** LIST MODULE ERROR BASES *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_MODERR_START_LIST
|
||||
FT_MODERR_START_LIST
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Base, 0x000, "base module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Autofit, 0x100, "autofitter module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( BDF, 0x200, "BDF module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Cache, 0x300, "cache module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( CFF, 0x400, "CFF module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( CID, 0x500, "CID module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Gzip, 0x600, "Gzip module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( LZW, 0x700, "LZW module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( OTvalid, 0x800, "OpenType validation module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( PCF, 0x900, "PCF module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( PFR, 0xA00, "PFR module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( PSaux, 0xB00, "PS auxiliary module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( PShinter, 0xC00, "PS hinter module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( PSnames, 0xD00, "PS names module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Raster, 0xE00, "raster module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( SFNT, 0xF00, "SFNT module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Smooth, 0x1000, "smooth raster module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( TrueType, 0x1100, "TrueType module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Type1, 0x1200, "Type 1 module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Type42, 0x1300, "Type 42 module" )
|
||||
FT_MODERRDEF( Winfonts, 0x1400, "Windows FON/FNT module" )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_MODERR_END_LIST
|
||||
FT_MODERR_END_LIST
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/***** CLEANUP *****/
|
||||
/***** *****/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
/*******************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#undef FT_MODERR_START_LIST
|
||||
#undef FT_MODERR_END_LIST
|
||||
#undef FT_MODERRDEF
|
||||
#undef FT_NEED_EXTERN_C
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTMODERR_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
203
portlibs/include/freetype/ftotval.h
Normal file
203
portlibs/include/freetype/ftotval.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,203 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftotval.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for validating OpenType tables (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Warning: This module might be moved to a different library in the */
|
||||
/* future to avoid a tight dependency between FreeType and the */
|
||||
/* OpenType specification. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTOTVAL_H__
|
||||
#define __FTOTVAL_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* ot_validation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* OpenType Validation */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* An API to validate OpenType tables. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of functions to validate */
|
||||
/* some OpenType tables (BASE, GDEF, GPOS, GSUB, JSTF, MATH). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_OTXXX
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of bit-field constants used with @FT_OpenType_Validate to
|
||||
* indicate which OpenType tables should be validated.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_BASE ::
|
||||
* Validate BASE table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GDEF ::
|
||||
* Validate GDEF table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GPOS ::
|
||||
* Validate GPOS table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_GSUB ::
|
||||
* Validate GSUB table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_JSTF ::
|
||||
* Validate JSTF table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_MATH ::
|
||||
* Validate MATH table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_VALIDATE_OT ::
|
||||
* Validate all OpenType tables (BASE, GDEF, GPOS, GSUB, JSTF, MATH).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_BASE 0x0100
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GDEF 0x0200
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GPOS 0x0400
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_GSUB 0x0800
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_JSTF 0x1000
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_MATH 0x2000
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_VALIDATE_OT FT_VALIDATE_BASE | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_GDEF | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_GPOS | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_GSUB | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_JSTF | \
|
||||
FT_VALIDATE_MATH
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_OpenType_Validate
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Validate various OpenType tables to assure that all offsets and
|
||||
* indices are valid. The idea is that a higher-level library which
|
||||
* actually does the text layout can access those tables without
|
||||
* error checking (which can be quite time consuming).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* validation_flags ::
|
||||
* A bit field which specifies the tables to be validated. See
|
||||
* @FT_VALIDATE_OTXXX for possible values.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* BASE_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the BASE table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* GDEF_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the GDEF table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* GPOS_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the GPOS table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* GSUB_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the GSUB table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* JSTF_table ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the JSTF table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with OpenType fonts, returning an error
|
||||
* otherwise.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* After use, the application should deallocate the five tables with
|
||||
* @FT_OpenType_Free. A NULL value indicates that the table either
|
||||
* doesn't exist in the font, or the application hasn't asked for
|
||||
* validation.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_OpenType_Validate( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt validation_flags,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *BASE_table,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *GDEF_table,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *GPOS_table,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *GSUB_table,
|
||||
FT_Bytes *JSTF_table );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_OpenType_Free
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Free the buffer allocated by OpenType validator.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* table ::
|
||||
* The pointer to the buffer that is allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_OpenType_Validate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function must be used to free the buffer allocated by
|
||||
* @FT_OpenType_Validate only.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_OpenType_Free( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Bytes table );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTOTVAL_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
537
portlibs/include/freetype/ftoutln.h
Normal file
537
portlibs/include/freetype/ftoutln.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,537 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftoutln.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Support for the FT_Outline type used to store glyph shapes of */
|
||||
/* most scalable font formats (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTOUTLN_H__
|
||||
#define __FTOUTLN_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* outline_processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Outline Processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Functions to create, transform, and render vectorial glyph images. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains routines used to create and destroy scalable */
|
||||
/* glyph images known as `outlines'. These can also be measured, */
|
||||
/* transformed, and converted into bitmaps and pixmaps. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Order> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline */
|
||||
/* FT_OUTLINE_FLAGS */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_New */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Done */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Copy */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Translate */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Transform */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Embolden */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Reverse */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Check */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_CBox */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_BBox */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_Bitmap */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Render */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Decompose */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Funcs */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_MoveTo_Func */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_LineTo_Func */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_ConicTo_Func */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_CubicTo_Func */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Decompose */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Walk over an outline's structure to decompose it into individual */
|
||||
/* segments and Bézier arcs. This function also emits `move to' */
|
||||
/* operations to indicate the start of new contours in the outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the source target. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* func_interface :: A table of `emitters', i.e., function pointers */
|
||||
/* called during decomposition to indicate path */
|
||||
/* operations. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* user :: A typeless pointer which is passed to each */
|
||||
/* emitter during the decomposition. It can be */
|
||||
/* used to store the state during the */
|
||||
/* decomposition. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Decompose( FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
const FT_Outline_Funcs* func_interface,
|
||||
void* user );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_New */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Create a new outline of a given size. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object from where the */
|
||||
/* outline is allocated. Note however that the new */
|
||||
/* outline will *not* necessarily be *freed*, when */
|
||||
/* destroying the library, by @FT_Done_FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* numPoints :: The maximal number of points within the outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* numContours :: The maximal number of contours within the outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* anoutline :: A handle to the new outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The reason why this function takes a `library' parameter is simply */
|
||||
/* to use the library's memory allocator. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_New( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_UInt numPoints,
|
||||
FT_Int numContours,
|
||||
FT_Outline *anoutline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_New_Internal( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
FT_UInt numPoints,
|
||||
FT_Int numContours,
|
||||
FT_Outline *anoutline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Done */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Destroy an outline created with @FT_Outline_New. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle of the library object used to allocate the */
|
||||
/* outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the outline object to be discarded. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* If the outline's `owner' field is not set, only the outline */
|
||||
/* descriptor will be released. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The reason why this function takes an `library' parameter is */
|
||||
/* simply to use ft_mem_free(). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Done( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Done_Internal( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Check */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Check the contents of an outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A handle to a source outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Check( FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_CBox */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return an outline's `control box'. The control box encloses all */
|
||||
/* the outline's points, including Bézier control points. Though it */
|
||||
/* coincides with the exact bounding box for most glyphs, it can be */
|
||||
/* slightly larger in some situations (like when rotating an outline */
|
||||
/* which contains Bézier outside arcs). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Computing the control box is very fast, while getting the bounding */
|
||||
/* box can take much more time as it needs to walk over all segments */
|
||||
/* and arcs in the outline. To get the latter, you can use the */
|
||||
/* `ftbbox' component which is dedicated to this single task. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the source outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* acbox :: The outline's control box. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Get_CBox( const FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_BBox *acbox );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Translate */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Apply a simple translation to the points of an outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the target outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* xOffset :: The horizontal offset. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* yOffset :: The vertical offset. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Translate( const FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_Pos xOffset,
|
||||
FT_Pos yOffset );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Copy */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Copy an outline into another one. Both objects must have the */
|
||||
/* same sizes (number of points & number of contours) when this */
|
||||
/* function is called. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* source :: A handle to the source outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* target :: A handle to the target outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Copy( const FT_Outline* source,
|
||||
FT_Outline *target );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Transform */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Apply a simple 2x2 matrix to all of an outline's points. Useful */
|
||||
/* for applying rotations, slanting, flipping, etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the target outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* matrix :: A pointer to the transformation matrix. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* You can use @FT_Outline_Translate if you need to translate the */
|
||||
/* outline's points. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Transform( const FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
const FT_Matrix* matrix );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Embolden */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Embolden an outline. The new outline will be at most 4~times */
|
||||
/* `strength' pixels wider and higher. You may think of the left and */
|
||||
/* bottom borders as unchanged. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Negative `strength' values to reduce the outline thickness are */
|
||||
/* possible also. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A handle to the target outline. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* strength :: How strong the glyph is emboldened. Expressed in */
|
||||
/* 26.6 pixel format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The used algorithm to increase or decrease the thickness of the */
|
||||
/* glyph doesn't change the number of points; this means that certain */
|
||||
/* situations like acute angles or intersections are sometimes */
|
||||
/* handled incorrectly. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* If you need `better' metrics values you should call */
|
||||
/* @FT_Outline_Get_CBox ot @FT_Outline_Get_BBox. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Example call: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* FT_Load_Glyph( face, index, FT_LOAD_DEFAULT ); */
|
||||
/* if ( face->slot->format == FT_GLYPH_FORMAT_OUTLINE ) */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Embolden( &face->slot->outline, strength ); */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Embolden( FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_Pos strength );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Reverse */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Reverse the drawing direction of an outline. This is used to */
|
||||
/* ensure consistent fill conventions for mirrored glyphs. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the target outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function toggles the bit flag @FT_OUTLINE_REVERSE_FILL in */
|
||||
/* the outline's `flags' field. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It shouldn't be used by a normal client application, unless it */
|
||||
/* knows what it is doing. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Reverse( FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Get_Bitmap */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Render an outline within a bitmap. The outline's image is simply */
|
||||
/* OR-ed to the target bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a FreeType library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the source outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* abitmap :: A pointer to the target bitmap descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This function does NOT CREATE the bitmap, it only renders an */
|
||||
/* outline image within the one you pass to it! Consequently, the */
|
||||
/* various fields in `abitmap' should be set accordingly. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It will use the raster corresponding to the default glyph format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The value of the `num_grays' field in `abitmap' is ignored. If */
|
||||
/* you select the gray-level rasterizer, and you want less than 256 */
|
||||
/* gray levels, you have to use @FT_Outline_Render directly. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Get_Bitmap( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
const FT_Bitmap *abitmap );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Outline_Render */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Render an outline within a bitmap using the current scan-convert. */
|
||||
/* This function uses an @FT_Raster_Params structure as an argument, */
|
||||
/* allowing advanced features like direct composition, translucency, */
|
||||
/* etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to a FreeType library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* outline :: A pointer to the source outline descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* params :: A pointer to an @FT_Raster_Params structure used to */
|
||||
/* describe the rendering operation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* You should know what you are doing and how @FT_Raster_Params works */
|
||||
/* to use this function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The field `params.source' will be set to `outline' before the scan */
|
||||
/* converter is called, which means that the value you give to it is */
|
||||
/* actually ignored. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The gray-level rasterizer always uses 256 gray levels. If you */
|
||||
/* want less gray levels, you have to provide your own span callback. */
|
||||
/* See the @FT_RASTER_FLAG_DIRECT value of the `flags' field in the */
|
||||
/* @FT_Raster_Params structure for more details. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Render( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_Raster_Params* params );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_Orientation
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of values used to describe an outline's contour orientation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The TrueType and PostScript specifications use different conventions
|
||||
* to determine whether outline contours should be filled or unfilled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_ORIENTATION_TRUETYPE ::
|
||||
* According to the TrueType specification, clockwise contours must
|
||||
* be filled, and counter-clockwise ones must be unfilled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_ORIENTATION_POSTSCRIPT ::
|
||||
* According to the PostScript specification, counter-clockwise contours
|
||||
* must be filled, and clockwise ones must be unfilled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_ORIENTATION_FILL_RIGHT ::
|
||||
* This is identical to @FT_ORIENTATION_TRUETYPE, but is used to
|
||||
* remember that in TrueType, everything that is to the right of
|
||||
* the drawing direction of a contour must be filled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_ORIENTATION_FILL_LEFT ::
|
||||
* This is identical to @FT_ORIENTATION_POSTSCRIPT, but is used to
|
||||
* remember that in PostScript, everything that is to the left of
|
||||
* the drawing direction of a contour must be filled.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_ORIENTATION_NONE ::
|
||||
* The orientation cannot be determined. That is, different parts of
|
||||
* the glyph have different orientation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_Orientation_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_ORIENTATION_TRUETYPE = 0,
|
||||
FT_ORIENTATION_POSTSCRIPT = 1,
|
||||
FT_ORIENTATION_FILL_RIGHT = FT_ORIENTATION_TRUETYPE,
|
||||
FT_ORIENTATION_FILL_LEFT = FT_ORIENTATION_POSTSCRIPT,
|
||||
FT_ORIENTATION_NONE
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Orientation;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Outline_Get_Orientation
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This function analyzes a glyph outline and tries to compute its
|
||||
* fill orientation (see @FT_Orientation). This is done by computing
|
||||
* the direction of each global horizontal and/or vertical extrema
|
||||
* within the outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that this will return @FT_ORIENTATION_TRUETYPE for empty
|
||||
* outlines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The orientation.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Orientation )
|
||||
FT_Outline_Get_Orientation( FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTOUTLN_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Local Variables: */
|
||||
/* coding: utf-8 */
|
||||
/* End: */
|
172
portlibs/include/freetype/ftpfr.h
Normal file
172
portlibs/include/freetype/ftpfr.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,172 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftpfr.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for accessing PFR-specific data (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2008, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTPFR_H__
|
||||
#define __FTPFR_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* pfr_fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* PFR Fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* PFR/TrueDoc specific API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of PFR-specific functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_PFR_Metrics
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the outline and metrics resolutions of a given PFR face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: Handle to the input face. It can be a non-PFR face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* aoutline_resolution ::
|
||||
* Outline resolution. This is equivalent to `face->units_per_EM'
|
||||
* for non-PFR fonts. Optional (parameter can be NULL).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* ametrics_resolution ::
|
||||
* Metrics resolution. This is equivalent to `outline_resolution'
|
||||
* for non-PFR fonts. Optional (parameter can be NULL).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* ametrics_x_scale ::
|
||||
* A 16.16 fixed-point number used to scale distance expressed
|
||||
* in metrics units to device sub-pixels. This is equivalent to
|
||||
* `face->size->x_scale', but for metrics only. Optional (parameter
|
||||
* can be NULL).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* ametrics_y_scale ::
|
||||
* Same as `ametrics_x_scale' but for the vertical direction.
|
||||
* optional (parameter can be NULL).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If the input face is not a PFR, this function will return an error.
|
||||
* However, in all cases, it will return valid values.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_PFR_Metrics( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt *aoutline_resolution,
|
||||
FT_UInt *ametrics_resolution,
|
||||
FT_Fixed *ametrics_x_scale,
|
||||
FT_Fixed *ametrics_y_scale );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_PFR_Kerning
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the kerning pair corresponding to two glyphs in a PFR face.
|
||||
* The distance is expressed in metrics units, unlike the result of
|
||||
* @FT_Get_Kerning.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* left :: Index of the left glyph.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* right :: Index of the right glyph.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* avector :: A kerning vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function always return distances in original PFR metrics
|
||||
* units. This is unlike @FT_Get_Kerning with the @FT_KERNING_UNSCALED
|
||||
* mode, which always returns distances converted to outline units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You can use the value of the `x_scale' and `y_scale' parameters
|
||||
* returned by @FT_Get_PFR_Metrics to scale these to device sub-pixels.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_PFR_Kerning( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt left,
|
||||
FT_UInt right,
|
||||
FT_Vector *avector );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_PFR_Advance
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return a given glyph advance, expressed in original metrics units,
|
||||
* from a PFR font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* gindex :: The glyph index.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* aadvance :: The glyph advance in metrics units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* You can use the `x_scale' or `y_scale' results of @FT_Get_PFR_Metrics
|
||||
* to convert the advance to device sub-pixels (i.e., 1/64th of pixels).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_PFR_Advance( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt gindex,
|
||||
FT_Pos *aadvance );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTPFR_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
230
portlibs/include/freetype/ftrender.h
Normal file
230
portlibs/include/freetype/ftrender.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,230 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftrender.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType renderer modules public interface (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2005, 2006, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTRENDER_H__
|
||||
#define __FTRENDER_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_MODULE_H
|
||||
#include FT_GLYPH_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* module_management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* create a new glyph object */
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_InitFunc)( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot slot );
|
||||
|
||||
/* destroys a given glyph object */
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_DoneFunc)( FT_Glyph glyph );
|
||||
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_TransformFunc)( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
const FT_Matrix* matrix,
|
||||
const FT_Vector* delta );
|
||||
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_GetBBoxFunc)( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
FT_BBox* abbox );
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_CopyFunc)( FT_Glyph source,
|
||||
FT_Glyph target );
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Glyph_PrepareFunc)( FT_Glyph glyph,
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot slot );
|
||||
|
||||
/* deprecated */
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_Init_Func FT_Glyph_InitFunc
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_Done_Func FT_Glyph_DoneFunc
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_Transform_Func FT_Glyph_TransformFunc
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_BBox_Func FT_Glyph_GetBBoxFunc
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_Copy_Func FT_Glyph_CopyFunc
|
||||
#define FT_Glyph_Prepare_Func FT_Glyph_PrepareFunc
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
struct FT_Glyph_Class_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Long glyph_size;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Format glyph_format;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_InitFunc glyph_init;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_DoneFunc glyph_done;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_CopyFunc glyph_copy;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_TransformFunc glyph_transform;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_GetBBoxFunc glyph_bbox;
|
||||
FT_Glyph_PrepareFunc glyph_prepare;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Renderer_RenderFunc)( FT_Renderer renderer,
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot slot,
|
||||
FT_UInt mode,
|
||||
const FT_Vector* origin );
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Renderer_TransformFunc)( FT_Renderer renderer,
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot slot,
|
||||
const FT_Matrix* matrix,
|
||||
const FT_Vector* delta );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Renderer_GetCBoxFunc)( FT_Renderer renderer,
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot slot,
|
||||
FT_BBox* cbox );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
typedef FT_Error
|
||||
(*FT_Renderer_SetModeFunc)( FT_Renderer renderer,
|
||||
FT_ULong mode_tag,
|
||||
FT_Pointer mode_ptr );
|
||||
|
||||
/* deprecated identifiers */
|
||||
#define FTRenderer_render FT_Renderer_RenderFunc
|
||||
#define FTRenderer_transform FT_Renderer_TransformFunc
|
||||
#define FTRenderer_getCBox FT_Renderer_GetCBoxFunc
|
||||
#define FTRenderer_setMode FT_Renderer_SetModeFunc
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Renderer_Class */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The renderer module class descriptor. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* root :: The root @FT_Module_Class fields. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* glyph_format :: The glyph image format this renderer handles. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* render_glyph :: A method used to render the image that is in a */
|
||||
/* given glyph slot into a bitmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* transform_glyph :: A method used to transform the image that is in */
|
||||
/* a given glyph slot. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* get_glyph_cbox :: A method used to access the glyph's cbox. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* set_mode :: A method used to pass additional parameters. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* raster_class :: For @FT_GLYPH_FORMAT_OUTLINE renderers only. */
|
||||
/* This is a pointer to its raster's class. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Renderer_Class_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Module_Class root;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Format glyph_format;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Renderer_RenderFunc render_glyph;
|
||||
FT_Renderer_TransformFunc transform_glyph;
|
||||
FT_Renderer_GetCBoxFunc get_glyph_cbox;
|
||||
FT_Renderer_SetModeFunc set_mode;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Raster_Funcs* raster_class;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Renderer_Class;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Renderer */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the current renderer for a given glyph format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* format :: The glyph format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* A renderer handle. 0~if none found. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* An error will be returned if a module already exists by that name, */
|
||||
/* or if the module requires a version of FreeType that is too great. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* To add a new renderer, simply use @FT_Add_Module. To retrieve a */
|
||||
/* renderer by its name, use @FT_Get_Module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Renderer )
|
||||
FT_Get_Renderer( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Format format );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Set_Renderer */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Set the current renderer to use, and set additional mode. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <InOut> */
|
||||
/* library :: A handle to the library object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* renderer :: A handle to the renderer object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* num_params :: The number of additional parameters. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* parameters :: Additional parameters. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* In case of success, the renderer will be used to convert glyph */
|
||||
/* images in the renderer's known format into bitmaps. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This doesn't change the current renderer for other formats. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Set_Renderer( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Renderer renderer,
|
||||
FT_UInt num_params,
|
||||
FT_Parameter* parameters );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTRENDER_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
159
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsizes.h
Normal file
159
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsizes.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,159 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftsizes.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType size objects management (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Typical application would normally not need to use these functions. */
|
||||
/* However, they have been placed in a public API for the rare cases */
|
||||
/* where they are needed. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTSIZES_H__
|
||||
#define __FTSIZES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* sizes_management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Size Management */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Managing multiple sizes per face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* When creating a new face object (e.g., with @FT_New_Face), an */
|
||||
/* @FT_Size object is automatically created and used to store all */
|
||||
/* pixel-size dependent information, available in the `face->size' */
|
||||
/* field. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It is however possible to create more sizes for a given face, */
|
||||
/* mostly in order to manage several character pixel sizes of the */
|
||||
/* same font family and style. See @FT_New_Size and @FT_Done_Size. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that @FT_Set_Pixel_Sizes and @FT_Set_Char_Size only */
|
||||
/* modify the contents of the current `active' size; you thus need */
|
||||
/* to use @FT_Activate_Size to change it. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* 99% of applications won't need the functions provided here, */
|
||||
/* especially if they use the caching sub-system, so be cautious */
|
||||
/* when using these. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_New_Size */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Create a new size object from a given face object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to a parent face object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* asize :: A handle to a new size object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* You need to call @FT_Activate_Size in order to select the new size */
|
||||
/* for upcoming calls to @FT_Set_Pixel_Sizes, @FT_Set_Char_Size, */
|
||||
/* @FT_Load_Glyph, @FT_Load_Char, etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_New_Size( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Size* size );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Done_Size */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Discard a given size object. Note that @FT_Done_Face */
|
||||
/* automatically discards all size objects allocated with */
|
||||
/* @FT_New_Size. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* size :: A handle to a target size object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Done_Size( FT_Size size );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Activate_Size */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Even though it is possible to create several size objects for a */
|
||||
/* given face (see @FT_New_Size for details), functions like */
|
||||
/* @FT_Load_Glyph or @FT_Load_Char only use the one which has been */
|
||||
/* activated last to determine the `current character pixel size'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function can be used to `activate' a previously created size */
|
||||
/* object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* size :: A handle to a target size object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* If `face' is the size's parent face object, this function changes */
|
||||
/* the value of `face->size' to the input size handle. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Activate_Size( FT_Size size );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTSIZES_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
200
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsnames.h
Normal file
200
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsnames.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,200 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftsnames.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Simple interface to access SFNT name tables (which are used */
|
||||
/* to hold font names, copyright info, notices, etc.) (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This is _not_ used to retrieve glyph names! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2006, 2009, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FT_SFNT_NAMES_H__
|
||||
#define __FT_SFNT_NAMES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* sfnt_names */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* SFNT Names */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Access the names embedded in TrueType and OpenType files. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The TrueType and OpenType specifications allow the inclusion of */
|
||||
/* a special `names table' in font files. This table contains */
|
||||
/* textual (and internationalized) information regarding the font, */
|
||||
/* like family name, copyright, version, etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* The definitions below are used to access them if available. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that this has nothing to do with glyph names! */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_SfntName */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model an SFNT `name' table entry. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* platform_id :: The platform ID for `string'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* encoding_id :: The encoding ID for `string'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* language_id :: The language ID for `string'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* name_id :: An identifier for `string'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* string :: The `name' string. Note that its format differs */
|
||||
/* depending on the (platform,encoding) pair. It can */
|
||||
/* be a Pascal String, a UTF-16 one, etc. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Generally speaking, the string is not */
|
||||
/* zero-terminated. Please refer to the TrueType */
|
||||
/* specification for details. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* string_len :: The length of `string' in bytes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* Possible values for `platform_id', `encoding_id', `language_id', */
|
||||
/* and `name_id' are given in the file `ttnameid.h'. For details */
|
||||
/* please refer to the TrueType or OpenType specification. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* See also @TT_PLATFORM_XXX, @TT_APPLE_ID_XXX, @TT_MAC_ID_XXX, */
|
||||
/* @TT_ISO_ID_XXX, and @TT_MS_ID_XXX. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_SfntName_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UShort platform_id;
|
||||
FT_UShort encoding_id;
|
||||
FT_UShort language_id;
|
||||
FT_UShort name_id;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Byte* string; /* this string is *not* null-terminated! */
|
||||
FT_UInt string_len; /* in bytes */
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_SfntName;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Sfnt_Name_Count */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve the number of name strings in the SFNT `name' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* The number of strings in the `name' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_UInt )
|
||||
FT_Get_Sfnt_Name_Count( FT_Face face );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Sfnt_Name */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Retrieve a string of the SFNT `name' table for a given index. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* idx :: The index of the `name' string. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Output> */
|
||||
/* aname :: The indexed @FT_SfntName structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* FreeType error code. 0~means success. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The `string' array returned in the `aname' structure is not */
|
||||
/* null-terminated. The application should deallocate it if it is no */
|
||||
/* longer in use. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Use @FT_Get_Sfnt_Name_Count to get the total number of available */
|
||||
/* `name' table entries, then do a loop until you get the right */
|
||||
/* platform, encoding, and name ID. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_Sfnt_Name( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt idx,
|
||||
FT_SfntName *aname );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @constant:
|
||||
* FT_PARAM_TAG_IGNORE_PREFERRED_FAMILY
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A constant used as the tag of @FT_Parameter structures to make
|
||||
* FT_Open_Face() ignore preferred family subfamily names in `name'
|
||||
* table since OpenType version 1.4. For backwards compatibility with
|
||||
* legacy systems which has 4-face-per-family restriction.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_PARAM_TAG_IGNORE_PREFERRED_FAMILY FT_MAKE_TAG( 'i', 'g', 'p', 'f' )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @constant:
|
||||
* FT_PARAM_TAG_IGNORE_PREFERRED_SUBFAMILY
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A constant used as the tag of @FT_Parameter structures to make
|
||||
* FT_Open_Face() ignore preferred subfamily names in `name' table since
|
||||
* OpenType version 1.4. For backwards compatibility with legacy
|
||||
* systems which has 4-face-per-family restriction.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_PARAM_TAG_IGNORE_PREFERRED_SUBFAMILY FT_MAKE_TAG( 'i', 'g', 'p', 's' )
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FT_SFNT_NAMES_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
716
portlibs/include/freetype/ftstroke.h
Normal file
716
portlibs/include/freetype/ftstroke.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,716 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftstroke.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType path stroker (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2008, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FT_STROKE_H__
|
||||
#define __FT_STROKE_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_OUTLINE_H
|
||||
#include FT_GLYPH_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @section:
|
||||
* glyph_stroker
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @title:
|
||||
* Glyph Stroker
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @abstract:
|
||||
* Generating bordered and stroked glyphs.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This component generates stroked outlines of a given vectorial
|
||||
* glyph. It also allows you to retrieve the `outside' and/or the
|
||||
* `inside' borders of the stroke.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This can be useful to generate `bordered' glyph, i.e., glyphs
|
||||
* displayed with a coloured (and anti-aliased) border around their
|
||||
* shape.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Opaque handler to a path stroker object.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_StrokerRec_* FT_Stroker;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_LineJoin
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* These values determine how two joining lines are rendered
|
||||
* in a stroker.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_ROUND ::
|
||||
* Used to render rounded line joins. Circular arcs are used
|
||||
* to join two lines smoothly.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_BEVEL ::
|
||||
* Used to render beveled line joins; i.e., the two joining lines
|
||||
* are extended until they intersect.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_MITER ::
|
||||
* Same as beveled rendering, except that an additional line
|
||||
* break is added if the angle between the two joining lines
|
||||
* is too closed (this is useful to avoid unpleasant spikes
|
||||
* in beveled rendering).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_Stroker_LineJoin_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_ROUND = 0,
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_BEVEL,
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_MITER
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Stroker_LineJoin;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_LineCap
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* These values determine how the end of opened sub-paths are
|
||||
* rendered in a stroke.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINECAP_BUTT ::
|
||||
* The end of lines is rendered as a full stop on the last
|
||||
* point itself.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINECAP_ROUND ::
|
||||
* The end of lines is rendered as a half-circle around the
|
||||
* last point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_LINECAP_SQUARE ::
|
||||
* The end of lines is rendered as a square around the
|
||||
* last point.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_Stroker_LineCap_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINECAP_BUTT = 0,
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINECAP_ROUND,
|
||||
FT_STROKER_LINECAP_SQUARE
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Stroker_LineCap;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_StrokerBorder
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* These values are used to select a given stroke border
|
||||
* in @FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts and @FT_Stroker_ExportBorder.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_BORDER_LEFT ::
|
||||
* Select the left border, relative to the drawing direction.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_STROKER_BORDER_RIGHT ::
|
||||
* Select the right border, relative to the drawing direction.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* Applications are generally interested in the `inside' and `outside'
|
||||
* borders. However, there is no direct mapping between these and the
|
||||
* `left' and `right' ones, since this really depends on the glyph's
|
||||
* drawing orientation, which varies between font formats.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* You can however use @FT_Outline_GetInsideBorder and
|
||||
* @FT_Outline_GetOutsideBorder to get these.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef enum FT_StrokerBorder_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_STROKER_BORDER_LEFT = 0,
|
||||
FT_STROKER_BORDER_RIGHT
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_StrokerBorder;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Outline_GetInsideBorder
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the @FT_StrokerBorder value corresponding to the
|
||||
* `inside' borders of a given outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* The source outline handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The border index. @FT_STROKER_BORDER_RIGHT for empty or invalid
|
||||
* outlines.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_StrokerBorder )
|
||||
FT_Outline_GetInsideBorder( FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Outline_GetOutsideBorder
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the @FT_StrokerBorder value corresponding to the
|
||||
* `outside' borders of a given outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* The source outline handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The border index. @FT_STROKER_BORDER_LEFT for empty or invalid
|
||||
* outlines.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_StrokerBorder )
|
||||
FT_Outline_GetOutsideBorder( FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_New
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Create a new stroker object.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* library ::
|
||||
* FreeType library handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* astroker ::
|
||||
* A new stroker object handle. NULL in case of error.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_New( FT_Library library,
|
||||
FT_Stroker *astroker );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_Set
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Reset a stroker object's attributes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* radius ::
|
||||
* The border radius.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* line_cap ::
|
||||
* The line cap style.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* line_join ::
|
||||
* The line join style.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* miter_limit ::
|
||||
* The miter limit for the FT_STROKER_LINEJOIN_MITER style,
|
||||
* expressed as 16.16 fixed point value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The radius is expressed in the same units as the outline
|
||||
* coordinates.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_Set( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Fixed radius,
|
||||
FT_Stroker_LineCap line_cap,
|
||||
FT_Stroker_LineJoin line_join,
|
||||
FT_Fixed miter_limit );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_Rewind
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Reset a stroker object without changing its attributes.
|
||||
* You should call this function before beginning a new
|
||||
* series of calls to @FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath or
|
||||
* @FT_Stroker_EndSubPath.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_Rewind( FT_Stroker stroker );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_ParseOutline
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A convenience function used to parse a whole outline with
|
||||
* the stroker. The resulting outline(s) can be retrieved
|
||||
* later by functions like @FT_Stroker_GetCounts and @FT_Stroker_Export.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* The source outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* opened ::
|
||||
* A boolean. If~1, the outline is treated as an open path instead
|
||||
* of a closed one.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If `opened' is~0 (the default), the outline is treated as a closed
|
||||
* path, and the stroker generates two distinct `border' outlines.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If `opened' is~1, the outline is processed as an open path, and the
|
||||
* stroker generates a single `stroke' outline.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function calls @FT_Stroker_Rewind automatically.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_ParseOutline( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline,
|
||||
FT_Bool opened );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Start a new sub-path in the stroker.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* to ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the start vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* open ::
|
||||
* A boolean. If~1, the sub-path is treated as an open one.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function is useful when you need to stroke a path that is
|
||||
* not stored as an @FT_Outline object.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Vector* to,
|
||||
FT_Bool open );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_EndSubPath
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Close the current sub-path in the stroker.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* You should call this function after @FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath.
|
||||
* If the subpath was not `opened', this function `draws' a
|
||||
* single line segment to the start position when needed.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_EndSubPath( FT_Stroker stroker );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_LineTo
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* `Draw' a single line segment in the stroker's current sub-path,
|
||||
* from the last position.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* to ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the destination point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* You should call this function between @FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath and
|
||||
* @FT_Stroker_EndSubPath.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_LineTo( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Vector* to );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_ConicTo
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* `Draw' a single quadratic Bézier in the stroker's current sub-path,
|
||||
* from the last position.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* control ::
|
||||
* A pointer to a Bézier control point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* to ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the destination point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* You should call this function between @FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath and
|
||||
* @FT_Stroker_EndSubPath.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_ConicTo( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Vector* control,
|
||||
FT_Vector* to );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_CubicTo
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* `Draw' a single cubic Bézier in the stroker's current sub-path,
|
||||
* from the last position.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* control1 ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the first Bézier control point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* control2 ::
|
||||
* A pointer to second Bézier control point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* to ::
|
||||
* A pointer to the destination point.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* You should call this function between @FT_Stroker_BeginSubPath and
|
||||
* @FT_Stroker_EndSubPath.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_CubicTo( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Vector* control1,
|
||||
FT_Vector* control2,
|
||||
FT_Vector* to );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Call this function once you have finished parsing your paths
|
||||
* with the stroker. It returns the number of points and
|
||||
* contours necessary to export one of the `border' or `stroke'
|
||||
* outlines generated by the stroker.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* border ::
|
||||
* The border index.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* anum_points ::
|
||||
* The number of points.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* anum_contours ::
|
||||
* The number of contours.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* When an outline, or a sub-path, is `closed', the stroker generates
|
||||
* two independent `border' outlines, named `left' and `right'.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When the outline, or a sub-path, is `opened', the stroker merges
|
||||
* the `border' outlines with caps. The `left' border receives all
|
||||
* points, while the `right' border becomes empty.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Use the function @FT_Stroker_GetCounts instead if you want to
|
||||
* retrieve the counts associated to both borders.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_StrokerBorder border,
|
||||
FT_UInt *anum_points,
|
||||
FT_UInt *anum_contours );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_ExportBorder
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Call this function after @FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts to
|
||||
* export the corresponding border to your own @FT_Outline
|
||||
* structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that this function appends the border points and
|
||||
* contours to your outline, but does not try to resize its
|
||||
* arrays.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* border ::
|
||||
* The border index.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* The target outline handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* Always call this function after @FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts to
|
||||
* get sure that there is enough room in your @FT_Outline object to
|
||||
* receive all new data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When an outline, or a sub-path, is `closed', the stroker generates
|
||||
* two independent `border' outlines, named `left' and `right'
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When the outline, or a sub-path, is `opened', the stroker merges
|
||||
* the `border' outlines with caps. The `left' border receives all
|
||||
* points, while the `right' border becomes empty.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Use the function @FT_Stroker_Export instead if you want to
|
||||
* retrieve all borders at once.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_ExportBorder( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_StrokerBorder border,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_GetCounts
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Call this function once you have finished parsing your paths
|
||||
* with the stroker. It returns the number of points and
|
||||
* contours necessary to export all points/borders from the stroked
|
||||
* outline/path.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* anum_points ::
|
||||
* The number of points.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* anum_contours ::
|
||||
* The number of contours.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_GetCounts( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_UInt *anum_points,
|
||||
FT_UInt *anum_contours );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_Export
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Call this function after @FT_Stroker_GetBorderCounts to
|
||||
* export all borders to your own @FT_Outline structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that this function appends the border points and
|
||||
* contours to your outline, but does not try to resize its
|
||||
* arrays.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* The target stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* outline ::
|
||||
* The target outline handle.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_Export( FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Outline* outline );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Stroker_Done
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Destroy a stroker object.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* A stroker handle. Can be NULL.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Stroker_Done( FT_Stroker stroker );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Glyph_Stroke
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Stroke a given outline glyph object with a given stroker.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @inout:
|
||||
* pglyph ::
|
||||
* Source glyph handle on input, new glyph handle on output.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* A stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* destroy ::
|
||||
* A Boolean. If~1, the source glyph object is destroyed
|
||||
* on success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The source glyph is untouched in case of error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_Stroke( FT_Glyph *pglyph,
|
||||
FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Bool destroy );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Glyph_StrokeBorder
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Stroke a given outline glyph object with a given stroker, but
|
||||
* only return either its inside or outside border.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @inout:
|
||||
* pglyph ::
|
||||
* Source glyph handle on input, new glyph handle on output.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stroker ::
|
||||
* A stroker handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* inside ::
|
||||
* A Boolean. If~1, return the inside border, otherwise
|
||||
* the outside border.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* destroy ::
|
||||
* A Boolean. If~1, the source glyph object is destroyed
|
||||
* on success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The source glyph is untouched in case of error.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Glyph_StrokeBorder( FT_Glyph *pglyph,
|
||||
FT_Stroker stroker,
|
||||
FT_Bool inside,
|
||||
FT_Bool destroy );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FT_STROKE_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Local Variables: */
|
||||
/* coding: utf-8 */
|
||||
/* End: */
|
80
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsynth.h
Normal file
80
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsynth.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftsynth.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType synthesizing code for emboldening and slanting */
|
||||
/* (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2000-2001, 2003, 2006, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/********* *********/
|
||||
/********* WARNING, THIS IS ALPHA CODE! THIS API *********/
|
||||
/********* IS DUE TO CHANGE UNTIL STRICTLY NOTIFIED BY THE *********/
|
||||
/********* FREETYPE DEVELOPMENT TEAM *********/
|
||||
/********* *********/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Main reason for not lifting the functions in this module to a */
|
||||
/* `standard' API is that the used parameters for emboldening and */
|
||||
/* slanting are not configurable. Consider the functions as a */
|
||||
/* code resource which should be copied into the application and */
|
||||
/* adapted to the particular needs. */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTSYNTH_H__
|
||||
#define __FTSYNTH_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/* Embolden a glyph by a `reasonable' value (which is highly a matter of */
|
||||
/* taste). This function is actually a convenience function, providing */
|
||||
/* a wrapper for @FT_Outline_Embolden and @FT_Bitmap_Embolden. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* For emboldened outlines the metrics are estimates only; if you need */
|
||||
/* precise values you should call @FT_Outline_Get_CBox. */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot_Embolden( FT_GlyphSlot slot );
|
||||
|
||||
/* Slant an outline glyph to the right by about 12 degrees. */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_GlyphSlot_Oblique( FT_GlyphSlot slot );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTSYNTH_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
347
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsystem.h
Normal file
347
portlibs/include/freetype/ftsystem.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,347 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftsystem.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType low-level system interface definition (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2005, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTSYSTEM_H__
|
||||
#define __FTSYSTEM_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* system_interface */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* System Interface */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* How FreeType manages memory and i/o. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains various definitions related to memory */
|
||||
/* management and i/o access. You need to understand this */
|
||||
/* information if you want to use a custom memory manager or you own */
|
||||
/* i/o streams. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* M E M O R Y M A N A G E M E N T */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Memory
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A handle to a given memory manager object, defined with an
|
||||
* @FT_MemoryRec structure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_MemoryRec_* FT_Memory;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @functype:
|
||||
* FT_Alloc_Func
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to allocate `size' bytes from `memory'.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* memory ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source memory manager.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* size ::
|
||||
* The size in bytes to allocate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* Address of new memory block. 0~in case of failure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef void*
|
||||
(*FT_Alloc_Func)( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
long size );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @functype:
|
||||
* FT_Free_Func
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to release a given block of memory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* memory ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source memory manager.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* block ::
|
||||
* The address of the target memory block.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Free_Func)( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
void* block );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @functype:
|
||||
* FT_Realloc_Func
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to re-allocate a given block of memory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* memory ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source memory manager.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* cur_size ::
|
||||
* The block's current size in bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* new_size ::
|
||||
* The block's requested new size.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* block ::
|
||||
* The block's current address.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* New block address. 0~in case of memory shortage.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* In case of error, the old block must still be available.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef void*
|
||||
(*FT_Realloc_Func)( FT_Memory memory,
|
||||
long cur_size,
|
||||
long new_size,
|
||||
void* block );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_MemoryRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A structure used to describe a given memory manager to FreeType~2.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @fields:
|
||||
* user ::
|
||||
* A generic typeless pointer for user data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* alloc ::
|
||||
* A pointer type to an allocation function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* free ::
|
||||
* A pointer type to an memory freeing function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* realloc ::
|
||||
* A pointer type to a reallocation function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct FT_MemoryRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
void* user;
|
||||
FT_Alloc_Func alloc;
|
||||
FT_Free_Func free;
|
||||
FT_Realloc_Func realloc;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* I / O M A N A G E M E N T */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Stream
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A handle to an input stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_StreamRec_* FT_Stream;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_StreamDesc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A union type used to store either a long or a pointer. This is used
|
||||
* to store a file descriptor or a `FILE*' in an input stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef union FT_StreamDesc_
|
||||
{
|
||||
long value;
|
||||
void* pointer;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_StreamDesc;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @functype:
|
||||
* FT_Stream_IoFunc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to seek and read data from a given input stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stream ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* offset ::
|
||||
* The offset of read in stream (always from start).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* buffer ::
|
||||
* The address of the read buffer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* count ::
|
||||
* The number of bytes to read from the stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The number of bytes effectively read by the stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function might be called to perform a seek or skip operation
|
||||
* with a `count' of~0. A non-zero return value then indicates an
|
||||
* error.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef unsigned long
|
||||
(*FT_Stream_IoFunc)( FT_Stream stream,
|
||||
unsigned long offset,
|
||||
unsigned char* buffer,
|
||||
unsigned long count );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @functype:
|
||||
* FT_Stream_CloseFunc
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A function used to close a given input stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* stream ::
|
||||
* A handle to the target stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef void
|
||||
(*FT_Stream_CloseFunc)( FT_Stream stream );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @struct:
|
||||
* FT_StreamRec
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A structure used to describe an input stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* base ::
|
||||
* For memory-based streams, this is the address of the first stream
|
||||
* byte in memory. This field should always be set to NULL for
|
||||
* disk-based streams.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* size ::
|
||||
* The stream size in bytes.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* pos ::
|
||||
* The current position within the stream.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* descriptor ::
|
||||
* This field is a union that can hold an integer or a pointer. It is
|
||||
* used by stream implementations to store file descriptors or `FILE*'
|
||||
* pointers.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* pathname ::
|
||||
* This field is completely ignored by FreeType. However, it is often
|
||||
* useful during debugging to use it to store the stream's filename
|
||||
* (where available).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* read ::
|
||||
* The stream's input function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* close ::
|
||||
* The stream's close function.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* memory ::
|
||||
* The memory manager to use to preload frames. This is set
|
||||
* internally by FreeType and shouldn't be touched by stream
|
||||
* implementations.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* cursor ::
|
||||
* This field is set and used internally by FreeType when parsing
|
||||
* frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* limit ::
|
||||
* This field is set and used internally by FreeType when parsing
|
||||
* frames.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct FT_StreamRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
unsigned char* base;
|
||||
unsigned long size;
|
||||
unsigned long pos;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_StreamDesc descriptor;
|
||||
FT_StreamDesc pathname;
|
||||
FT_Stream_IoFunc read;
|
||||
FT_Stream_CloseFunc close;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Memory memory;
|
||||
unsigned char* cursor;
|
||||
unsigned char* limit;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_StreamRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTSYSTEM_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
350
portlibs/include/freetype/fttrigon.h
Normal file
350
portlibs/include/freetype/fttrigon.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,350 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* fttrigon.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType trigonometric functions (specification). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2001, 2003, 2005, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTTRIGON_H__
|
||||
#define __FTTRIGON_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* computations */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @type:
|
||||
* FT_Angle
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* This type is used to model angle values in FreeType. Note that the
|
||||
* angle is a 16.16 fixed float value expressed in degrees.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef FT_Fixed FT_Angle;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ANGLE_PI
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The angle pi expressed in @FT_Angle units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ANGLE_PI ( 180L << 16 )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ANGLE_2PI
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The angle 2*pi expressed in @FT_Angle units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ANGLE_2PI ( FT_ANGLE_PI * 2 )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ANGLE_PI2
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The angle pi/2 expressed in @FT_Angle units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ANGLE_PI2 ( FT_ANGLE_PI / 2 )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @macro:
|
||||
* FT_ANGLE_PI4
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* The angle pi/4 expressed in @FT_Angle units.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_ANGLE_PI4 ( FT_ANGLE_PI / 4 )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Sin
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the sinus of a given angle in fixed point format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The input angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The sinus value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If you need both the sinus and cosinus for a given angle, use the
|
||||
* function @FT_Vector_Unit.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Fixed )
|
||||
FT_Sin( FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Cos
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the cosinus of a given angle in fixed point format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The input angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The cosinus value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If you need both the sinus and cosinus for a given angle, use the
|
||||
* function @FT_Vector_Unit.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Fixed )
|
||||
FT_Cos( FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Tan
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the tangent of a given angle in fixed point format.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The input angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The tangent value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Fixed )
|
||||
FT_Tan( FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Atan2
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the arc-tangent corresponding to a given vector (x,y) in
|
||||
* the 2d plane.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* x ::
|
||||
* The horizontal vector coordinate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* y ::
|
||||
* The vertical vector coordinate.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The arc-tangent value (i.e. angle).
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Angle )
|
||||
FT_Atan2( FT_Fixed x,
|
||||
FT_Fixed y );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Angle_Diff
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the difference between two angles. The result is always
|
||||
* constrained to the ]-PI..PI] interval.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle1 ::
|
||||
* First angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* angle2 ::
|
||||
* Second angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* Constrained value of `value2-value1'.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Angle )
|
||||
FT_Angle_Diff( FT_Angle angle1,
|
||||
FT_Angle angle2 );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Vector_Unit
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the unit vector corresponding to a given angle. After the
|
||||
* call, the value of `vec.x' will be `sin(angle)', and the value of
|
||||
* `vec.y' will be `cos(angle)'.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This function is useful to retrieve both the sinus and cosinus of a
|
||||
* given angle quickly.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* vec ::
|
||||
* The address of target vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The address of angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Vector_Unit( FT_Vector* vec,
|
||||
FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Vector_Rotate
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Rotate a vector by a given angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @inout:
|
||||
* vec ::
|
||||
* The address of target vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The address of angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Vector_Rotate( FT_Vector* vec,
|
||||
FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Vector_Length
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return the length of a given vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* vec ::
|
||||
* The address of target vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* The vector length, expressed in the same units that the original
|
||||
* vector coordinates.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Fixed )
|
||||
FT_Vector_Length( FT_Vector* vec );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Vector_Polarize
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Compute both the length and angle of a given vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* vec ::
|
||||
* The address of source vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* length ::
|
||||
* The vector length.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The vector angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Vector_Polarize( FT_Vector* vec,
|
||||
FT_Fixed *length,
|
||||
FT_Angle *angle );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Vector_From_Polar
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Compute vector coordinates from a length and angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* vec ::
|
||||
* The address of source vector.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* length ::
|
||||
* The vector length.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* angle ::
|
||||
* The vector angle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void )
|
||||
FT_Vector_From_Polar( FT_Vector* vec,
|
||||
FT_Fixed length,
|
||||
FT_Angle angle );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTTRIGON_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
588
portlibs/include/freetype/fttypes.h
Normal file
588
portlibs/include/freetype/fttypes.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,588 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* fttypes.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType simple types definitions (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2004, 2006, 2007, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTTYPES_H__
|
||||
#define __FTTYPES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_CONFIG_CONFIG_H
|
||||
#include FT_SYSTEM_H
|
||||
#include FT_IMAGE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* basic_types */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Basic Data Types */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* The basic data types defined by the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the basic data types defined by FreeType~2, */
|
||||
/* ranging from simple scalar types to bitmap descriptors. More */
|
||||
/* font-specific structures are defined in a different section. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Order> */
|
||||
/* FT_Byte */
|
||||
/* FT_Bytes */
|
||||
/* FT_Char */
|
||||
/* FT_Int */
|
||||
/* FT_UInt */
|
||||
/* FT_Int16 */
|
||||
/* FT_UInt16 */
|
||||
/* FT_Int32 */
|
||||
/* FT_UInt32 */
|
||||
/* FT_Short */
|
||||
/* FT_UShort */
|
||||
/* FT_Long */
|
||||
/* FT_ULong */
|
||||
/* FT_Bool */
|
||||
/* FT_Offset */
|
||||
/* FT_PtrDist */
|
||||
/* FT_String */
|
||||
/* FT_Tag */
|
||||
/* FT_Error */
|
||||
/* FT_Fixed */
|
||||
/* FT_Pointer */
|
||||
/* FT_Pos */
|
||||
/* FT_Vector */
|
||||
/* FT_BBox */
|
||||
/* FT_Matrix */
|
||||
/* FT_FWord */
|
||||
/* FT_UFWord */
|
||||
/* FT_F2Dot14 */
|
||||
/* FT_UnitVector */
|
||||
/* FT_F26Dot6 */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Generic */
|
||||
/* FT_Generic_Finalizer */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FT_Bitmap */
|
||||
/* FT_Pixel_Mode */
|
||||
/* FT_Palette_Mode */
|
||||
/* FT_Glyph_Format */
|
||||
/* FT_IMAGE_TAG */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bool */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef of unsigned char, used for simple booleans. As usual, */
|
||||
/* values 1 and~0 represent true and false, respectively. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned char FT_Bool;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_FWord */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A signed 16-bit integer used to store a distance in original font */
|
||||
/* units. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed short FT_FWord; /* distance in FUnits */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_UFWord */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* An unsigned 16-bit integer used to store a distance in original */
|
||||
/* font units. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned short FT_UFWord; /* unsigned distance */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Char */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple typedef for the _signed_ char type. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed char FT_Char;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Byte */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple typedef for the _unsigned_ char type. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned char FT_Byte;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Bytes */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for constant memory areas. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef const FT_Byte* FT_Bytes;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Tag */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for 32-bit tags (as used in the SFNT format). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef FT_UInt32 FT_Tag;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_String */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple typedef for the char type, usually used for strings. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef char FT_String;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Short */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for signed short. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed short FT_Short;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_UShort */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for unsigned short. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned short FT_UShort;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Int */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for the int type. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed int FT_Int;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_UInt */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for the unsigned int type. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned int FT_UInt;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Long */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for signed long. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed long FT_Long;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_ULong */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A typedef for unsigned long. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef unsigned long FT_ULong;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_F2Dot14 */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A signed 2.14 fixed float type used for unit vectors. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed short FT_F2Dot14;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_F26Dot6 */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A signed 26.6 fixed float type used for vectorial pixel */
|
||||
/* coordinates. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed long FT_F26Dot6;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Fixed */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This type is used to store 16.16 fixed float values, like scaling */
|
||||
/* values or matrix coefficients. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef signed long FT_Fixed;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Error */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The FreeType error code type. A value of~0 is always interpreted */
|
||||
/* as a successful operation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef int FT_Error;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Pointer */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple typedef for a typeless pointer. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef void* FT_Pointer;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_Offset */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This is equivalent to the ANSI~C `size_t' type, i.e., the largest */
|
||||
/* _unsigned_ integer type used to express a file size or position, */
|
||||
/* or a memory block size. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef size_t FT_Offset;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_PtrDist */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This is equivalent to the ANSI~C `ptrdiff_t' type, i.e., the */
|
||||
/* largest _signed_ integer type used to express the distance */
|
||||
/* between two pointers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef ft_ptrdiff_t FT_PtrDist;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_UnitVector */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple structure used to store a 2D vector unit vector. Uses */
|
||||
/* FT_F2Dot14 types. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* x :: Horizontal coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* y :: Vertical coordinate. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_UnitVector_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_F2Dot14 x;
|
||||
FT_F2Dot14 y;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_UnitVector;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Matrix */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A simple structure used to store a 2x2 matrix. Coefficients are */
|
||||
/* in 16.16 fixed float format. The computation performed is: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* { */
|
||||
/* x' = x*xx + y*xy */
|
||||
/* y' = x*yx + y*yy */
|
||||
/* } */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* xx :: Matrix coefficient. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* xy :: Matrix coefficient. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* yx :: Matrix coefficient. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* yy :: Matrix coefficient. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Matrix_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed xx, xy;
|
||||
FT_Fixed yx, yy;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Matrix;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Data */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Read-only binary data represented as a pointer and a length. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* pointer :: The data. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* length :: The length of the data in bytes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Data_
|
||||
{
|
||||
const FT_Byte* pointer;
|
||||
FT_Int length;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Data;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <FuncType> */
|
||||
/* FT_Generic_Finalizer */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Describe a function used to destroy the `client' data of any */
|
||||
/* FreeType object. See the description of the @FT_Generic type for */
|
||||
/* details of usage. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* The address of the FreeType object which is under finalization. */
|
||||
/* Its client data is accessed through its `generic' field. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef void (*FT_Generic_Finalizer)(void* object);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_Generic */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Client applications often need to associate their own data to a */
|
||||
/* variety of FreeType core objects. For example, a text layout API */
|
||||
/* might want to associate a glyph cache to a given size object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Most FreeType object contains a `generic' field, of type */
|
||||
/* FT_Generic, which usage is left to client applications and font */
|
||||
/* servers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It can be used to store a pointer to client-specific data, as well */
|
||||
/* as the address of a `finalizer' function, which will be called by */
|
||||
/* FreeType when the object is destroyed (for example, the previous */
|
||||
/* client example would put the address of the glyph cache destructor */
|
||||
/* in the `finalizer' field). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* data :: A typeless pointer to any client-specified data. This */
|
||||
/* field is completely ignored by the FreeType library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* finalizer :: A pointer to a `generic finalizer' function, which */
|
||||
/* will be called when the object is destroyed. If this */
|
||||
/* field is set to NULL, no code will be called. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_Generic_
|
||||
{
|
||||
void* data;
|
||||
FT_Generic_Finalizer finalizer;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Generic;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Macro> */
|
||||
/* FT_MAKE_TAG */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This macro converts four-letter tags which are used to label */
|
||||
/* TrueType tables into an unsigned long to be used within FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The produced values *must* be 32-bit integers. Don't redefine */
|
||||
/* this macro. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
#define FT_MAKE_TAG( _x1, _x2, _x3, _x4 ) \
|
||||
(FT_Tag) \
|
||||
( ( (FT_ULong)_x1 << 24 ) | \
|
||||
( (FT_ULong)_x2 << 16 ) | \
|
||||
( (FT_ULong)_x3 << 8 ) | \
|
||||
(FT_ULong)_x4 )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* L I S T M A N A G E M E N T */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* list_processing */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_ListNode */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Many elements and objects in FreeType are listed through an */
|
||||
/* @FT_List record (see @FT_ListRec). As its name suggests, an */
|
||||
/* FT_ListNode is a handle to a single list element. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_ListNodeRec_* FT_ListNode;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Type> */
|
||||
/* FT_List */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to a list record (see @FT_ListRec). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_ListRec_* FT_List;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_ListNodeRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to hold a single list element. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* prev :: The previous element in the list. NULL if first. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* next :: The next element in the list. NULL if last. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* data :: A typeless pointer to the listed object. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_ListNodeRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_ListNode prev;
|
||||
FT_ListNode next;
|
||||
void* data;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_ListNodeRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_ListRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to hold a simple doubly-linked list. These are */
|
||||
/* used in many parts of FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* head :: The head (first element) of doubly-linked list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* tail :: The tail (last element) of doubly-linked list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_ListRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_ListNode head;
|
||||
FT_ListNode tail;
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_ListRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_IS_EMPTY( list ) ( (list).head == 0 )
|
||||
|
||||
/* return base error code (without module-specific prefix) */
|
||||
#define FT_ERROR_BASE( x ) ( (x) & 0xFF )
|
||||
|
||||
/* return module error code */
|
||||
#define FT_ERROR_MODULE( x ) ( (x) & 0xFF00U )
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_BOOL( x ) ( (FT_Bool)( x ) )
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTTYPES_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
274
portlibs/include/freetype/ftwinfnt.h
Normal file
274
portlibs/include/freetype/ftwinfnt.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,274 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftwinfnt.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* FreeType API for accessing Windows fnt-specific data. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2003, 2004, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTWINFNT_H__
|
||||
#define __FTWINFNT_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* winfnt_fonts */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Window FNT Files */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Windows FNT specific API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the declaration of Windows FNT specific */
|
||||
/* functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @enum:
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_XXX
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A list of valid values for the `charset' byte in
|
||||
* @FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec. Exact mapping tables for the various cpXXXX
|
||||
* encodings (except for cp1361) can be found at ftp://ftp.unicode.org
|
||||
* in the MAPPINGS/VENDORS/MICSFT/WINDOWS subdirectory. cp1361 is
|
||||
* roughly a superset of MAPPINGS/OBSOLETE/EASTASIA/KSC/JOHAB.TXT.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @values:
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_DEFAULT ::
|
||||
* This is used for font enumeration and font creation as a
|
||||
* `don't care' value. Valid font files don't contain this value.
|
||||
* When querying for information about the character set of the font
|
||||
* that is currently selected into a specified device context, this
|
||||
* return value (of the related Windows API) simply denotes failure.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_SYMBOL ::
|
||||
* There is no known mapping table available.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_MAC ::
|
||||
* Mac Roman encoding.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_OEM ::
|
||||
* From Michael Pöttgen <michael@poettgen.de>:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The `Windows Font Mapping' article says that FT_WinFNT_ID_OEM
|
||||
* is used for the charset of vector fonts, like `modern.fon',
|
||||
* `roman.fon', and `script.fon' on Windows.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The `CreateFont' documentation says: The FT_WinFNT_ID_OEM value
|
||||
* specifies a character set that is operating-system dependent.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* The `IFIMETRICS' documentation from the `Windows Driver
|
||||
* Development Kit' says: This font supports an OEM-specific
|
||||
* character set. The OEM character set is system dependent.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* In general OEM, as opposed to ANSI (i.e., cp1252), denotes the
|
||||
* second default codepage that most international versions of
|
||||
* Windows have. It is one of the OEM codepages from
|
||||
*
|
||||
* http://www.microsoft.com/globaldev/reference/cphome.mspx,
|
||||
*
|
||||
* and is used for the `DOS boxes', to support legacy applications.
|
||||
* A German Windows version for example usually uses ANSI codepage
|
||||
* 1252 and OEM codepage 850.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP874 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Thai TIS 620 and ISO 8859-11.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP932 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Japanese Shift-JIS (with minor deviations).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP936 ::
|
||||
* A superset of simplified Chinese GB 2312-1980 (with different
|
||||
* ordering and minor deviations).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP949 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Korean Hangul KS~C 5601-1987 (with different
|
||||
* ordering and minor deviations).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP950 ::
|
||||
* A superset of traditional Chinese Big~5 ETen (with different
|
||||
* ordering and minor deviations).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1250 ::
|
||||
* A superset of East European ISO 8859-2 (with slightly different
|
||||
* ordering).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1251 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Russian ISO 8859-5 (with different ordering).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1252 ::
|
||||
* ANSI encoding. A superset of ISO 8859-1.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1253 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Greek ISO 8859-7 (with minor modifications).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1254 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Turkish ISO 8859-9.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1255 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Hebrew ISO 8859-8 (with some modifications).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1256 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Arabic ISO 8859-6 (with different ordering).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1257 ::
|
||||
* A superset of Baltic ISO 8859-13 (with some deviations).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1258 ::
|
||||
* For Vietnamese. This encoding doesn't cover all necessary
|
||||
* characters.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1361 ::
|
||||
* Korean (Johab).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1252 0
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_DEFAULT 1
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_SYMBOL 2
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_MAC 77
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP932 128
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP949 129
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1361 130
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP936 134
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP950 136
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1253 161
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1254 162
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1258 163
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1255 177
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1256 178
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1257 186
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1251 204
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP874 222
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_CP1250 238
|
||||
#define FT_WinFNT_ID_OEM 255
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Windows FNT Header info. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UShort version;
|
||||
FT_ULong file_size;
|
||||
FT_Byte copyright[60];
|
||||
FT_UShort file_type;
|
||||
FT_UShort nominal_point_size;
|
||||
FT_UShort vertical_resolution;
|
||||
FT_UShort horizontal_resolution;
|
||||
FT_UShort ascent;
|
||||
FT_UShort internal_leading;
|
||||
FT_UShort external_leading;
|
||||
FT_Byte italic;
|
||||
FT_Byte underline;
|
||||
FT_Byte strike_out;
|
||||
FT_UShort weight;
|
||||
FT_Byte charset;
|
||||
FT_UShort pixel_width;
|
||||
FT_UShort pixel_height;
|
||||
FT_Byte pitch_and_family;
|
||||
FT_UShort avg_width;
|
||||
FT_UShort max_width;
|
||||
FT_Byte first_char;
|
||||
FT_Byte last_char;
|
||||
FT_Byte default_char;
|
||||
FT_Byte break_char;
|
||||
FT_UShort bytes_per_row;
|
||||
FT_ULong device_offset;
|
||||
FT_ULong face_name_offset;
|
||||
FT_ULong bits_pointer;
|
||||
FT_ULong bits_offset;
|
||||
FT_Byte reserved;
|
||||
FT_ULong flags;
|
||||
FT_UShort A_space;
|
||||
FT_UShort B_space;
|
||||
FT_UShort C_space;
|
||||
FT_UShort color_table_offset;
|
||||
FT_ULong reserved1[4];
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* FT_WinFNT_Header */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to an @FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec_* FT_WinFNT_Header;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**********************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_WinFNT_Header
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve a Windows FNT font info header.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face :: A handle to the input face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* aheader :: The WinFNT header.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* This function only works with Windows FNT faces, returning an error
|
||||
* otherwise.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_WinFNT_Header( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_WinFNT_HeaderRec *aheader );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTWINFNT_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Local Variables: */
|
||||
/* coding: utf-8 */
|
||||
/* End: */
|
83
portlibs/include/freetype/ftxf86.h
Normal file
83
portlibs/include/freetype/ftxf86.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,83 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ftxf86.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Support functions for X11. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2007 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FTXF86_H__
|
||||
#define __FTXF86_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* font_formats */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Font Formats */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Getting the font format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The single function in this section can be used to get the font */
|
||||
/* format. Note that this information is not needed normally; */
|
||||
/* however, there are special cases (like in PDF devices) where it is */
|
||||
/* important to differentiate, in spite of FreeType's uniform API. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function is in the X11/xf86 namespace for historical reasons */
|
||||
/* and in no way depends on that windowing system. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_X11_Font_Format */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return a string describing the format of a given face, using values */
|
||||
/* which can be used as an X11 FONT_PROPERTY. Possible values are */
|
||||
/* `TrueType', `Type~1', `BDF', `PCF', `Type~42', `CID~Type~1', `CFF', */
|
||||
/* `PFR', and `Windows~FNT'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: */
|
||||
/* Input face handle. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* Font format string. NULL in case of error. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( const char* )
|
||||
FT_Get_X11_Font_Format( FT_Face face );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FTXF86_H__ */
|
504
portlibs/include/freetype/t1tables.h
Normal file
504
portlibs/include/freetype/t1tables.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,504 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* t1tables.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Basic Type 1/Type 2 tables definitions and interface (specification */
|
||||
/* only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2006, 2008, 2009 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __T1TABLES_H__
|
||||
#define __T1TABLES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* type1_tables */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* Type 1 Tables */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* Type~1 (PostScript) specific font tables. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the definition of Type 1-specific tables, */
|
||||
/* including structures related to other PostScript font formats. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Note that we separate font data in PS_FontInfoRec and PS_PrivateRec */
|
||||
/* structures in order to support Multiple Master fonts. */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* PS_FontInfoRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a Type~1 or Type~2 FontInfo dictionary. */
|
||||
/* Note that for Multiple Master fonts, each instance has its own */
|
||||
/* FontInfo dictionary. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct PS_FontInfoRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_String* version;
|
||||
FT_String* notice;
|
||||
FT_String* full_name;
|
||||
FT_String* family_name;
|
||||
FT_String* weight;
|
||||
FT_Long italic_angle;
|
||||
FT_Bool is_fixed_pitch;
|
||||
FT_Short underline_position;
|
||||
FT_UShort underline_thickness;
|
||||
|
||||
} PS_FontInfoRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* PS_FontInfo */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to a @PS_FontInfoRec structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct PS_FontInfoRec_* PS_FontInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* T1_FontInfo */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This type is equivalent to @PS_FontInfoRec. It is deprecated but */
|
||||
/* kept to maintain source compatibility between various versions of */
|
||||
/* FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef PS_FontInfoRec T1_FontInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* PS_PrivateRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a Type~1 or Type~2 private dictionary. */
|
||||
/* Note that for Multiple Master fonts, each instance has its own */
|
||||
/* Private dictionary. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct PS_PrivateRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Int unique_id;
|
||||
FT_Int lenIV;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Byte num_blue_values;
|
||||
FT_Byte num_other_blues;
|
||||
FT_Byte num_family_blues;
|
||||
FT_Byte num_family_other_blues;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short blue_values[14];
|
||||
FT_Short other_blues[10];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short family_blues [14];
|
||||
FT_Short family_other_blues[10];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Fixed blue_scale;
|
||||
FT_Int blue_shift;
|
||||
FT_Int blue_fuzz;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort standard_width[1];
|
||||
FT_UShort standard_height[1];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Byte num_snap_widths;
|
||||
FT_Byte num_snap_heights;
|
||||
FT_Bool force_bold;
|
||||
FT_Bool round_stem_up;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short snap_widths [13]; /* including std width */
|
||||
FT_Short snap_heights[13]; /* including std height */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Fixed expansion_factor;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Long language_group;
|
||||
FT_Long password;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short min_feature[2];
|
||||
|
||||
} PS_PrivateRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* PS_Private */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to a @PS_PrivateRec structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct PS_PrivateRec_* PS_Private;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* T1_Private */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This type is equivalent to @PS_PrivateRec. It is deprecated but */
|
||||
/* kept to maintain source compatibility between various versions of */
|
||||
/* FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef PS_PrivateRec T1_Private;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Enum> */
|
||||
/* T1_Blend_Flags */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A set of flags used to indicate which fields are present in a */
|
||||
/* given blend dictionary (font info or private). Used to support */
|
||||
/* Multiple Masters fonts. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef enum T1_Blend_Flags_
|
||||
{
|
||||
/*# required fields in a FontInfo blend dictionary */
|
||||
T1_BLEND_UNDERLINE_POSITION = 0,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_ITALIC_ANGLE,
|
||||
|
||||
/*# required fields in a Private blend dictionary */
|
||||
T1_BLEND_BLUE_VALUES,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_OTHER_BLUES,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_STANDARD_WIDTH,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_STANDARD_HEIGHT,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_STEM_SNAP_WIDTHS,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_STEM_SNAP_HEIGHTS,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_BLUE_SCALE,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_BLUE_SHIFT,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_FAMILY_BLUES,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_FAMILY_OTHER_BLUES,
|
||||
T1_BLEND_FORCE_BOLD,
|
||||
|
||||
/*# never remove */
|
||||
T1_BLEND_MAX
|
||||
|
||||
} T1_Blend_Flags;
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*# backwards compatible definitions */
|
||||
#define t1_blend_underline_position T1_BLEND_UNDERLINE_POSITION
|
||||
#define t1_blend_underline_thickness T1_BLEND_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS
|
||||
#define t1_blend_italic_angle T1_BLEND_ITALIC_ANGLE
|
||||
#define t1_blend_blue_values T1_BLEND_BLUE_VALUES
|
||||
#define t1_blend_other_blues T1_BLEND_OTHER_BLUES
|
||||
#define t1_blend_standard_widths T1_BLEND_STANDARD_WIDTH
|
||||
#define t1_blend_standard_height T1_BLEND_STANDARD_HEIGHT
|
||||
#define t1_blend_stem_snap_widths T1_BLEND_STEM_SNAP_WIDTHS
|
||||
#define t1_blend_stem_snap_heights T1_BLEND_STEM_SNAP_HEIGHTS
|
||||
#define t1_blend_blue_scale T1_BLEND_BLUE_SCALE
|
||||
#define t1_blend_blue_shift T1_BLEND_BLUE_SHIFT
|
||||
#define t1_blend_family_blues T1_BLEND_FAMILY_BLUES
|
||||
#define t1_blend_family_other_blues T1_BLEND_FAMILY_OTHER_BLUES
|
||||
#define t1_blend_force_bold T1_BLEND_FORCE_BOLD
|
||||
#define t1_blend_max T1_BLEND_MAX
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* maximum number of Multiple Masters designs, as defined in the spec */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS 16
|
||||
|
||||
/* maximum number of Multiple Masters axes, as defined in the spec */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_MM_AXIS 4
|
||||
|
||||
/* maximum number of elements in a design map */
|
||||
#define T1_MAX_MM_MAP_POINTS 20
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* this structure is used to store the BlendDesignMap entry for an axis */
|
||||
typedef struct PS_DesignMap_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Byte num_points;
|
||||
FT_Long* design_points;
|
||||
FT_Fixed* blend_points;
|
||||
|
||||
} PS_DesignMapRec, *PS_DesignMap;
|
||||
|
||||
/* backwards-compatible definition */
|
||||
typedef PS_DesignMapRec T1_DesignMap;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct PS_BlendRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UInt num_designs;
|
||||
FT_UInt num_axis;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_String* axis_names[T1_MAX_MM_AXIS];
|
||||
FT_Fixed* design_pos[T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS];
|
||||
PS_DesignMapRec design_map[T1_MAX_MM_AXIS];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Fixed* weight_vector;
|
||||
FT_Fixed* default_weight_vector;
|
||||
|
||||
PS_FontInfo font_infos[T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS + 1];
|
||||
PS_Private privates [T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS + 1];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong blend_bitflags;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BBox* bboxes [T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS + 1];
|
||||
|
||||
/* since 2.3.0 */
|
||||
|
||||
/* undocumented, optional: the default design instance; */
|
||||
/* corresponds to default_weight_vector -- */
|
||||
/* num_default_design_vector == 0 means it is not present */
|
||||
/* in the font and associated metrics files */
|
||||
FT_UInt default_design_vector[T1_MAX_MM_DESIGNS];
|
||||
FT_UInt num_default_design_vector;
|
||||
|
||||
} PS_BlendRec, *PS_Blend;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* backwards-compatible definition */
|
||||
typedef PS_BlendRec T1_Blend;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* CID_FaceDictRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to represent data in a CID top-level dictionary. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct CID_FaceDictRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
PS_PrivateRec private_dict;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UInt len_buildchar;
|
||||
FT_Fixed forcebold_threshold;
|
||||
FT_Pos stroke_width;
|
||||
FT_Fixed expansion_factor;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Byte paint_type;
|
||||
FT_Byte font_type;
|
||||
FT_Matrix font_matrix;
|
||||
FT_Vector font_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UInt num_subrs;
|
||||
FT_ULong subrmap_offset;
|
||||
FT_Int sd_bytes;
|
||||
|
||||
} CID_FaceDictRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* CID_FaceDict */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to a @CID_FaceDictRec structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct CID_FaceDictRec_* CID_FaceDict;
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* backwards-compatible definition */
|
||||
typedef CID_FaceDictRec CID_FontDict;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* CID_FaceInfoRec */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to represent CID Face information. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct CID_FaceInfoRec_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_String* cid_font_name;
|
||||
FT_Fixed cid_version;
|
||||
FT_Int cid_font_type;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_String* registry;
|
||||
FT_String* ordering;
|
||||
FT_Int supplement;
|
||||
|
||||
PS_FontInfoRec font_info;
|
||||
FT_BBox font_bbox;
|
||||
FT_ULong uid_base;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Int num_xuid;
|
||||
FT_ULong xuid[16];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong cidmap_offset;
|
||||
FT_Int fd_bytes;
|
||||
FT_Int gd_bytes;
|
||||
FT_ULong cid_count;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Int num_dicts;
|
||||
CID_FaceDict font_dicts;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong data_offset;
|
||||
|
||||
} CID_FaceInfoRec;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* CID_FaceInfo */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A handle to a @CID_FaceInfoRec structure. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct CID_FaceInfoRec_* CID_FaceInfo;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* CID_Info */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This type is equivalent to @CID_FaceInfoRec. It is deprecated but */
|
||||
/* kept to maintain source compatibility between various versions of */
|
||||
/* FreeType. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef CID_FaceInfoRec CID_Info;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Has_PS_Glyph_Names
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return true if a given face provides reliable PostScript glyph
|
||||
* names. This is similar to using the @FT_HAS_GLYPH_NAMES macro,
|
||||
* except that certain fonts (mostly TrueType) contain incorrect
|
||||
* glyph name tables.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* When this function returns true, the caller is sure that the glyph
|
||||
* names returned by @FT_Get_Glyph_Name are reliable.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* face handle
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* Boolean. True if glyph names are reliable.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Int )
|
||||
FT_Has_PS_Glyph_Names( FT_Face face );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_PS_Font_Info
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the @PS_FontInfoRec structure corresponding to a given
|
||||
* PostScript font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* PostScript face handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* afont_info ::
|
||||
* Output font info structure pointer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The string pointers within the font info structure are owned by
|
||||
* the face and don't need to be freed by the caller.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the font's format is not PostScript-based, this function will
|
||||
* return the `FT_Err_Invalid_Argument' error code.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_PS_Font_Info( FT_Face face,
|
||||
PS_FontInfo afont_info );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Get_PS_Font_Private
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Retrieve the @PS_PrivateRec structure corresponding to a given
|
||||
* PostScript font.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* PostScript face handle.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* afont_private ::
|
||||
* Output private dictionary structure pointer.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* The string pointers within the @PS_PrivateRec structure are owned by
|
||||
* the face and don't need to be freed by the caller.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If the font's format is not PostScript-based, this function returns
|
||||
* the `FT_Err_Invalid_Argument' error code.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Get_PS_Font_Private( FT_Face face,
|
||||
PS_Private afont_private );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __T1TABLES_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
1247
portlibs/include/freetype/ttnameid.h
Normal file
1247
portlibs/include/freetype/ttnameid.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
759
portlibs/include/freetype/tttables.h
Normal file
759
portlibs/include/freetype/tttables.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,759 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* tttables.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Basic SFNT/TrueType tables definitions and interface */
|
||||
/* (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2008, 2009, 2010 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __TTTABLES_H__
|
||||
#define __TTTABLES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Section> */
|
||||
/* truetype_tables */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Title> */
|
||||
/* TrueType Tables */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Abstract> */
|
||||
/* TrueType specific table types and functions. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* This section contains the definition of TrueType-specific tables */
|
||||
/* as well as some routines used to access and process them. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_Header */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType font header table. All */
|
||||
/* fields follow the TrueType specification. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_Header_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed Table_Version;
|
||||
FT_Fixed Font_Revision;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Long CheckSum_Adjust;
|
||||
FT_Long Magic_Number;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort Flags;
|
||||
FT_UShort Units_Per_EM;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Long Created [2];
|
||||
FT_Long Modified[2];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short xMin;
|
||||
FT_Short yMin;
|
||||
FT_Short xMax;
|
||||
FT_Short yMax;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort Mac_Style;
|
||||
FT_UShort Lowest_Rec_PPEM;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short Font_Direction;
|
||||
FT_Short Index_To_Loc_Format;
|
||||
FT_Short Glyph_Data_Format;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_Header;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_HoriHeader */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType horizontal header, the `hhea' */
|
||||
/* table, as well as the corresponding horizontal metrics table, */
|
||||
/* i.e., the `hmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* Version :: The table version. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Ascender :: The font's ascender, i.e., the distance */
|
||||
/* from the baseline to the top-most of all */
|
||||
/* glyph points found in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This value is invalid in many fonts, as */
|
||||
/* it is usually set by the font designer, */
|
||||
/* and often reflects only a portion of the */
|
||||
/* glyphs found in the font (maybe ASCII). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You should use the `sTypoAscender' field */
|
||||
/* of the OS/2 table instead if you want */
|
||||
/* the correct one. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Descender :: The font's descender, i.e., the distance */
|
||||
/* from the baseline to the bottom-most of */
|
||||
/* all glyph points found in the font. It */
|
||||
/* is negative. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This value is invalid in many fonts, as */
|
||||
/* it is usually set by the font designer, */
|
||||
/* and often reflects only a portion of the */
|
||||
/* glyphs found in the font (maybe ASCII). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You should use the `sTypoDescender' */
|
||||
/* field of the OS/2 table instead if you */
|
||||
/* want the correct one. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Line_Gap :: The font's line gap, i.e., the distance */
|
||||
/* to add to the ascender and descender to */
|
||||
/* get the BTB, i.e., the */
|
||||
/* baseline-to-baseline distance for the */
|
||||
/* font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* advance_Width_Max :: This field is the maximum of all advance */
|
||||
/* widths found in the font. It can be */
|
||||
/* used to compute the maximum width of an */
|
||||
/* arbitrary string of text. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* min_Left_Side_Bearing :: The minimum left side bearing of all */
|
||||
/* glyphs within the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* min_Right_Side_Bearing :: The minimum right side bearing of all */
|
||||
/* glyphs within the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* xMax_Extent :: The maximum horizontal extent (i.e., the */
|
||||
/* `width' of a glyph's bounding box) for */
|
||||
/* all glyphs in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* caret_Slope_Rise :: The rise coefficient of the cursor's */
|
||||
/* slope of the cursor (slope=rise/run). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* caret_Slope_Run :: The run coefficient of the cursor's */
|
||||
/* slope. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Reserved :: 8~reserved bytes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* metric_Data_Format :: Always~0. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* number_Of_HMetrics :: Number of HMetrics entries in the `hmtx' */
|
||||
/* table -- this value can be smaller than */
|
||||
/* the total number of glyphs in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* long_metrics :: A pointer into the `hmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* short_metrics :: A pointer into the `hmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* IMPORTANT: The TT_HoriHeader and TT_VertHeader structures should */
|
||||
/* be identical except for the names of their fields which */
|
||||
/* are different. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This ensures that a single function in the `ttload' */
|
||||
/* module is able to read both the horizontal and vertical */
|
||||
/* headers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_HoriHeader_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed Version;
|
||||
FT_Short Ascender;
|
||||
FT_Short Descender;
|
||||
FT_Short Line_Gap;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort advance_Width_Max; /* advance width maximum */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short min_Left_Side_Bearing; /* minimum left-sb */
|
||||
FT_Short min_Right_Side_Bearing; /* minimum right-sb */
|
||||
FT_Short xMax_Extent; /* xmax extents */
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Slope_Rise;
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Slope_Run;
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Offset;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short Reserved[4];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short metric_Data_Format;
|
||||
FT_UShort number_Of_HMetrics;
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following fields are not defined by the TrueType specification */
|
||||
/* but they are used to connect the metrics header to the relevant */
|
||||
/* `HMTX' table. */
|
||||
|
||||
void* long_metrics;
|
||||
void* short_metrics;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_HoriHeader;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_VertHeader */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType vertical header, the `vhea' */
|
||||
/* table, as well as the corresponding vertical metrics table, i.e., */
|
||||
/* the `vmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* Version :: The table version. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Ascender :: The font's ascender, i.e., the distance */
|
||||
/* from the baseline to the top-most of */
|
||||
/* all glyph points found in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This value is invalid in many fonts, as */
|
||||
/* it is usually set by the font designer, */
|
||||
/* and often reflects only a portion of */
|
||||
/* the glyphs found in the font (maybe */
|
||||
/* ASCII). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You should use the `sTypoAscender' */
|
||||
/* field of the OS/2 table instead if you */
|
||||
/* want the correct one. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Descender :: The font's descender, i.e., the */
|
||||
/* distance from the baseline to the */
|
||||
/* bottom-most of all glyph points found */
|
||||
/* in the font. It is negative. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This value is invalid in many fonts, as */
|
||||
/* it is usually set by the font designer, */
|
||||
/* and often reflects only a portion of */
|
||||
/* the glyphs found in the font (maybe */
|
||||
/* ASCII). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* You should use the `sTypoDescender' */
|
||||
/* field of the OS/2 table instead if you */
|
||||
/* want the correct one. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Line_Gap :: The font's line gap, i.e., the distance */
|
||||
/* to add to the ascender and descender to */
|
||||
/* get the BTB, i.e., the */
|
||||
/* baseline-to-baseline distance for the */
|
||||
/* font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* advance_Height_Max :: This field is the maximum of all */
|
||||
/* advance heights found in the font. It */
|
||||
/* can be used to compute the maximum */
|
||||
/* height of an arbitrary string of text. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* min_Top_Side_Bearing :: The minimum top side bearing of all */
|
||||
/* glyphs within the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* min_Bottom_Side_Bearing :: The minimum bottom side bearing of all */
|
||||
/* glyphs within the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* yMax_Extent :: The maximum vertical extent (i.e., the */
|
||||
/* `height' of a glyph's bounding box) for */
|
||||
/* all glyphs in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* caret_Slope_Rise :: The rise coefficient of the cursor's */
|
||||
/* slope of the cursor (slope=rise/run). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* caret_Slope_Run :: The run coefficient of the cursor's */
|
||||
/* slope. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* caret_Offset :: The cursor's offset for slanted fonts. */
|
||||
/* This value is `reserved' in vmtx */
|
||||
/* version 1.0. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Reserved :: 8~reserved bytes. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* metric_Data_Format :: Always~0. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* number_Of_HMetrics :: Number of VMetrics entries in the */
|
||||
/* `vmtx' table -- this value can be */
|
||||
/* smaller than the total number of glyphs */
|
||||
/* in the font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* long_metrics :: A pointer into the `vmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* short_metrics :: A pointer into the `vmtx' table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* IMPORTANT: The TT_HoriHeader and TT_VertHeader structures should */
|
||||
/* be identical except for the names of their fields which */
|
||||
/* are different. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This ensures that a single function in the `ttload' */
|
||||
/* module is able to read both the horizontal and vertical */
|
||||
/* headers. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_VertHeader_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed Version;
|
||||
FT_Short Ascender;
|
||||
FT_Short Descender;
|
||||
FT_Short Line_Gap;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort advance_Height_Max; /* advance height maximum */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short min_Top_Side_Bearing; /* minimum left-sb or top-sb */
|
||||
FT_Short min_Bottom_Side_Bearing; /* minimum right-sb or bottom-sb */
|
||||
FT_Short yMax_Extent; /* xmax or ymax extents */
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Slope_Rise;
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Slope_Run;
|
||||
FT_Short caret_Offset;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short Reserved[4];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short metric_Data_Format;
|
||||
FT_UShort number_Of_VMetrics;
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following fields are not defined by the TrueType specification */
|
||||
/* but they're used to connect the metrics header to the relevant */
|
||||
/* `HMTX' or `VMTX' table. */
|
||||
|
||||
void* long_metrics;
|
||||
void* short_metrics;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_VertHeader;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_OS2 */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType OS/2 table. This is the long */
|
||||
/* table version. All fields comply to the TrueType specification. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Note that we now support old Mac fonts which do not include an */
|
||||
/* OS/2 table. In this case, the `version' field is always set to */
|
||||
/* 0xFFFF. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_OS2_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_UShort version; /* 0x0001 - more or 0xFFFF */
|
||||
FT_Short xAvgCharWidth;
|
||||
FT_UShort usWeightClass;
|
||||
FT_UShort usWidthClass;
|
||||
FT_Short fsType;
|
||||
FT_Short ySubscriptXSize;
|
||||
FT_Short ySubscriptYSize;
|
||||
FT_Short ySubscriptXOffset;
|
||||
FT_Short ySubscriptYOffset;
|
||||
FT_Short ySuperscriptXSize;
|
||||
FT_Short ySuperscriptYSize;
|
||||
FT_Short ySuperscriptXOffset;
|
||||
FT_Short ySuperscriptYOffset;
|
||||
FT_Short yStrikeoutSize;
|
||||
FT_Short yStrikeoutPosition;
|
||||
FT_Short sFamilyClass;
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Byte panose[10];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong ulUnicodeRange1; /* Bits 0-31 */
|
||||
FT_ULong ulUnicodeRange2; /* Bits 32-63 */
|
||||
FT_ULong ulUnicodeRange3; /* Bits 64-95 */
|
||||
FT_ULong ulUnicodeRange4; /* Bits 96-127 */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Char achVendID[4];
|
||||
|
||||
FT_UShort fsSelection;
|
||||
FT_UShort usFirstCharIndex;
|
||||
FT_UShort usLastCharIndex;
|
||||
FT_Short sTypoAscender;
|
||||
FT_Short sTypoDescender;
|
||||
FT_Short sTypoLineGap;
|
||||
FT_UShort usWinAscent;
|
||||
FT_UShort usWinDescent;
|
||||
|
||||
/* only version 1 tables: */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_ULong ulCodePageRange1; /* Bits 0-31 */
|
||||
FT_ULong ulCodePageRange2; /* Bits 32-63 */
|
||||
|
||||
/* only version 2 tables: */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_Short sxHeight;
|
||||
FT_Short sCapHeight;
|
||||
FT_UShort usDefaultChar;
|
||||
FT_UShort usBreakChar;
|
||||
FT_UShort usMaxContext;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_OS2;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_Postscript */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType PostScript table. All fields */
|
||||
/* comply to the TrueType specification. This structure does not */
|
||||
/* reference the PostScript glyph names, which can be nevertheless */
|
||||
/* accessed with the `ttpost' module. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_Postscript_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed FormatType;
|
||||
FT_Fixed italicAngle;
|
||||
FT_Short underlinePosition;
|
||||
FT_Short underlineThickness;
|
||||
FT_ULong isFixedPitch;
|
||||
FT_ULong minMemType42;
|
||||
FT_ULong maxMemType42;
|
||||
FT_ULong minMemType1;
|
||||
FT_ULong maxMemType1;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Glyph names follow in the file, but we don't */
|
||||
/* load them by default. See the ttpost.c file. */
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_Postscript;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_PCLT */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* A structure used to model a TrueType PCLT table. All fields */
|
||||
/* comply to the TrueType specification. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_PCLT_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed Version;
|
||||
FT_ULong FontNumber;
|
||||
FT_UShort Pitch;
|
||||
FT_UShort xHeight;
|
||||
FT_UShort Style;
|
||||
FT_UShort TypeFamily;
|
||||
FT_UShort CapHeight;
|
||||
FT_UShort SymbolSet;
|
||||
FT_Char TypeFace[16];
|
||||
FT_Char CharacterComplement[8];
|
||||
FT_Char FileName[6];
|
||||
FT_Char StrokeWeight;
|
||||
FT_Char WidthType;
|
||||
FT_Byte SerifStyle;
|
||||
FT_Byte Reserved;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_PCLT;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Struct> */
|
||||
/* TT_MaxProfile */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* The maximum profile is a table containing many max values which */
|
||||
/* can be used to pre-allocate arrays. This ensures that no memory */
|
||||
/* allocation occurs during a glyph load. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Fields> */
|
||||
/* version :: The version number. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* numGlyphs :: The number of glyphs in this TrueType */
|
||||
/* font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxPoints :: The maximum number of points in a */
|
||||
/* non-composite TrueType glyph. See also */
|
||||
/* the structure element */
|
||||
/* `maxCompositePoints'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxContours :: The maximum number of contours in a */
|
||||
/* non-composite TrueType glyph. See also */
|
||||
/* the structure element */
|
||||
/* `maxCompositeContours'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxCompositePoints :: The maximum number of points in a */
|
||||
/* composite TrueType glyph. See also the */
|
||||
/* structure element `maxPoints'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxCompositeContours :: The maximum number of contours in a */
|
||||
/* composite TrueType glyph. See also the */
|
||||
/* structure element `maxContours'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxZones :: The maximum number of zones used for */
|
||||
/* glyph hinting. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxTwilightPoints :: The maximum number of points in the */
|
||||
/* twilight zone used for glyph hinting. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxStorage :: The maximum number of elements in the */
|
||||
/* storage area used for glyph hinting. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxFunctionDefs :: The maximum number of function */
|
||||
/* definitions in the TrueType bytecode for */
|
||||
/* this font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxInstructionDefs :: The maximum number of instruction */
|
||||
/* definitions in the TrueType bytecode for */
|
||||
/* this font. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxStackElements :: The maximum number of stack elements used */
|
||||
/* during bytecode interpretation. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxSizeOfInstructions :: The maximum number of TrueType opcodes */
|
||||
/* used for glyph hinting. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxComponentElements :: The maximum number of simple (i.e., non- */
|
||||
/* composite) glyphs in a composite glyph. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* maxComponentDepth :: The maximum nesting depth of composite */
|
||||
/* glyphs. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* This structure is only used during font loading. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef struct TT_MaxProfile_
|
||||
{
|
||||
FT_Fixed version;
|
||||
FT_UShort numGlyphs;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxPoints;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxContours;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxCompositePoints;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxCompositeContours;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxZones;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxTwilightPoints;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxStorage;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxFunctionDefs;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxInstructionDefs;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxStackElements;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxSizeOfInstructions;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxComponentElements;
|
||||
FT_UShort maxComponentDepth;
|
||||
|
||||
} TT_MaxProfile;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Enum> */
|
||||
/* FT_Sfnt_Tag */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* An enumeration used to specify the index of an SFNT table. */
|
||||
/* Used in the @FT_Get_Sfnt_Table API function. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
typedef enum FT_Sfnt_Tag_
|
||||
{
|
||||
ft_sfnt_head = 0, /* TT_Header */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_maxp = 1, /* TT_MaxProfile */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_os2 = 2, /* TT_OS2 */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_hhea = 3, /* TT_HoriHeader */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_vhea = 4, /* TT_VertHeader */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_post = 5, /* TT_Postscript */
|
||||
ft_sfnt_pclt = 6, /* TT_PCLT */
|
||||
|
||||
sfnt_max /* internal end mark */
|
||||
|
||||
} FT_Sfnt_Tag;
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_Sfnt_Table */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return a pointer to a given SFNT table within a face. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* face :: A handle to the source. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* tag :: The index of the SFNT table. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* A type-less pointer to the table. This will be~0 in case of */
|
||||
/* error, or if the corresponding table was not found *OR* loaded */
|
||||
/* from the file. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Use a typecast according to `tag' to access the structure */
|
||||
/* elements. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Note> */
|
||||
/* The table is owned by the face object and disappears with it. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This function is only useful to access SFNT tables that are loaded */
|
||||
/* by the sfnt, truetype, and opentype drivers. See @FT_Sfnt_Tag for */
|
||||
/* a list. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( void* )
|
||||
FT_Get_Sfnt_Table( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_Sfnt_Tag tag );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Load_Sfnt_Table
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Load any font table into client memory.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* tag ::
|
||||
* The four-byte tag of the table to load. Use the value~0 if you want
|
||||
* to access the whole font file. Otherwise, you can use one of the
|
||||
* definitions found in the @FT_TRUETYPE_TAGS_H file, or forge a new
|
||||
* one with @FT_MAKE_TAG.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* offset ::
|
||||
* The starting offset in the table (or file if tag == 0).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* buffer ::
|
||||
* The target buffer address. The client must ensure that the memory
|
||||
* array is big enough to hold the data.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @inout:
|
||||
* length ::
|
||||
* If the `length' parameter is NULL, then try to load the whole table.
|
||||
* Return an error code if it fails.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Else, if `*length' is~0, exit immediately while returning the
|
||||
* table's (or file) full size in it.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Else the number of bytes to read from the table or file, from the
|
||||
* starting offset.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* If you need to determine the table's length you should first call this
|
||||
* function with `*length' set to~0, as in the following example:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* {
|
||||
* FT_ULong length = 0;
|
||||
*
|
||||
*
|
||||
* error = FT_Load_Sfnt_Table( face, tag, 0, NULL, &length );
|
||||
* if ( error ) { ... table does not exist ... }
|
||||
*
|
||||
* buffer = malloc( length );
|
||||
* if ( buffer == NULL ) { ... not enough memory ... }
|
||||
*
|
||||
* error = FT_Load_Sfnt_Table( face, tag, 0, buffer, &length );
|
||||
* if ( error ) { ... could not load table ... }
|
||||
* }
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Load_Sfnt_Table( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_ULong tag,
|
||||
FT_Long offset,
|
||||
FT_Byte* buffer,
|
||||
FT_ULong* length );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/**************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @function:
|
||||
* FT_Sfnt_Table_Info
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* Return information on an SFNT table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @input:
|
||||
* face ::
|
||||
* A handle to the source face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* table_index ::
|
||||
* The index of an SFNT table. The function returns
|
||||
* FT_Err_Table_Missing for an invalid value.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @output:
|
||||
* tag ::
|
||||
* The name tag of the SFNT table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* length ::
|
||||
* The length of the SFNT table.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return:
|
||||
* FreeType error code. 0~means success.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @note:
|
||||
* SFNT tables with length zero are treated as missing.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Error )
|
||||
FT_Sfnt_Table_Info( FT_Face face,
|
||||
FT_UInt table_index,
|
||||
FT_ULong *tag,
|
||||
FT_ULong *length );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_CMap_Language_ID */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return TrueType/sfnt specific cmap language ID. Definitions of */
|
||||
/* language ID values are in `freetype/ttnameid.h'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* charmap :: */
|
||||
/* The target charmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* The language ID of `charmap'. If `charmap' doesn't belong to a */
|
||||
/* TrueType/sfnt face, just return~0 as the default value. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_ULong )
|
||||
FT_Get_CMap_Language_ID( FT_CharMap charmap );
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Function> */
|
||||
/* FT_Get_CMap_Format */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Description> */
|
||||
/* Return TrueType/sfnt specific cmap format. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Input> */
|
||||
/* charmap :: */
|
||||
/* The target charmap. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* <Return> */
|
||||
/* The format of `charmap'. If `charmap' doesn't belong to a */
|
||||
/* TrueType/sfnt face, return -1. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
FT_EXPORT( FT_Long )
|
||||
FT_Get_CMap_Format( FT_CharMap charmap );
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __TTTABLES_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
107
portlibs/include/freetype/tttags.h
Normal file
107
portlibs/include/freetype/tttags.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,107 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* tttags.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Tags for TrueType and OpenType tables (specification only). */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __TTAGS_H__
|
||||
#define __TTAGS_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define TTAG_avar FT_MAKE_TAG( 'a', 'v', 'a', 'r' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_BASE FT_MAKE_TAG( 'B', 'A', 'S', 'E' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_bdat FT_MAKE_TAG( 'b', 'd', 'a', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_BDF FT_MAKE_TAG( 'B', 'D', 'F', ' ' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_bhed FT_MAKE_TAG( 'b', 'h', 'e', 'd' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_bloc FT_MAKE_TAG( 'b', 'l', 'o', 'c' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_bsln FT_MAKE_TAG( 'b', 's', 'l', 'n' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_CFF FT_MAKE_TAG( 'C', 'F', 'F', ' ' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_CID FT_MAKE_TAG( 'C', 'I', 'D', ' ' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_cmap FT_MAKE_TAG( 'c', 'm', 'a', 'p' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_cvar FT_MAKE_TAG( 'c', 'v', 'a', 'r' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_cvt FT_MAKE_TAG( 'c', 'v', 't', ' ' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_DSIG FT_MAKE_TAG( 'D', 'S', 'I', 'G' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_EBDT FT_MAKE_TAG( 'E', 'B', 'D', 'T' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_EBLC FT_MAKE_TAG( 'E', 'B', 'L', 'C' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_EBSC FT_MAKE_TAG( 'E', 'B', 'S', 'C' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_feat FT_MAKE_TAG( 'f', 'e', 'a', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_FOND FT_MAKE_TAG( 'F', 'O', 'N', 'D' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_fpgm FT_MAKE_TAG( 'f', 'p', 'g', 'm' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_fvar FT_MAKE_TAG( 'f', 'v', 'a', 'r' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_gasp FT_MAKE_TAG( 'g', 'a', 's', 'p' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_GDEF FT_MAKE_TAG( 'G', 'D', 'E', 'F' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_glyf FT_MAKE_TAG( 'g', 'l', 'y', 'f' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_GPOS FT_MAKE_TAG( 'G', 'P', 'O', 'S' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_GSUB FT_MAKE_TAG( 'G', 'S', 'U', 'B' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_gvar FT_MAKE_TAG( 'g', 'v', 'a', 'r' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_hdmx FT_MAKE_TAG( 'h', 'd', 'm', 'x' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_head FT_MAKE_TAG( 'h', 'e', 'a', 'd' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_hhea FT_MAKE_TAG( 'h', 'h', 'e', 'a' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_hmtx FT_MAKE_TAG( 'h', 'm', 't', 'x' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_JSTF FT_MAKE_TAG( 'J', 'S', 'T', 'F' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_just FT_MAKE_TAG( 'j', 'u', 's', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_kern FT_MAKE_TAG( 'k', 'e', 'r', 'n' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_lcar FT_MAKE_TAG( 'l', 'c', 'a', 'r' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_loca FT_MAKE_TAG( 'l', 'o', 'c', 'a' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_LTSH FT_MAKE_TAG( 'L', 'T', 'S', 'H' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_LWFN FT_MAKE_TAG( 'L', 'W', 'F', 'N' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_MATH FT_MAKE_TAG( 'M', 'A', 'T', 'H' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_maxp FT_MAKE_TAG( 'm', 'a', 'x', 'p' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_META FT_MAKE_TAG( 'M', 'E', 'T', 'A' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_MMFX FT_MAKE_TAG( 'M', 'M', 'F', 'X' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_MMSD FT_MAKE_TAG( 'M', 'M', 'S', 'D' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_mort FT_MAKE_TAG( 'm', 'o', 'r', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_morx FT_MAKE_TAG( 'm', 'o', 'r', 'x' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_name FT_MAKE_TAG( 'n', 'a', 'm', 'e' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_opbd FT_MAKE_TAG( 'o', 'p', 'b', 'd' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_OS2 FT_MAKE_TAG( 'O', 'S', '/', '2' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_OTTO FT_MAKE_TAG( 'O', 'T', 'T', 'O' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_PCLT FT_MAKE_TAG( 'P', 'C', 'L', 'T' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_POST FT_MAKE_TAG( 'P', 'O', 'S', 'T' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_post FT_MAKE_TAG( 'p', 'o', 's', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_prep FT_MAKE_TAG( 'p', 'r', 'e', 'p' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_prop FT_MAKE_TAG( 'p', 'r', 'o', 'p' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_sfnt FT_MAKE_TAG( 's', 'f', 'n', 't' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_SING FT_MAKE_TAG( 'S', 'I', 'N', 'G' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_trak FT_MAKE_TAG( 't', 'r', 'a', 'k' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_true FT_MAKE_TAG( 't', 'r', 'u', 'e' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_ttc FT_MAKE_TAG( 't', 't', 'c', ' ' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_ttcf FT_MAKE_TAG( 't', 't', 'c', 'f' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_TYP1 FT_MAKE_TAG( 'T', 'Y', 'P', '1' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_typ1 FT_MAKE_TAG( 't', 'y', 'p', '1' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_VDMX FT_MAKE_TAG( 'V', 'D', 'M', 'X' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_vhea FT_MAKE_TAG( 'v', 'h', 'e', 'a' )
|
||||
#define TTAG_vmtx FT_MAKE_TAG( 'v', 'm', 't', 'x' )
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __TTAGS_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
59
portlibs/include/freetype/ttunpat.h
Normal file
59
portlibs/include/freetype/ttunpat.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ttunpat.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Definitions for the unpatented TrueType hinting system */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 2003, 2006 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Written by Graham Asher <graham.asher@btinternet.com> */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __TTUNPAT_H__
|
||||
#define __TTUNPAT_H__
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ft2build.h>
|
||||
#include FT_FREETYPE_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef FREETYPE_H
|
||||
#error "freetype.h of FreeType 1 has been loaded!"
|
||||
#error "Please fix the directory search order for header files"
|
||||
#error "so that freetype.h of FreeType 2 is found first."
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
FT_BEGIN_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @constant:
|
||||
* FT_PARAM_TAG_UNPATENTED_HINTING
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @description:
|
||||
* A constant used as the tag of an @FT_Parameter structure to indicate
|
||||
* that unpatented methods only should be used by the TrueType bytecode
|
||||
* interpreter for a typeface opened by @FT_Open_Face.
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define FT_PARAM_TAG_UNPATENTED_HINTING FT_MAKE_TAG( 'u', 'n', 'p', 'a' )
|
||||
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
|
||||
FT_END_HEADER
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __TTUNPAT_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
61
portlibs/include/ft2build.h
Normal file
61
portlibs/include/ft2build.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* ft2build.h */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Build macros of the FreeType 2 library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* Copyright 1996-2001, 2003, 2006 by */
|
||||
/* David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This file is part of the FreeType project, and may only be used, */
|
||||
/* modified, and distributed under the terms of the FreeType project */
|
||||
/* license, LICENSE.TXT. By continuing to use, modify, or distribute */
|
||||
/* this file you indicate that you have read the license and */
|
||||
/* understand and accept it fully. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* This is a Unix-specific version of <ft2build.h> that should be used */
|
||||
/* exclusively *after* installation of the library. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* It assumes that `/usr/local/include/freetype2' (or whatever is */
|
||||
/* returned by the `freetype-config --cflags' or `pkg-config --cflags' */
|
||||
/* command) is in your compilation include path. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* We don't need to do anything special in this release. However, for */
|
||||
/* a future FreeType 2 release, the following installation changes will */
|
||||
/* be performed: */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - The contents of `freetype-2.x/include/freetype' will be installed */
|
||||
/* to `/usr/local/include/freetype2' instead of */
|
||||
/* `/usr/local/include/freetype2/freetype'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - This file will #include <freetype2/config/ftheader.h>, instead */
|
||||
/* of <freetype/config/ftheader.h>. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - The contents of `ftheader.h' will be processed with `sed' to */
|
||||
/* replace all `<freetype/xxx>' with `<freetype2/xxx>'. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* - Adding `/usr/local/include/freetype2' to your compilation include */
|
||||
/* path will not be necessary anymore. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/* These changes will be transparent to client applications which use */
|
||||
/* freetype-config (or pkg-config). No modifications will be necessary */
|
||||
/* to compile with the new scheme. */
|
||||
/* */
|
||||
/*************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef __FT2_BUILD_UNIX_H__
|
||||
#define __FT2_BUILD_UNIX_H__
|
||||
|
||||
/* `<prefix>/include/freetype2' must be in your current inclusion path */
|
||||
#include <freetype/config/ftheader.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* __FT2_BUILD_UNIX_H__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* END */
|
889
portlibs/include/gd.h
Normal file
889
portlibs/include/gd.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,889 @@
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef GD_H
|
||||
#define GD_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD_MAJOR_VERSION 2
|
||||
#define GD_MINOR_VERSION 1
|
||||
#define GD_RELEASE_VERSION 0
|
||||
#define GD_EXTRA_VERSION "alpha"
|
||||
#define GD_VERSION_STRING "2.1.0-alpha"
|
||||
|
||||
/* Do the DLL dance: dllexport when building the DLL,
|
||||
dllimport when importing from it, nothing when
|
||||
not on Silly Silly Windows (tm Aardman Productions). */
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.20: for headers */
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.24: __stdcall also needed for Visual BASIC
|
||||
and other languages. This breaks ABI compatibility
|
||||
with previous DLL revs, but it's necessary. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.29: WIN32 programmers can declare the NONDLL macro if they
|
||||
wish to build gd as a static library or by directly including
|
||||
the gd sources in a project. */
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined(WIN32) && !defined(_WIN32_WCE)
|
||||
#define NONDLL 1
|
||||
#endif /* WIN32 */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef NONDLL
|
||||
#define BGD_DECLARE(rt) extern rt
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#ifdef BGDWIN32
|
||||
|
||||
#define BGD_DECLARE(rt) __declspec(dllexport) rt __stdcall
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define BGD_DECLARE(rt) __declspec(dllimport) rt _stdcall
|
||||
#endif /* BGDWIN32 */
|
||||
#endif /* NONDLL */
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.20: for actual storage of exported data, functions don't need this,
|
||||
currently needed only for font pointers */
|
||||
#ifdef NONDLL
|
||||
/* 2.0.25: bring back extern */
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_PROT extern
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_IMPL
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#ifdef BGDWIN32
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_PROT __declspec(dllexport) extern
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_IMPL __declspec(dllexport)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_PROT __declspec(dllimport) extern
|
||||
#define BGD_EXPORT_DATA_IMPL __declspec(dllimport)
|
||||
#endif /* BGDWIN32 */
|
||||
#endif /* NONDLL */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C"
|
||||
{
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* some might want to set DEFAULT_FONTPATH from configure in config.h */
|
||||
#ifdef NETWARE
|
||||
/* default fontpath for netware systems, could probably be handled in configure for 2.1 */
|
||||
#define DEFAULT_FONTPATH "sys:/java/nwgfx/lib/x11/fonts/ttf;."
|
||||
#define PATHSEPARATOR ";"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.23: more Type 1 fonts */
|
||||
#ifndef DEFAULT_FONTPATH
|
||||
/* default fontpath for unix systems - whatever happened to standards ! */
|
||||
#define DEFAULT_FONTPATH "/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/fonts/TrueType:/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/fonts/truetype:/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/fonts/TTF:/usr/share/fonts/TrueType:/usr/share/fonts/truetype:/usr/openwin/lib/X11/fonts/TrueType:/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/fonts/Type1:/usr/lib/X11/fonts/Type1:/usr/openwin/lib/X11/fonts/Type1"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PATHSEPARATOR
|
||||
#define PATHSEPARATOR ":"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* gd.h: declarations file for the graphic-draw module.
|
||||
* Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
|
||||
* documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted, provided
|
||||
* that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that both that
|
||||
* copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting
|
||||
* documentation. This software is provided "AS IS." Thomas Boutell and
|
||||
* Boutell.Com, Inc. disclaim all warranties, either express or implied,
|
||||
* including but not limited to implied warranties of merchantability and
|
||||
* fitness for a particular purpose, with respect to this code and accompanying
|
||||
* documentation. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* stdio is needed for file I/O. */
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include "gd_io.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* The maximum number of palette entries in palette-based images.
|
||||
In the wonderful new world of gd 2.0, you can of course have
|
||||
many more colors when using truecolor mode. */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdMaxColors 256
|
||||
|
||||
/* Image type. See functions below; you will not need to change
|
||||
the elements directly. Use the provided macros to
|
||||
access sx, sy, the color table, and colorsTotal for
|
||||
read-only purposes. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* If 'truecolor' is set true, the image is truecolor;
|
||||
pixels are represented by integers, which
|
||||
must be 32 bits wide or more.
|
||||
|
||||
True colors are repsented as follows:
|
||||
|
||||
ARGB
|
||||
|
||||
Where 'A' (alpha channel) occupies only the
|
||||
LOWER 7 BITS of the MSB. This very small
|
||||
loss of alpha channel resolution allows gd 2.x
|
||||
to keep backwards compatibility by allowing
|
||||
signed integers to be used to represent colors,
|
||||
and negative numbers to represent special cases,
|
||||
just as in gd 1.x. */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdAlphaMax 127
|
||||
#define gdAlphaOpaque 0
|
||||
#define gdAlphaTransparent 127
|
||||
#define gdRedMax 255
|
||||
#define gdGreenMax 255
|
||||
#define gdBlueMax 255
|
||||
#define gdTrueColorGetAlpha(c) (((c) & 0x7F000000) >> 24)
|
||||
#define gdTrueColorGetRed(c) (((c) & 0xFF0000) >> 16)
|
||||
#define gdTrueColorGetGreen(c) (((c) & 0x00FF00) >> 8)
|
||||
#define gdTrueColorGetBlue(c) ((c) & 0x0000FF)
|
||||
|
||||
enum gdCropMode {
|
||||
GD_CROP_DEFAULT = 0,
|
||||
GD_CROP_TRANSPARENT,
|
||||
GD_CROP_BLACK,
|
||||
GD_CROP_WHITE,
|
||||
GD_CROP_SIDES
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* This function accepts truecolor pixel values only. The
|
||||
source color is composited with the destination color
|
||||
based on the alpha channel value of the source color.
|
||||
The resulting color is opaque. */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdAlphaBlend (int dest, int src);
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct gdImageStruct
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* Palette-based image pixels */
|
||||
unsigned char **pixels;
|
||||
int sx;
|
||||
int sy;
|
||||
/* These are valid in palette images only. See also
|
||||
'alpha', which appears later in the structure to
|
||||
preserve binary backwards compatibility */
|
||||
int colorsTotal;
|
||||
int red[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
int green[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
int blue[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
int open[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
/* For backwards compatibility, this is set to the
|
||||
first palette entry with 100% transparency,
|
||||
and is also set and reset by the
|
||||
gdImageColorTransparent function. Newer
|
||||
applications can allocate palette entries
|
||||
with any desired level of transparency; however,
|
||||
bear in mind that many viewers, notably
|
||||
many web browsers, fail to implement
|
||||
full alpha channel for PNG and provide
|
||||
support for full opacity or transparency only. */
|
||||
int transparent;
|
||||
int *polyInts;
|
||||
int polyAllocated;
|
||||
struct gdImageStruct *brush;
|
||||
struct gdImageStruct *tile;
|
||||
int brushColorMap[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
int tileColorMap[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
int styleLength;
|
||||
int stylePos;
|
||||
int *style;
|
||||
int interlace;
|
||||
/* New in 2.0: thickness of line. Initialized to 1. */
|
||||
int thick;
|
||||
/* New in 2.0: alpha channel for palettes. Note that only
|
||||
Macintosh Internet Explorer and (possibly) Netscape 6
|
||||
really support multiple levels of transparency in
|
||||
palettes, to my knowledge, as of 2/15/01. Most
|
||||
common browsers will display 100% opaque and
|
||||
100% transparent correctly, and do something
|
||||
unpredictable and/or undesirable for levels
|
||||
in between. TBB */
|
||||
int alpha[gdMaxColors];
|
||||
/* Truecolor flag and pixels. New 2.0 fields appear here at the
|
||||
end to minimize breakage of existing object code. */
|
||||
int trueColor;
|
||||
int **tpixels;
|
||||
/* Should alpha channel be copied, or applied, each time a
|
||||
pixel is drawn? This applies to truecolor images only.
|
||||
No attempt is made to alpha-blend in palette images,
|
||||
even if semitransparent palette entries exist.
|
||||
To do that, build your image as a truecolor image,
|
||||
then quantize down to 8 bits. */
|
||||
int alphaBlendingFlag;
|
||||
/* Should the alpha channel of the image be saved? This affects
|
||||
PNG at the moment; other future formats may also
|
||||
have that capability. JPEG doesn't. */
|
||||
int saveAlphaFlag;
|
||||
|
||||
/* There should NEVER BE ACCESSOR MACROS FOR ITEMS BELOW HERE, so this
|
||||
part of the structure can be safely changed in new releases. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.12: anti-aliased globals. 2.0.26: just a few vestiges after
|
||||
switching to the fast, memory-cheap implementation from PHP-gd. */
|
||||
int AA;
|
||||
int AA_color;
|
||||
int AA_dont_blend;
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.12: simple clipping rectangle. These values
|
||||
must be checked for safety when set; please use
|
||||
gdImageSetClip */
|
||||
int cx1;
|
||||
int cy1;
|
||||
int cx2;
|
||||
int cy2;
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.1.0: allows to specify resolution in dpi */
|
||||
unsigned int res_x;
|
||||
unsigned int res_y;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdImage;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef gdImage *gdImagePtr;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
/* # of characters in font */
|
||||
int nchars;
|
||||
/* First character is numbered... (usually 32 = space) */
|
||||
int offset;
|
||||
/* Character width and height */
|
||||
int w;
|
||||
int h;
|
||||
/* Font data; array of characters, one row after another.
|
||||
Easily included in code, also easily loaded from
|
||||
data files. */
|
||||
char *data;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdFont;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Text functions take these. */
|
||||
typedef gdFont *gdFontPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
/* For backwards compatibility only. Use gdImageSetStyle()
|
||||
for MUCH more flexible line drawing. Also see
|
||||
gdImageSetBrush(). */
|
||||
#define gdDashSize 4
|
||||
|
||||
/* Special colors. */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdStyled (-2)
|
||||
#define gdBrushed (-3)
|
||||
#define gdStyledBrushed (-4)
|
||||
#define gdTiled (-5)
|
||||
|
||||
/* NOT the same as the transparent color index.
|
||||
This is used in line styles only. */
|
||||
#define gdTransparent (-6)
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdAntiAliased (-7)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Functions to manipulate images. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Creates a palette-based image (up to 256 colors). */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreate (int sx, int sy);
|
||||
|
||||
/* An alternate name for the above (2.0). */
|
||||
#define gdImageCreatePalette gdImageCreate
|
||||
|
||||
/* Creates a truecolor image (millions of colors). */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateTrueColor (int sx, int sy);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Creates an image from various file types. These functions
|
||||
return a palette or truecolor image based on the
|
||||
nature of the file being loaded. Truecolor PNG
|
||||
stays truecolor; palette PNG stays palette-based;
|
||||
JPEG is always truecolor. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromPng (FILE * fd);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromPngCtx (gdIOCtxPtr in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromPngPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
/* These read the first frame only */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGif (FILE * fd);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGifCtx (gdIOCtxPtr in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGifPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromWBMP (FILE * inFile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromWBMPCtx (gdIOCtx * infile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromWBMPPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromJpeg (FILE * infile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromJpegCtx (gdIOCtx * infile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromJpegPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTiff(FILE *inFile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTiffCtx(gdIOCtx *infile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTiffPtr(int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTga( FILE * fp );
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTgaCtx(gdIOCtx* ctx);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromTgaPtr(int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromBmp (FILE * inFile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromBmpPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromBmpCtx (gdIOCtxPtr infile);
|
||||
|
||||
/* A custom data source. */
|
||||
/* The source function must return -1 on error, otherwise the number
|
||||
of bytes fetched. 0 is EOF, not an error! */
|
||||
/* context will be passed to your source function. */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
int (*source) (void *context, char *buffer, int len);
|
||||
void *context;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdSource, *gdSourcePtr;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Deprecated in favor of gdImageCreateFromPngCtx */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromPngSource (gdSourcePtr in);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd (FILE * in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGdCtx (gdIOCtxPtr in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGdPtr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2 (FILE * in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2Ctx (gdIOCtxPtr in);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2Ptr (int size, void *data);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2Part (FILE * in, int srcx, int srcy, int w,
|
||||
int h);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2PartCtx (gdIOCtxPtr in, int srcx, int srcy,
|
||||
int w, int h);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromGd2PartPtr (int size, void *data, int srcx, int srcy,
|
||||
int w, int h);
|
||||
/* 2.0.10: prototype was missing */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromXbm (FILE * in);
|
||||
|
||||
/* NOTE: filename, not FILE */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreateFromXpm (char *filename);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageDestroy (gdImagePtr im);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Replaces or blends with the background depending on the
|
||||
most recent call to gdImageAlphaBlending and the
|
||||
alpha channel value of 'color'; default is to overwrite.
|
||||
Tiling and line styling are also implemented
|
||||
here. All other gd drawing functions pass through this call,
|
||||
allowing for many useful effects. */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetPixel (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y, int color);
|
||||
/* FreeType 2 text output with hook to extra flags */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageGetPixel (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageGetTrueColorPixel (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageAABlend (gdImagePtr im);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageLine (gdImagePtr im, int x1, int y1, int x2, int y2, int color);
|
||||
|
||||
/* For backwards compatibility only. Use gdImageSetStyle()
|
||||
for much more flexible line drawing. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageDashedLine (gdImagePtr im, int x1, int y1, int x2, int y2,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
/* Corners specified (not width and height). Upper left first, lower right
|
||||
second. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageRectangle (gdImagePtr im, int x1, int y1, int x2, int y2,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
/* Solid bar. Upper left corner first, lower right corner second. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFilledRectangle (gdImagePtr im, int x1, int y1, int x2, int y2,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetClip(gdImagePtr im, int x1, int y1, int x2, int y2);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGetClip(gdImagePtr im, int *x1P, int *y1P, int *x2P, int *y2P);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetResolution(gdImagePtr im, const unsigned int res_x, const unsigned int res_y);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageBoundsSafe (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageChar (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y, int c,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCharUp (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y, int c,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageString (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y,
|
||||
unsigned char *s, int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageStringUp (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y,
|
||||
unsigned char *s, int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageString16 (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y,
|
||||
unsigned short *s, int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageStringUp16 (gdImagePtr im, gdFontPtr f, int x, int y,
|
||||
unsigned short *s, int color);
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.16: for thread-safe use of gdImageStringFT and friends,
|
||||
call this before allowing any thread to call gdImageStringFT.
|
||||
Otherwise it is invoked by the first thread to invoke
|
||||
gdImageStringFT, with a very small but real risk of a race condition.
|
||||
Return 0 on success, nonzero on failure to initialize freetype. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdFontCacheSetup (void);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Optional: clean up after application is done using fonts in
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE( )
|
||||
gdImageStringFT(). */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdFontCacheShutdown (void);
|
||||
/* 2.0.20: for backwards compatibility. A few applications did start calling
|
||||
this function when it first appeared although it was never documented.
|
||||
Simply invokes gdFontCacheShutdown. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdFreeFontCache (void);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Calls gdImageStringFT. Provided for backwards compatibility only. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(char *) gdImageStringTTF (gdImage * im, int *brect, int fg, char *fontlist,
|
||||
double ptsize, double angle, int x, int y,
|
||||
char *string);
|
||||
|
||||
/* FreeType 2 text output */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(char *) gdImageStringFT (gdImage * im, int *brect, int fg, char *fontlist,
|
||||
double ptsize, double angle, int x, int y,
|
||||
char *string);
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.5: provides an extensible way to pass additional parameters.
|
||||
Thanks to Wez Furlong, sorry for the delay. */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
int flags; /* Logical OR of gdFTEX_ values */
|
||||
double linespacing; /* fine tune line spacing for '\n' */
|
||||
int charmap; /* TBB: 2.0.12: may be gdFTEX_Unicode,
|
||||
gdFTEX_Shift_JIS, gdFTEX_Big5,
|
||||
or gdFTEX_Adobe_Custom;
|
||||
when not specified, maps are searched
|
||||
for in the above order. */
|
||||
int hdpi; /* if (flags & gdFTEX_RESOLUTION) */
|
||||
int vdpi; /* if (flags & gdFTEX_RESOLUTION) */
|
||||
char *xshow; /* if (flags & gdFTEX_XSHOW)
|
||||
then, on return, xshow is a malloc'ed
|
||||
string containing xshow position data for
|
||||
the last string.
|
||||
|
||||
NB. The caller is responsible for gdFree'ing
|
||||
the xshow string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
char *fontpath; /* if (flags & gdFTEX_RETURNFONTPATHNAME)
|
||||
then, on return, fontpath is a malloc'ed
|
||||
string containing the actual font file path name
|
||||
used, which can be interesting when fontconfig
|
||||
is in use.
|
||||
|
||||
The caller is responsible for gdFree'ing the
|
||||
fontpath string.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdFTStringExtra, *gdFTStringExtraPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_LINESPACE 1
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_CHARMAP 2
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_RESOLUTION 4
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_DISABLE_KERNING 8
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_XSHOW 16
|
||||
/* The default unless gdFTUseFontConfig(1); has been called:
|
||||
fontlist is a full or partial font file pathname or list thereof
|
||||
(i.e. just like before 2.0.29) */
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_FONTPATHNAME 32
|
||||
/* Necessary to use fontconfig patterns instead of font pathnames
|
||||
as the fontlist argument, unless gdFTUseFontConfig(1); has
|
||||
been called. New in 2.0.29 */
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_FONTCONFIG 64
|
||||
/* Sometimes interesting when fontconfig is used: the fontpath
|
||||
element of the structure above will contain a gdMalloc'd string
|
||||
copy of the actual font file pathname used, if this flag is set
|
||||
when the call is made */
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_RETURNFONTPATHNAME 128
|
||||
|
||||
/* If flag is nonzero, the fontlist parameter to gdImageStringFT
|
||||
and gdImageStringFTEx shall be assumed to be a fontconfig font pattern
|
||||
if fontconfig was compiled into gd. This function returns zero
|
||||
if fontconfig is not available, nonzero otherwise. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdFTUseFontConfig(int flag);
|
||||
|
||||
/* These are NOT flags; set one in 'charmap' if you set the
|
||||
gdFTEX_CHARMAP bit in 'flags'. */
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_Unicode 0
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_Shift_JIS 1
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_Big5 2
|
||||
#define gdFTEX_Adobe_Custom 3
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(char *) gdImageStringFTEx (gdImage * im, int *brect, int fg, char *fontlist,
|
||||
double ptsize, double angle, int x, int y,
|
||||
char *string, gdFTStringExtraPtr strex);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Point type for use in polygon drawing. */
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
int x, y;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdPoint, *gdPointPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
int x, y;
|
||||
int width, height;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdRect, *gdRectPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePolygon (gdImagePtr im, gdPointPtr p, int n, int c);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageOpenPolygon (gdImagePtr im, gdPointPtr p, int n, int c);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFilledPolygon (gdImagePtr im, gdPointPtr p, int n, int c);
|
||||
|
||||
/* These functions still work with truecolor images,
|
||||
for which they never return error. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorAllocate (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b);
|
||||
/* gd 2.0: palette entries with non-opaque transparency are permitted. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorAllocateAlpha (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b, int a);
|
||||
/* Assumes opaque is the preferred alpha channel value */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorClosest (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b);
|
||||
/* Closest match taking all four parameters into account.
|
||||
A slightly different color with the same transparency
|
||||
beats the exact same color with radically different
|
||||
transparency */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorClosestAlpha (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b, int a);
|
||||
/* An alternate method */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorClosestHWB (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b);
|
||||
/* Returns exact, 100% opaque matches only */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorExact (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b);
|
||||
/* Returns an exact match only, including alpha */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorExactAlpha (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b, int a);
|
||||
/* Opaque only */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorResolve (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b);
|
||||
/* Based on gdImageColorExactAlpha and gdImageColorClosestAlpha */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorResolveAlpha (gdImagePtr im, int r, int g, int b, int a);
|
||||
|
||||
/* A simpler way to obtain an opaque truecolor value for drawing on a
|
||||
truecolor image. Not for use with palette images! */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdTrueColor(r, g, b) (((r) << 16) + \
|
||||
((g) << 8) + \
|
||||
(b))
|
||||
|
||||
/* Returns a truecolor value with an alpha channel component.
|
||||
gdAlphaMax (127, **NOT 255**) is transparent, 0 is completely
|
||||
opaque. */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdTrueColorAlpha(r, g, b, a) (((a) << 24) + \
|
||||
((r) << 16) + \
|
||||
((g) << 8) + \
|
||||
(b))
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageColorDeallocate (gdImagePtr im, int color);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Converts a truecolor image to a palette-based image,
|
||||
using a high-quality two-pass quantization routine
|
||||
which attempts to preserve alpha channel information
|
||||
as well as R/G/B color information when creating
|
||||
a palette. If ditherFlag is set, the image will be
|
||||
dithered to approximate colors better, at the expense
|
||||
of some obvious "speckling." colorsWanted can be
|
||||
anything up to 256. If the original source image
|
||||
includes photographic information or anything that
|
||||
came out of a JPEG, 256 is strongly recommended.
|
||||
|
||||
Better yet, don't use these function -- write real
|
||||
truecolor PNGs and JPEGs. The disk space gain of
|
||||
conversion to palette is not great (for small images
|
||||
it can be negative) and the quality loss is ugly.
|
||||
|
||||
DIFFERENCES: gdImageCreatePaletteFromTrueColor creates and
|
||||
returns a new image. gdImageTrueColorToPalette modifies
|
||||
an existing image, and the truecolor pixels are discarded. */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCreatePaletteFromTrueColor (gdImagePtr im, int ditherFlag,
|
||||
int colorsWanted);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageTrueColorToPalette (gdImagePtr im, int ditherFlag,
|
||||
int colorsWanted);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Specifies a color index (if a palette image) or an
|
||||
RGB color (if a truecolor image) which should be
|
||||
considered 100% transparent. FOR TRUECOLOR IMAGES,
|
||||
THIS IS IGNORED IF AN ALPHA CHANNEL IS BEING
|
||||
SAVED. Use gdImageSaveAlpha(im, 0); to
|
||||
turn off the saving of a full alpha channel in
|
||||
a truecolor image. Note that gdImageColorTransparent
|
||||
is usually compatible with older browsers that
|
||||
do not understand full alpha channels well. TBB */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageColorTransparent (gdImagePtr im, int color);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePaletteCopy (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src);
|
||||
|
||||
typedef int (*gdCallbackImageColor)(gdImagePtr im, int src);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorReplace(gdImagePtr im, int src, int dst);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorReplaceThreshold(gdImagePtr im, int src, int dst, float threshold);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorReplaceArray(gdImagePtr im, int len, int *src, int *dst);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageColorReplaceCallback(gdImagePtr im, gdCallbackImageColor callback);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGif (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePng (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePngCtx (gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifCtx (gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageTiff(gdImagePtr im, FILE *outFile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageTiffPtr(gdImagePtr im, int *size);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageTiffCtx(gdImagePtr image, gdIOCtx *out);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageBmpPtr(gdImagePtr im, int *size, int compression);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageBmp(gdImagePtr im, FILE *outFile, int compression);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageBmpCtx(gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtxPtr out, int compression);
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.12: Compression level: 0-9 or -1, where 0 is NO COMPRESSION at all,
|
||||
1 is FASTEST but produces larger files, 9 provides the best
|
||||
compression (smallest files) but takes a long time to compress, and
|
||||
-1 selects the default compiled into the zlib library. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePngEx (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out, int level);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePngCtxEx (gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx * out, int level);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageWBMP (gdImagePtr image, int fg, FILE * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageWBMPCtx (gdImagePtr image, int fg, gdIOCtx * out);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Guaranteed to correctly free memory returned
|
||||
by the gdImage*Ptr functions */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdFree (void *m);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageWBMPPtr (gdImagePtr im, int *size, int fg);
|
||||
|
||||
/* 100 is highest quality (there is always a little loss with JPEG).
|
||||
0 is lowest. 10 is about the lowest useful setting. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageJpeg (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out, int quality);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageJpegCtx (gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx * out, int quality);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageJpegPtr (gdImagePtr im, int *size, int quality);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Legal values for Disposal. gdDisposalNone is always used by
|
||||
the built-in optimizer if previm is passed. */
|
||||
|
||||
enum {
|
||||
gdDisposalUnknown,
|
||||
gdDisposalNone,
|
||||
gdDisposalRestoreBackground,
|
||||
gdDisposalRestorePrevious
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimBegin(gdImagePtr im, FILE *outFile, int GlobalCM, int Loops);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimAdd(gdImagePtr im, FILE *outFile, int LocalCM, int LeftOfs, int TopOfs, int Delay, int Disposal, gdImagePtr previm);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimEnd(FILE *outFile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimBeginCtx(gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx *out, int GlobalCM, int Loops);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimAddCtx(gdImagePtr im, gdIOCtx *out, int LocalCM, int LeftOfs, int TopOfs, int Delay, int Disposal, gdImagePtr previm);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGifAnimEndCtx(gdIOCtx *out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGifAnimBeginPtr(gdImagePtr im, int *size, int GlobalCM, int Loops);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGifAnimAddPtr(gdImagePtr im, int *size, int LocalCM, int LeftOfs, int TopOfs, int Delay, int Disposal, gdImagePtr previm);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGifAnimEndPtr(int *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/* A custom data sink. For backwards compatibility. Use
|
||||
gdIOCtx instead. */
|
||||
/* The sink function must return -1 on error, otherwise the number
|
||||
of bytes written, which must be equal to len. */
|
||||
/* context will be passed to your sink function. */
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
int (*sink) (void *context, const char *buffer, int len);
|
||||
void *context;
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdSink, *gdSinkPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImagePngToSink (gdImagePtr im, gdSinkPtr out);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGd (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageGd2 (gdImagePtr im, FILE * out, int cs, int fmt);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGifPtr (gdImagePtr im, int *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImagePngPtr (gdImagePtr im, int *size);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImagePngPtrEx (gdImagePtr im, int *size, int level);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGdPtr (gdImagePtr im, int *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Best to free this memory with gdFree(), not free() */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdImageGd2Ptr (gdImagePtr im, int cs, int fmt, int *size);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Style is a bitwise OR ( | operator ) of these.
|
||||
gdArc and gdChord are mutually exclusive;
|
||||
gdChord just connects the starting and ending
|
||||
angles with a straight line, while gdArc produces
|
||||
a rounded edge. gdPie is a synonym for gdArc.
|
||||
gdNoFill indicates that the arc or chord should be
|
||||
outlined, not filled. gdEdged, used together with
|
||||
gdNoFill, indicates that the beginning and ending
|
||||
angles should be connected to the center; this is
|
||||
a good way to outline (rather than fill) a
|
||||
'pie slice'. */
|
||||
#define gdArc 0
|
||||
#define gdPie gdArc
|
||||
#define gdChord 1
|
||||
#define gdNoFill 2
|
||||
#define gdEdged 4
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFilledArc (gdImagePtr im, int cx, int cy, int w, int h, int s,
|
||||
int e, int color, int style);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageArc (gdImagePtr im, int cx, int cy, int w, int h, int s, int e,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageEllipse(gdImagePtr im, int cx, int cy, int w, int h, int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFilledEllipse (gdImagePtr im, int cx, int cy, int w, int h,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFillToBorder (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y, int border,
|
||||
int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFill (gdImagePtr im, int x, int y, int color);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopy (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src, int dstX, int dstY,
|
||||
int srcX, int srcY, int w, int h);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopyMerge (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src, int dstX, int dstY,
|
||||
int srcX, int srcY, int w, int h, int pct);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopyMergeGray (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src, int dstX,
|
||||
int dstY, int srcX, int srcY, int w, int h,
|
||||
int pct);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Stretches or shrinks to fit, as needed. Does NOT attempt
|
||||
to average the entire set of source pixels that scale down onto the
|
||||
destination pixel. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopyResized (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src, int dstX, int dstY,
|
||||
int srcX, int srcY, int dstW, int dstH, int srcW,
|
||||
int srcH);
|
||||
|
||||
/* gd 2.0: stretches or shrinks to fit, as needed. When called with a
|
||||
truecolor destination image, this function averages the
|
||||
entire set of source pixels that scale down onto the
|
||||
destination pixel, taking into account what portion of the
|
||||
destination pixel each source pixel represents. This is a
|
||||
floating point operation, but this is not a performance issue
|
||||
on modern hardware, except for some embedded devices. If the
|
||||
destination is a palette image, gdImageCopyResized is
|
||||
substituted automatically. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopyResampled (gdImagePtr dst, gdImagePtr src, int dstX,
|
||||
int dstY, int srcX, int srcY, int dstW, int dstH,
|
||||
int srcW, int srcH);
|
||||
|
||||
/* gd 2.0.8: gdImageCopyRotated is added. Source
|
||||
is a rectangle, with its upper left corner at
|
||||
srcX and srcY. Destination is the *center* of
|
||||
the rotated copy. Angle is in degrees, same as
|
||||
gdImageArc. Floating point destination center
|
||||
coordinates allow accurate rotation of
|
||||
objects of odd-numbered width or height. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageCopyRotated (gdImagePtr dst,
|
||||
gdImagePtr src,
|
||||
double dstX, double dstY,
|
||||
int srcX, int srcY,
|
||||
int srcWidth, int srcHeight, int angle);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetBrush (gdImagePtr im, gdImagePtr brush);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetTile (gdImagePtr im, gdImagePtr tile);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetAntiAliased (gdImagePtr im, int c);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetAntiAliasedDontBlend (gdImagePtr im, int c, int dont_blend);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetStyle (gdImagePtr im, int *style, int noOfPixels);
|
||||
/* Line thickness (defaults to 1). Affects lines, ellipses,
|
||||
rectangles, polygons and so forth. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSetThickness (gdImagePtr im, int thickness);
|
||||
/* On or off (1 or 0) for all three of these. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageInterlace (gdImagePtr im, int interlaceArg);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageAlphaBlending (gdImagePtr im, int alphaBlendingArg);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSaveAlpha (gdImagePtr im, int saveAlphaArg);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageCrop(gdImagePtr src, const gdRect *crop);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageAutoCrop(gdImagePtr im, const unsigned int mode);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageThresholdCrop(gdImagePtr im, const unsigned int color, const float threshold);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFlipHorizontal(gdImagePtr im);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFlipVertical(gdImagePtr im);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageFlipBoth(gdImagePtr im);
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageNeuQuant(gdImagePtr im, const int max_color, int sample_factor);
|
||||
|
||||
enum gdPixelateMode {
|
||||
GD_PIXELATE_UPPERLEFT,
|
||||
GD_PIXELATE_AVERAGE
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImagePixelate(gdImagePtr im, int block_size, const unsigned int mode);
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
int sub;
|
||||
int plus;
|
||||
unsigned int num_colors;
|
||||
int *colors;
|
||||
unsigned int seed;
|
||||
} gdScatter, *gdScatterPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageScatter(gdImagePtr im, int sub, int plus);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageScatterColor(gdImagePtr im, int sub, int plus, int colors[], unsigned int num_colors);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageScatterEx(gdImagePtr im, gdScatterPtr s);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros to access information about images. */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Returns nonzero if the image is a truecolor image,
|
||||
zero for a palette image. */
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdImageTrueColor(im) ((im)->trueColor)
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdImageSX(im) ((im)->sx)
|
||||
#define gdImageSY(im) ((im)->sy)
|
||||
#define gdImageColorsTotal(im) ((im)->colorsTotal)
|
||||
#define gdImageRed(im, c) ((im)->trueColor ? (int) gdTrueColorGetRed(c) : \
|
||||
(im)->red[(c)])
|
||||
#define gdImageGreen(im, c) ((im)->trueColor ? (int) gdTrueColorGetGreen(c) : \
|
||||
(im)->green[(c)])
|
||||
#define gdImageBlue(im, c) ((im)->trueColor ? (int) gdTrueColorGetBlue(c) : \
|
||||
(im)->blue[(c)])
|
||||
#define gdImageAlpha(im, c) ((im)->trueColor ? (int) gdTrueColorGetAlpha(c) : \
|
||||
(im)->alpha[(c)])
|
||||
#define gdImageGetTransparent(im) ((im)->transparent)
|
||||
#define gdImageGetInterlaced(im) ((im)->interlace)
|
||||
|
||||
/* These macros provide direct access to pixels in
|
||||
palette-based and truecolor images, respectively.
|
||||
If you use these macros, you must perform your own
|
||||
bounds checking. Use of the macro for the correct type
|
||||
of image is also your responsibility. */
|
||||
#define gdImagePalettePixel(im, x, y) (im)->pixels[(y)][(x)]
|
||||
#define gdImageTrueColorPixel(im, x, y) (im)->tpixels[(y)][(x)]
|
||||
|
||||
#define gdImageResolutionX(im) (im)->res_x
|
||||
#define gdImageResolutionY(im) (im)->res_y
|
||||
|
||||
/* I/O Support routines. */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdIOCtx *) gdNewFileCtx (FILE *);
|
||||
/* If data is null, size is ignored and an initial data buffer is
|
||||
allocated automatically. NOTE: this function assumes gd has the right
|
||||
to free or reallocate "data" at will! Also note that gd will free
|
||||
"data" when the IO context is freed. If data is not null, it must point
|
||||
to memory allocated with gdMalloc, or by a call to gdImage[something]Ptr.
|
||||
If not, see gdNewDynamicCtxEx for an alternative. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdIOCtx *) gdNewDynamicCtx (int size, void *data);
|
||||
/* 2.0.21: if freeFlag is nonzero, gd will free and/or reallocate "data" as
|
||||
needed as described above. If freeFlag is zero, gd will never free
|
||||
or reallocate "data", which means that the context should only be used
|
||||
for *reading* an image from a memory buffer, or writing an image to a
|
||||
memory buffer which is already large enough. If the memory buffer is
|
||||
not large enough and an image write is attempted, the write operation
|
||||
will fail. Those wishing to write an image to a buffer in memory have
|
||||
a much simpler alternative in the gdImage[something]Ptr functions. */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdIOCtx *) gdNewDynamicCtxEx (int size, void *data, int freeFlag);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdIOCtx *) gdNewSSCtx (gdSourcePtr in, gdSinkPtr out);
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void *) gdDPExtractData (struct gdIOCtx *ctx, int *size);
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD2_CHUNKSIZE 128
|
||||
#define GD2_CHUNKSIZE_MIN 64
|
||||
#define GD2_CHUNKSIZE_MAX 4096
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD2_VERS 2
|
||||
#define GD2_ID "gd2"
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD2_FMT_RAW 1
|
||||
#define GD2_FMT_COMPRESSED 2
|
||||
|
||||
/* Image comparison definitions */
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(int) gdImageCompare (gdImagePtr im1, gdImagePtr im2);
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_IMAGE 1 /* Actual image IS different */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_NUM_COLORS 2 /* Number of Colours in pallette differ */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_COLOR 4 /* Image colours differ */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_SIZE_X 8 /* Image width differs */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_SIZE_Y 16 /* Image heights differ */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_TRANSPARENT 32 /* Transparent colour */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_BACKGROUND 64 /* Background colour */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_INTERLACE 128 /* Interlaced setting */
|
||||
#define GD_CMP_TRUECOLOR 256 /* Truecolor vs palette differs */
|
||||
|
||||
#define GD_RESOLUTION 96 /* dots per inch */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* newfangled special effects */
|
||||
#include "gdfx.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* GD_H */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
52
portlibs/include/gd_io.h
Normal file
52
portlibs/include/gd_io.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef GD_IO_H
|
||||
#define GD_IO_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef VMS
|
||||
# define Putchar gdPutchar
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct gdIOCtx
|
||||
{
|
||||
int (*getC)(struct gdIOCtx *);
|
||||
int (*getBuf)(struct gdIOCtx *, void *, int);
|
||||
void (*putC)(struct gdIOCtx *, int);
|
||||
int (*putBuf)(struct gdIOCtx *, const void *, int);
|
||||
/* seek must return 1 on SUCCESS, 0 on FAILURE. Unlike fseek! */
|
||||
int (*seek)(struct gdIOCtx *, const int);
|
||||
long (*tell)(struct gdIOCtx *);
|
||||
void (*gd_free)(struct gdIOCtx *);
|
||||
}
|
||||
gdIOCtx;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct gdIOCtx *gdIOCtxPtr;
|
||||
|
||||
void Putword(int w, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
void Putchar(int c, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
void gdPutC(const unsigned char c, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdPutBuf(const void *, int, gdIOCtx *);
|
||||
void gdPutWord(int w, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
void gdPutInt(int w, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
int gdGetC(gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdGetBuf(void *, int, gdIOCtx *);
|
||||
int gdGetByte(int *result, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdGetWord(int *result, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdGetWordLSB(signed short int *result, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdGetInt(int *result, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
int gdGetIntLSB(signed int *result, gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
int gdSeek(gdIOCtx *ctx, const int offset);
|
||||
long gdTell(gdIOCtx *ctx);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
73
portlibs/include/gdfx.h
Normal file
73
portlibs/include/gdfx.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef GDFX_H
|
||||
#define GDFX_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
#include "gd.h"
|
||||
|
||||
/* im MUST be square, but can have any size. Returns a new image
|
||||
of width and height radius * 2, in which the X axis of
|
||||
the original has been remapped to theta (angle) and the Y axis
|
||||
of the original has been remapped to rho (distance from center).
|
||||
This is known as a "polar coordinate transform." */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(gdImagePtr) gdImageSquareToCircle(gdImagePtr im, int radius);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Draws the text 'top' and 'bottom' on 'im', curved along the
|
||||
edge of a circle of radius 'radius', with its
|
||||
center at 'cx' and 'cy'. 'top' is written clockwise
|
||||
along the top; 'bottom' is written counterclockwise
|
||||
along the bottom. 'textRadius' determines the 'height'
|
||||
of each character; if 'textRadius' is 1/2 of 'radius',
|
||||
characters extend halfway from the edge to the center.
|
||||
'fillPortion' varies from 0 to 1.0, with useful values
|
||||
from about 0.4 to 0.9, and determines how much of the
|
||||
180 degrees of arc assigned to each section of text
|
||||
is actually occupied by text; 0.9 looks better than
|
||||
1.0 which is rather crowded. 'font' is a freetype
|
||||
font; see gdImageStringFT. 'points' is passed to the
|
||||
freetype engine and has an effect on hinting; although
|
||||
the size of the text is determined by radius, textRadius,
|
||||
and fillPortion, you should pass a point size that
|
||||
'hints' appropriately -- if you know the text will be
|
||||
large, pass a large point size such as 24.0 to get the
|
||||
best results. 'fgcolor' can be any color, and may have
|
||||
an alpha component, do blending, etc.
|
||||
|
||||
Returns 0 on success, or an error string. */
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(char *) gdImageStringFTCircle(
|
||||
gdImagePtr im,
|
||||
int cx,
|
||||
int cy,
|
||||
double radius,
|
||||
double textRadius,
|
||||
double fillPortion,
|
||||
char *font,
|
||||
double points,
|
||||
char *top,
|
||||
char *bottom,
|
||||
int fgcolor);
|
||||
|
||||
/* 2.0.16:
|
||||
* Sharpen function added on 2003-11-19
|
||||
* by Paul Troughton (paul<dot>troughton<at>ieee<dot>org)
|
||||
* Simple 3x3 convolution kernel
|
||||
* Makes use of seperability
|
||||
* Faster, but less flexible, than full-blown unsharp masking
|
||||
* pct is sharpening percentage, and can be greater than 100
|
||||
* Silently does nothing to non-truecolor images
|
||||
* Silently does nothing for pct<0, as not a useful blurring function
|
||||
* Leaves transparency/alpha-channel untouched
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
BGD_DECLARE(void) gdImageSharpen (gdImagePtr im, int pct);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* GDFX_H */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
44
portlibs/include/jconfig.h
Normal file
44
portlibs/include/jconfig.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
|
||||
/* jconfig.h. Generated automatically by configure. */
|
||||
/* jconfig.cfg --- source file edited by configure script */
|
||||
/* see jconfig.doc for explanations */
|
||||
|
||||
#define HAVE_PROTOTYPES
|
||||
#define HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR
|
||||
#define HAVE_UNSIGNED_SHORT
|
||||
#undef void
|
||||
#undef const
|
||||
#undef CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDDEF_H
|
||||
#define HAVE_STDLIB_H
|
||||
#undef NEED_BSD_STRINGS
|
||||
#define NEED_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#undef NEED_FAR_POINTERS /* DJGPP uses flat 32-bit addressing */
|
||||
#undef NEED_SHORT_EXTERNAL_NAMES
|
||||
/* Define this if you get warnings about undefined structures. */
|
||||
#undef INCOMPLETE_TYPES_BROKEN
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JPEG_INTERNALS
|
||||
|
||||
#undef RIGHT_SHIFT_IS_UNSIGNED
|
||||
#define INLINE __inline__
|
||||
/* These are for configuring the JPEG memory manager. */
|
||||
#undef DEFAULT_MAX_MEM
|
||||
#undef NO_MKTEMP
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* JPEG_INTERNALS */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JPEG_CJPEG_DJPEG
|
||||
|
||||
#define BMP_SUPPORTED /* BMP image file format */
|
||||
#define GIF_SUPPORTED /* GIF image file format */
|
||||
#define PPM_SUPPORTED /* PBMPLUS PPM/PGM image file format */
|
||||
#undef RLE_SUPPORTED /* Utah RLE image file format */
|
||||
#define TARGA_SUPPORTED /* Targa image file format */
|
||||
|
||||
#undef TWO_FILE_COMMANDLINE /* optional */
|
||||
#undef USE_SETMODE /* Needed to make one-file style work in DJGPP */
|
||||
#undef NEED_SIGNAL_CATCHER /* Define this if you use jmemname.c */
|
||||
#undef DONT_USE_B_MODE
|
||||
#undef PROGRESS_REPORT /* optional */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* JPEG_CJPEG_DJPEG */
|
304
portlibs/include/jerror.h
Normal file
304
portlibs/include/jerror.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,304 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* jerror.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 1994-1997, Thomas G. Lane.
|
||||
* Modified 1997-2009 by Guido Vollbeding.
|
||||
* This file is part of the Independent JPEG Group's software.
|
||||
* For conditions of distribution and use, see the accompanying README file.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file defines the error and message codes for the JPEG library.
|
||||
* Edit this file to add new codes, or to translate the message strings to
|
||||
* some other language.
|
||||
* A set of error-reporting macros are defined too. Some applications using
|
||||
* the JPEG library may wish to include this file to get the error codes
|
||||
* and/or the macros.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* To define the enum list of message codes, include this file without
|
||||
* defining macro JMESSAGE. To create a message string table, include it
|
||||
* again with a suitable JMESSAGE definition (see jerror.c for an example).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef JMESSAGE
|
||||
#ifndef JERROR_H
|
||||
/* First time through, define the enum list */
|
||||
#define JMAKE_ENUM_LIST
|
||||
#else
|
||||
/* Repeated inclusions of this file are no-ops unless JMESSAGE is defined */
|
||||
#define JMESSAGE(code,string)
|
||||
#endif /* JERROR_H */
|
||||
#endif /* JMESSAGE */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JMAKE_ENUM_LIST
|
||||
|
||||
typedef enum {
|
||||
|
||||
#define JMESSAGE(code,string) code ,
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* JMAKE_ENUM_LIST */
|
||||
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JMSG_NOMESSAGE, "Bogus message code %d") /* Must be first entry! */
|
||||
|
||||
/* For maintenance convenience, list is alphabetical by message code name */
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_ALIGN_TYPE, "ALIGN_TYPE is wrong, please fix")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_ALLOC_CHUNK, "MAX_ALLOC_CHUNK is wrong, please fix")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_BUFFER_MODE, "Bogus buffer control mode")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_COMPONENT_ID, "Invalid component ID %d in SOS")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_CROP_SPEC, "Invalid crop request")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_DCT_COEF, "DCT coefficient out of range")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_DCTSIZE, "DCT scaled block size %dx%d not supported")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_DROP_SAMPLING,
|
||||
"Component index %d: mismatching sampling ratio %d:%d, %d:%d, %c")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_HUFF_TABLE, "Bogus Huffman table definition")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_IN_COLORSPACE, "Bogus input colorspace")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_J_COLORSPACE, "Bogus JPEG colorspace")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_LENGTH, "Bogus marker length")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_LIB_VERSION,
|
||||
"Wrong JPEG library version: library is %d, caller expects %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_MCU_SIZE, "Sampling factors too large for interleaved scan")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_POOL_ID, "Invalid memory pool code %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_PRECISION, "Unsupported JPEG data precision %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_PROGRESSION,
|
||||
"Invalid progressive parameters Ss=%d Se=%d Ah=%d Al=%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_PROG_SCRIPT,
|
||||
"Invalid progressive parameters at scan script entry %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_SAMPLING, "Bogus sampling factors")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_SCAN_SCRIPT, "Invalid scan script at entry %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_STATE, "Improper call to JPEG library in state %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_STRUCT_SIZE,
|
||||
"JPEG parameter struct mismatch: library thinks size is %u, caller expects %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BAD_VIRTUAL_ACCESS, "Bogus virtual array access")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_BUFFER_SIZE, "Buffer passed to JPEG library is too small")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_CANT_SUSPEND, "Suspension not allowed here")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_CCIR601_NOTIMPL, "CCIR601 sampling not implemented yet")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_COMPONENT_COUNT, "Too many color components: %d, max %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_CONVERSION_NOTIMPL, "Unsupported color conversion request")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_DAC_INDEX, "Bogus DAC index %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_DAC_VALUE, "Bogus DAC value 0x%x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_DHT_INDEX, "Bogus DHT index %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_DQT_INDEX, "Bogus DQT index %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_EMPTY_IMAGE, "Empty JPEG image (DNL not supported)")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_EMS_READ, "Read from EMS failed")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_EMS_WRITE, "Write to EMS failed")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_EOI_EXPECTED, "Didn't expect more than one scan")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_FILE_READ, "Input file read error")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_FILE_WRITE, "Output file write error --- out of disk space?")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_FRACT_SAMPLE_NOTIMPL, "Fractional sampling not implemented yet")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_HUFF_CLEN_OVERFLOW, "Huffman code size table overflow")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_HUFF_MISSING_CODE, "Missing Huffman code table entry")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_IMAGE_TOO_BIG, "Maximum supported image dimension is %u pixels")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_INPUT_EMPTY, "Empty input file")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_INPUT_EOF, "Premature end of input file")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_MISMATCHED_QUANT_TABLE,
|
||||
"Cannot transcode due to multiple use of quantization table %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_MISSING_DATA, "Scan script does not transmit all data")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_MODE_CHANGE, "Invalid color quantization mode change")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NOTIMPL, "Not implemented yet")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NOT_COMPILED, "Requested feature was omitted at compile time")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_ARITH_TABLE, "Arithmetic table 0x%02x was not defined")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_BACKING_STORE, "Backing store not supported")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_HUFF_TABLE, "Huffman table 0x%02x was not defined")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_IMAGE, "JPEG datastream contains no image")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_QUANT_TABLE, "Quantization table 0x%02x was not defined")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_NO_SOI, "Not a JPEG file: starts with 0x%02x 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_OUT_OF_MEMORY, "Insufficient memory (case %d)")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_QUANT_COMPONENTS,
|
||||
"Cannot quantize more than %d color components")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_QUANT_FEW_COLORS, "Cannot quantize to fewer than %d colors")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_QUANT_MANY_COLORS, "Cannot quantize to more than %d colors")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_SOF_DUPLICATE, "Invalid JPEG file structure: two SOF markers")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_SOF_NO_SOS, "Invalid JPEG file structure: missing SOS marker")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_SOF_UNSUPPORTED, "Unsupported JPEG process: SOF type 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_SOI_DUPLICATE, "Invalid JPEG file structure: two SOI markers")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_SOS_NO_SOF, "Invalid JPEG file structure: SOS before SOF")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_TFILE_CREATE, "Failed to create temporary file %s")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_TFILE_READ, "Read failed on temporary file")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_TFILE_SEEK, "Seek failed on temporary file")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_TFILE_WRITE,
|
||||
"Write failed on temporary file --- out of disk space?")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_TOO_LITTLE_DATA, "Application transferred too few scanlines")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_UNKNOWN_MARKER, "Unsupported marker type 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_VIRTUAL_BUG, "Virtual array controller messed up")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_WIDTH_OVERFLOW, "Image too wide for this implementation")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_XMS_READ, "Read from XMS failed")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JERR_XMS_WRITE, "Write to XMS failed")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JMSG_COPYRIGHT, JCOPYRIGHT)
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JMSG_VERSION, JVERSION)
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_16BIT_TABLES,
|
||||
"Caution: quantization tables are too coarse for baseline JPEG")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_ADOBE,
|
||||
"Adobe APP14 marker: version %d, flags 0x%04x 0x%04x, transform %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_APP0, "Unknown APP0 marker (not JFIF), length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_APP14, "Unknown APP14 marker (not Adobe), length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_DAC, "Define Arithmetic Table 0x%02x: 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_DHT, "Define Huffman Table 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_DQT, "Define Quantization Table %d precision %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_DRI, "Define Restart Interval %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_EMS_CLOSE, "Freed EMS handle %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_EMS_OPEN, "Obtained EMS handle %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_EOI, "End Of Image")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_HUFFBITS, " %3d %3d %3d %3d %3d %3d %3d %3d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_JFIF, "JFIF APP0 marker: version %d.%02d, density %dx%d %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_JFIF_BADTHUMBNAILSIZE,
|
||||
"Warning: thumbnail image size does not match data length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_JFIF_EXTENSION,
|
||||
"JFIF extension marker: type 0x%02x, length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_JFIF_THUMBNAIL, " with %d x %d thumbnail image")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_MISC_MARKER, "Miscellaneous marker 0x%02x, length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_PARMLESS_MARKER, "Unexpected marker 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_QUANTVALS, " %4u %4u %4u %4u %4u %4u %4u %4u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_QUANT_3_NCOLORS, "Quantizing to %d = %d*%d*%d colors")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_QUANT_NCOLORS, "Quantizing to %d colors")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_QUANT_SELECTED, "Selected %d colors for quantization")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_RECOVERY_ACTION, "At marker 0x%02x, recovery action %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_RST, "RST%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SMOOTH_NOTIMPL,
|
||||
"Smoothing not supported with nonstandard sampling ratios")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOF, "Start Of Frame 0x%02x: width=%u, height=%u, components=%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOF_COMPONENT, " Component %d: %dhx%dv q=%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOI, "Start of Image")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOS, "Start Of Scan: %d components")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOS_COMPONENT, " Component %d: dc=%d ac=%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_SOS_PARAMS, " Ss=%d, Se=%d, Ah=%d, Al=%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_TFILE_CLOSE, "Closed temporary file %s")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_TFILE_OPEN, "Opened temporary file %s")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_THUMB_JPEG,
|
||||
"JFIF extension marker: JPEG-compressed thumbnail image, length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_THUMB_PALETTE,
|
||||
"JFIF extension marker: palette thumbnail image, length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_THUMB_RGB,
|
||||
"JFIF extension marker: RGB thumbnail image, length %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_UNKNOWN_IDS,
|
||||
"Unrecognized component IDs %d %d %d, assuming YCbCr")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_XMS_CLOSE, "Freed XMS handle %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JTRC_XMS_OPEN, "Obtained XMS handle %u")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_ADOBE_XFORM, "Unknown Adobe color transform code %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_ARITH_BAD_CODE, "Corrupt JPEG data: bad arithmetic code")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_BOGUS_PROGRESSION,
|
||||
"Inconsistent progression sequence for component %d coefficient %d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_EXTRANEOUS_DATA,
|
||||
"Corrupt JPEG data: %u extraneous bytes before marker 0x%02x")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_HIT_MARKER, "Corrupt JPEG data: premature end of data segment")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_HUFF_BAD_CODE, "Corrupt JPEG data: bad Huffman code")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_JFIF_MAJOR, "Warning: unknown JFIF revision number %d.%02d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_JPEG_EOF, "Premature end of JPEG file")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_MUST_RESYNC,
|
||||
"Corrupt JPEG data: found marker 0x%02x instead of RST%d")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_NOT_SEQUENTIAL, "Invalid SOS parameters for sequential JPEG")
|
||||
JMESSAGE(JWRN_TOO_MUCH_DATA, "Application transferred too many scanlines")
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JMAKE_ENUM_LIST
|
||||
|
||||
JMSG_LASTMSGCODE
|
||||
} J_MESSAGE_CODE;
|
||||
|
||||
#undef JMAKE_ENUM_LIST
|
||||
#endif /* JMAKE_ENUM_LIST */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Zap JMESSAGE macro so that future re-inclusions do nothing by default */
|
||||
#undef JMESSAGE
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef JERROR_H
|
||||
#define JERROR_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* Macros to simplify using the error and trace message stuff */
|
||||
/* The first parameter is either type of cinfo pointer */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Fatal errors (print message and exit) */
|
||||
#define ERREXIT(cinfo,code) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXIT1(cinfo,code,p1) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXIT2(cinfo,code,p1,p2) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXIT3(cinfo,code,p1,p2,p3) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[2] = (p3), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXIT4(cinfo,code,p1,p2,p3,p4) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[2] = (p3), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[3] = (p4), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXIT6(cinfo,code,p1,p2,p3,p4,p5,p6) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[2] = (p3), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[3] = (p4), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[4] = (p5), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[5] = (p6), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
#define ERREXITS(cinfo,code,str) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
strncpy((cinfo)->err->msg_parm.s, (str), JMSG_STR_PARM_MAX), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->error_exit) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo)))
|
||||
|
||||
#define MAKESTMT(stuff) do { stuff } while (0)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Nonfatal errors (we can keep going, but the data is probably corrupt) */
|
||||
#define WARNMS(cinfo,code) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), -1))
|
||||
#define WARNMS1(cinfo,code,p1) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), -1))
|
||||
#define WARNMS2(cinfo,code,p1,p2) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), -1))
|
||||
|
||||
/* Informational/debugging messages */
|
||||
#define TRACEMS(cinfo,lvl,code) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)))
|
||||
#define TRACEMS1(cinfo,lvl,code,p1) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)))
|
||||
#define TRACEMS2(cinfo,lvl,code,p1,p2) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[0] = (p1), \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i[1] = (p2), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)))
|
||||
#define TRACEMS3(cinfo,lvl,code,p1,p2,p3) \
|
||||
MAKESTMT(int * _mp = (cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i; \
|
||||
_mp[0] = (p1); _mp[1] = (p2); _mp[2] = (p3); \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code); \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)); )
|
||||
#define TRACEMS4(cinfo,lvl,code,p1,p2,p3,p4) \
|
||||
MAKESTMT(int * _mp = (cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i; \
|
||||
_mp[0] = (p1); _mp[1] = (p2); _mp[2] = (p3); _mp[3] = (p4); \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code); \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)); )
|
||||
#define TRACEMS5(cinfo,lvl,code,p1,p2,p3,p4,p5) \
|
||||
MAKESTMT(int * _mp = (cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i; \
|
||||
_mp[0] = (p1); _mp[1] = (p2); _mp[2] = (p3); _mp[3] = (p4); \
|
||||
_mp[4] = (p5); \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code); \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)); )
|
||||
#define TRACEMS8(cinfo,lvl,code,p1,p2,p3,p4,p5,p6,p7,p8) \
|
||||
MAKESTMT(int * _mp = (cinfo)->err->msg_parm.i; \
|
||||
_mp[0] = (p1); _mp[1] = (p2); _mp[2] = (p3); _mp[3] = (p4); \
|
||||
_mp[4] = (p5); _mp[5] = (p6); _mp[6] = (p7); _mp[7] = (p8); \
|
||||
(cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code); \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)); )
|
||||
#define TRACEMSS(cinfo,lvl,code,str) \
|
||||
((cinfo)->err->msg_code = (code), \
|
||||
strncpy((cinfo)->err->msg_parm.s, (str), JMSG_STR_PARM_MAX), \
|
||||
(*(cinfo)->err->emit_message) ((j_common_ptr) (cinfo), (lvl)))
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* JERROR_H */
|
369
portlibs/include/jmorecfg.h
Normal file
369
portlibs/include/jmorecfg.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,369 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* jmorecfg.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 1991-1997, Thomas G. Lane.
|
||||
* Modified 1997-2011 by Guido Vollbeding.
|
||||
* This file is part of the Independent JPEG Group's software.
|
||||
* For conditions of distribution and use, see the accompanying README file.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This file contains additional configuration options that customize the
|
||||
* JPEG software for special applications or support machine-dependent
|
||||
* optimizations. Most users will not need to touch this file.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Define BITS_IN_JSAMPLE as either
|
||||
* 8 for 8-bit sample values (the usual setting)
|
||||
* 12 for 12-bit sample values
|
||||
* Only 8 and 12 are legal data precisions for lossy JPEG according to the
|
||||
* JPEG standard, and the IJG code does not support anything else!
|
||||
* We do not support run-time selection of data precision, sorry.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define BITS_IN_JSAMPLE 8 /* use 8 or 12 */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Maximum number of components (color channels) allowed in JPEG image.
|
||||
* To meet the letter of the JPEG spec, set this to 255. However, darn
|
||||
* few applications need more than 4 channels (maybe 5 for CMYK + alpha
|
||||
* mask). We recommend 10 as a reasonable compromise; use 4 if you are
|
||||
* really short on memory. (Each allowed component costs a hundred or so
|
||||
* bytes of storage, whether actually used in an image or not.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define MAX_COMPONENTS 10 /* maximum number of image components */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Basic data types.
|
||||
* You may need to change these if you have a machine with unusual data
|
||||
* type sizes; for example, "char" not 8 bits, "short" not 16 bits,
|
||||
* or "long" not 32 bits. We don't care whether "int" is 16 or 32 bits,
|
||||
* but it had better be at least 16.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Representation of a single sample (pixel element value).
|
||||
* We frequently allocate large arrays of these, so it's important to keep
|
||||
* them small. But if you have memory to burn and access to char or short
|
||||
* arrays is very slow on your hardware, you might want to change these.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if BITS_IN_JSAMPLE == 8
|
||||
/* JSAMPLE should be the smallest type that will hold the values 0..255.
|
||||
* You can use a signed char by having GETJSAMPLE mask it with 0xFF.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR
|
||||
|
||||
typedef unsigned char JSAMPLE;
|
||||
#define GETJSAMPLE(value) ((int) (value))
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* not HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef char JSAMPLE;
|
||||
#ifdef CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED
|
||||
#define GETJSAMPLE(value) ((int) (value))
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define GETJSAMPLE(value) ((int) (value) & 0xFF)
|
||||
#endif /* CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
|
||||
#define MAXJSAMPLE 255
|
||||
#define CENTERJSAMPLE 128
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* BITS_IN_JSAMPLE == 8 */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#if BITS_IN_JSAMPLE == 12
|
||||
/* JSAMPLE should be the smallest type that will hold the values 0..4095.
|
||||
* On nearly all machines "short" will do nicely.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef short JSAMPLE;
|
||||
#define GETJSAMPLE(value) ((int) (value))
|
||||
|
||||
#define MAXJSAMPLE 4095
|
||||
#define CENTERJSAMPLE 2048
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* BITS_IN_JSAMPLE == 12 */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Representation of a DCT frequency coefficient.
|
||||
* This should be a signed value of at least 16 bits; "short" is usually OK.
|
||||
* Again, we allocate large arrays of these, but you can change to int
|
||||
* if you have memory to burn and "short" is really slow.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef short JCOEF;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Compressed datastreams are represented as arrays of JOCTET.
|
||||
* These must be EXACTLY 8 bits wide, at least once they are written to
|
||||
* external storage. Note that when using the stdio data source/destination
|
||||
* managers, this is also the data type passed to fread/fwrite.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR
|
||||
|
||||
typedef unsigned char JOCTET;
|
||||
#define GETJOCTET(value) (value)
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* not HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
|
||||
typedef char JOCTET;
|
||||
#ifdef CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED
|
||||
#define GETJOCTET(value) (value)
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define GETJOCTET(value) ((value) & 0xFF)
|
||||
#endif /* CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* These typedefs are used for various table entries and so forth.
|
||||
* They must be at least as wide as specified; but making them too big
|
||||
* won't cost a huge amount of memory, so we don't provide special
|
||||
* extraction code like we did for JSAMPLE. (In other words, these
|
||||
* typedefs live at a different point on the speed/space tradeoff curve.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* UINT8 must hold at least the values 0..255. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR
|
||||
typedef unsigned char UINT8;
|
||||
#else /* not HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
#ifdef CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED
|
||||
typedef char UINT8;
|
||||
#else /* not CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED */
|
||||
typedef short UINT8;
|
||||
#endif /* CHAR_IS_UNSIGNED */
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_UNSIGNED_CHAR */
|
||||
|
||||
/* UINT16 must hold at least the values 0..65535. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_UNSIGNED_SHORT
|
||||
typedef unsigned short UINT16;
|
||||
#else /* not HAVE_UNSIGNED_SHORT */
|
||||
typedef unsigned int UINT16;
|
||||
#endif /* HAVE_UNSIGNED_SHORT */
|
||||
|
||||
/* INT16 must hold at least the values -32768..32767. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef XMD_H /* X11/xmd.h correctly defines INT16 */
|
||||
typedef short INT16;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* INT32 must hold at least signed 32-bit values. */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef XMD_H /* X11/xmd.h correctly defines INT32 */
|
||||
#ifndef _BASETSD_H_ /* Microsoft defines it in basetsd.h */
|
||||
#ifndef _BASETSD_H /* MinGW is slightly different */
|
||||
#ifndef QGLOBAL_H /* Qt defines it in qglobal.h */
|
||||
typedef long INT32;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Datatype used for image dimensions. The JPEG standard only supports
|
||||
* images up to 64K*64K due to 16-bit fields in SOF markers. Therefore
|
||||
* "unsigned int" is sufficient on all machines. However, if you need to
|
||||
* handle larger images and you don't mind deviating from the spec, you
|
||||
* can change this datatype.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef unsigned int JDIMENSION;
|
||||
|
||||
#define JPEG_MAX_DIMENSION 65500L /* a tad under 64K to prevent overflows */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* These macros are used in all function definitions and extern declarations.
|
||||
* You could modify them if you need to change function linkage conventions;
|
||||
* in particular, you'll need to do that to make the library a Windows DLL.
|
||||
* Another application is to make all functions global for use with debuggers
|
||||
* or code profilers that require it.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* a function called through method pointers: */
|
||||
#define METHODDEF(type) static type
|
||||
/* a function used only in its module: */
|
||||
#define LOCAL(type) static type
|
||||
/* a function referenced thru EXTERNs: */
|
||||
#define GLOBAL(type) type
|
||||
/* a reference to a GLOBAL function: */
|
||||
#define EXTERN(type) extern type
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* This macro is used to declare a "method", that is, a function pointer.
|
||||
* We want to supply prototype parameters if the compiler can cope.
|
||||
* Note that the arglist parameter must be parenthesized!
|
||||
* Again, you can customize this if you need special linkage keywords.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_PROTOTYPES
|
||||
#define JMETHOD(type,methodname,arglist) type (*methodname) arglist
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define JMETHOD(type,methodname,arglist) type (*methodname) ()
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Here is the pseudo-keyword for declaring pointers that must be "far"
|
||||
* on 80x86 machines. Most of the specialized coding for 80x86 is handled
|
||||
* by just saying "FAR *" where such a pointer is needed. In a few places
|
||||
* explicit coding is needed; see uses of the NEED_FAR_POINTERS symbol.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FAR
|
||||
#ifdef NEED_FAR_POINTERS
|
||||
#define FAR far
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FAR
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* On a few systems, type boolean and/or its values FALSE, TRUE may appear
|
||||
* in standard header files. Or you may have conflicts with application-
|
||||
* specific header files that you want to include together with these files.
|
||||
* Defining HAVE_BOOLEAN before including jpeglib.h should make it work.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef HAVE_BOOLEAN
|
||||
typedef int boolean;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef FALSE /* in case these macros already exist */
|
||||
#define FALSE 0 /* values of boolean */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef TRUE
|
||||
#define TRUE 1
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* The remaining options affect code selection within the JPEG library,
|
||||
* but they don't need to be visible to most applications using the library.
|
||||
* To minimize application namespace pollution, the symbols won't be
|
||||
* defined unless JPEG_INTERNALS or JPEG_INTERNAL_OPTIONS has been defined.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JPEG_INTERNALS
|
||||
#define JPEG_INTERNAL_OPTIONS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef JPEG_INTERNAL_OPTIONS
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* These defines indicate whether to include various optional functions.
|
||||
* Undefining some of these symbols will produce a smaller but less capable
|
||||
* library. Note that you can leave certain source files out of the
|
||||
* compilation/linking process if you've #undef'd the corresponding symbols.
|
||||
* (You may HAVE to do that if your compiler doesn't like null source files.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Capability options common to encoder and decoder: */
|
||||
|
||||
#define DCT_ISLOW_SUPPORTED /* slow but accurate integer algorithm */
|
||||
#define DCT_IFAST_SUPPORTED /* faster, less accurate integer method */
|
||||
#define DCT_FLOAT_SUPPORTED /* floating-point: accurate, fast on fast HW */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Encoder capability options: */
|
||||
|
||||
#define C_ARITH_CODING_SUPPORTED /* Arithmetic coding back end? */
|
||||
#define C_MULTISCAN_FILES_SUPPORTED /* Multiple-scan JPEG files? */
|
||||
#define C_PROGRESSIVE_SUPPORTED /* Progressive JPEG? (Requires MULTISCAN)*/
|
||||
#define DCT_SCALING_SUPPORTED /* Input rescaling via DCT? (Requires DCT_ISLOW)*/
|
||||
#define ENTROPY_OPT_SUPPORTED /* Optimization of entropy coding parms? */
|
||||
/* Note: if you selected 12-bit data precision, it is dangerous to turn off
|
||||
* ENTROPY_OPT_SUPPORTED. The standard Huffman tables are only good for 8-bit
|
||||
* precision, so jchuff.c normally uses entropy optimization to compute
|
||||
* usable tables for higher precision. If you don't want to do optimization,
|
||||
* you'll have to supply different default Huffman tables.
|
||||
* The exact same statements apply for progressive JPEG: the default tables
|
||||
* don't work for progressive mode. (This may get fixed, however.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define INPUT_SMOOTHING_SUPPORTED /* Input image smoothing option? */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Decoder capability options: */
|
||||
|
||||
#define D_ARITH_CODING_SUPPORTED /* Arithmetic coding back end? */
|
||||
#define D_MULTISCAN_FILES_SUPPORTED /* Multiple-scan JPEG files? */
|
||||
#define D_PROGRESSIVE_SUPPORTED /* Progressive JPEG? (Requires MULTISCAN)*/
|
||||
#define IDCT_SCALING_SUPPORTED /* Output rescaling via IDCT? */
|
||||
#define SAVE_MARKERS_SUPPORTED /* jpeg_save_markers() needed? */
|
||||
#define BLOCK_SMOOTHING_SUPPORTED /* Block smoothing? (Progressive only) */
|
||||
#undef UPSAMPLE_SCALING_SUPPORTED /* Output rescaling at upsample stage? */
|
||||
#define UPSAMPLE_MERGING_SUPPORTED /* Fast path for sloppy upsampling? */
|
||||
#define QUANT_1PASS_SUPPORTED /* 1-pass color quantization? */
|
||||
#define QUANT_2PASS_SUPPORTED /* 2-pass color quantization? */
|
||||
|
||||
/* more capability options later, no doubt */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Ordering of RGB data in scanlines passed to or from the application.
|
||||
* If your application wants to deal with data in the order B,G,R, just
|
||||
* change these macros. You can also deal with formats such as R,G,B,X
|
||||
* (one extra byte per pixel) by changing RGB_PIXELSIZE. Note that changing
|
||||
* the offsets will also change the order in which colormap data is organized.
|
||||
* RESTRICTIONS:
|
||||
* 1. The sample applications cjpeg,djpeg do NOT support modified RGB formats.
|
||||
* 2. The color quantizer modules will not behave desirably if RGB_PIXELSIZE
|
||||
* is not 3 (they don't understand about dummy color components!). So you
|
||||
* can't use color quantization if you change that value.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define RGB_RED 0 /* Offset of Red in an RGB scanline element */
|
||||
#define RGB_GREEN 1 /* Offset of Green */
|
||||
#define RGB_BLUE 2 /* Offset of Blue */
|
||||
#define RGB_PIXELSIZE 3 /* JSAMPLEs per RGB scanline element */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Definitions for speed-related optimizations. */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* If your compiler supports inline functions, define INLINE
|
||||
* as the inline keyword; otherwise define it as empty.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef INLINE
|
||||
#ifdef __GNUC__ /* for instance, GNU C knows about inline */
|
||||
#define INLINE __inline__
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef INLINE
|
||||
#define INLINE /* default is to define it as empty */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* On some machines (notably 68000 series) "int" is 32 bits, but multiplying
|
||||
* two 16-bit shorts is faster than multiplying two ints. Define MULTIPLIER
|
||||
* as short on such a machine. MULTIPLIER must be at least 16 bits wide.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef MULTIPLIER
|
||||
#define MULTIPLIER int /* type for fastest integer multiply */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* FAST_FLOAT should be either float or double, whichever is done faster
|
||||
* by your compiler. (Note that this type is only used in the floating point
|
||||
* DCT routines, so it only matters if you've defined DCT_FLOAT_SUPPORTED.)
|
||||
* Typically, float is faster in ANSI C compilers, while double is faster in
|
||||
* pre-ANSI compilers (because they insist on converting to double anyway).
|
||||
* The code below therefore chooses float if we have ANSI-style prototypes.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FAST_FLOAT
|
||||
#ifdef HAVE_PROTOTYPES
|
||||
#define FAST_FLOAT float
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define FAST_FLOAT double
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* JPEG_INTERNAL_OPTIONS */
|
1160
portlibs/include/jpeglib.h
Normal file
1160
portlibs/include/jpeglib.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
25
portlibs/include/ogg/config_types.h
Normal file
25
portlibs/include/ogg/config_types.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
|
||||
#ifndef __CONFIG_TYPES_H__
|
||||
#define __CONFIG_TYPES_H__
|
||||
|
||||
/* these are filled in by configure */
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_INTTYPES_H 1
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_STDINT_H 1
|
||||
#define INCLUDE_SYS_TYPES_H 1
|
||||
|
||||
#if INCLUDE_INTTYPES_H
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if INCLUDE_STDINT_H
|
||||
# include <stdint.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if INCLUDE_SYS_TYPES_H
|
||||
# include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
typedef int16_t ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef uint16_t ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int32_t ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef uint32_t ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef int64_t ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
210
portlibs/include/ogg/ogg.h
Normal file
210
portlibs/include/ogg/ogg.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,210 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THIS FILE IS PART OF THE OggVorbis SOFTWARE CODEC SOURCE CODE. *
|
||||
* USE, DISTRIBUTION AND REPRODUCTION OF THIS LIBRARY SOURCE IS *
|
||||
* GOVERNED BY A BSD-STYLE SOURCE LICENSE INCLUDED WITH THIS SOURCE *
|
||||
* IN 'COPYING'. PLEASE READ THESE TERMS BEFORE DISTRIBUTING. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THE OggVorbis SOURCE CODE IS (C) COPYRIGHT 1994-2007 *
|
||||
* by the Xiph.Org Foundation http://www.xiph.org/ *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
********************************************************************
|
||||
|
||||
function: toplevel libogg include
|
||||
last mod: $Id$
|
||||
|
||||
********************************************************************/
|
||||
#ifndef _OGG_H
|
||||
#define _OGG_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
#include <ogg/os_types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
void *iov_base;
|
||||
size_t iov_len;
|
||||
} ogg_iovec_t;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
long endbyte;
|
||||
int endbit;
|
||||
|
||||
unsigned char *buffer;
|
||||
unsigned char *ptr;
|
||||
long storage;
|
||||
} oggpack_buffer;
|
||||
|
||||
/* ogg_page is used to encapsulate the data in one Ogg bitstream page *****/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
unsigned char *header;
|
||||
long header_len;
|
||||
unsigned char *body;
|
||||
long body_len;
|
||||
} ogg_page;
|
||||
|
||||
/* ogg_stream_state contains the current encode/decode state of a logical
|
||||
Ogg bitstream **********************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
unsigned char *body_data; /* bytes from packet bodies */
|
||||
long body_storage; /* storage elements allocated */
|
||||
long body_fill; /* elements stored; fill mark */
|
||||
long body_returned; /* elements of fill returned */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
int *lacing_vals; /* The values that will go to the segment table */
|
||||
ogg_int64_t *granule_vals; /* granulepos values for headers. Not compact
|
||||
this way, but it is simple coupled to the
|
||||
lacing fifo */
|
||||
long lacing_storage;
|
||||
long lacing_fill;
|
||||
long lacing_packet;
|
||||
long lacing_returned;
|
||||
|
||||
unsigned char header[282]; /* working space for header encode */
|
||||
int header_fill;
|
||||
|
||||
int e_o_s; /* set when we have buffered the last packet in the
|
||||
logical bitstream */
|
||||
int b_o_s; /* set after we've written the initial page
|
||||
of a logical bitstream */
|
||||
long serialno;
|
||||
long pageno;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t packetno; /* sequence number for decode; the framing
|
||||
knows where there's a hole in the data,
|
||||
but we need coupling so that the codec
|
||||
(which is in a separate abstraction
|
||||
layer) also knows about the gap */
|
||||
ogg_int64_t granulepos;
|
||||
|
||||
} ogg_stream_state;
|
||||
|
||||
/* ogg_packet is used to encapsulate the data and metadata belonging
|
||||
to a single raw Ogg/Vorbis packet *************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
unsigned char *packet;
|
||||
long bytes;
|
||||
long b_o_s;
|
||||
long e_o_s;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_int64_t granulepos;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_int64_t packetno; /* sequence number for decode; the framing
|
||||
knows where there's a hole in the data,
|
||||
but we need coupling so that the codec
|
||||
(which is in a separate abstraction
|
||||
layer) also knows about the gap */
|
||||
} ogg_packet;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
unsigned char *data;
|
||||
int storage;
|
||||
int fill;
|
||||
int returned;
|
||||
|
||||
int unsynced;
|
||||
int headerbytes;
|
||||
int bodybytes;
|
||||
} ogg_sync_state;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Ogg BITSTREAM PRIMITIVES: bitstream ************************/
|
||||
|
||||
extern void oggpack_writeinit(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern int oggpack_writecheck(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_writetrunc(oggpack_buffer *b,long bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_writealign(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_writecopy(oggpack_buffer *b,void *source,long bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_reset(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_writeclear(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_readinit(oggpack_buffer *b,unsigned char *buf,int bytes);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_write(oggpack_buffer *b,unsigned long value,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_look(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_look1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_adv(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpack_adv1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_read(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_read1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_bytes(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpack_bits(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern unsigned char *oggpack_get_buffer(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_writeinit(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern int oggpackB_writecheck(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_writetrunc(oggpack_buffer *b,long bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_writealign(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_writecopy(oggpack_buffer *b,void *source,long bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_reset(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_writeclear(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_readinit(oggpack_buffer *b,unsigned char *buf,int bytes);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_write(oggpack_buffer *b,unsigned long value,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_look(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_look1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_adv(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern void oggpackB_adv1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_read(oggpack_buffer *b,int bits);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_read1(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_bytes(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern long oggpackB_bits(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
extern unsigned char *oggpackB_get_buffer(oggpack_buffer *b);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Ogg BITSTREAM PRIMITIVES: encoding **************************/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_packetin(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_iovecin(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_iovec_t *iov,
|
||||
int count, long e_o_s, ogg_int64_t granulepos);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_pageout(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_pageout_fill(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_page *og, int nfill);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_flush(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_flush_fill(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_page *og, int nfill);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Ogg BITSTREAM PRIMITIVES: decoding **************************/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_init(ogg_sync_state *oy);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_clear(ogg_sync_state *oy);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_reset(ogg_sync_state *oy);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_destroy(ogg_sync_state *oy);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_check(ogg_sync_state *oy);
|
||||
|
||||
extern char *ogg_sync_buffer(ogg_sync_state *oy, long size);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_wrote(ogg_sync_state *oy, long bytes);
|
||||
extern long ogg_sync_pageseek(ogg_sync_state *oy,ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_sync_pageout(ogg_sync_state *oy, ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_pagein(ogg_stream_state *os, ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_packetout(ogg_stream_state *os,ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_packetpeek(ogg_stream_state *os,ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Ogg BITSTREAM PRIMITIVES: general ***************************/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_init(ogg_stream_state *os,int serialno);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_clear(ogg_stream_state *os);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_reset(ogg_stream_state *os);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_reset_serialno(ogg_stream_state *os,int serialno);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_destroy(ogg_stream_state *os);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_check(ogg_stream_state *os);
|
||||
extern int ogg_stream_eos(ogg_stream_state *os);
|
||||
|
||||
extern void ogg_page_checksum_set(ogg_page *og);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_version(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_continued(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_bos(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_eos(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ogg_page_granulepos(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_serialno(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern long ogg_page_pageno(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
extern int ogg_page_packets(const ogg_page *og);
|
||||
|
||||
extern void ogg_packet_clear(ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _OGG_H */
|
148
portlibs/include/ogg/os_types.h
Normal file
148
portlibs/include/ogg/os_types.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THIS FILE IS PART OF THE OggVorbis SOFTWARE CODEC SOURCE CODE. *
|
||||
* USE, DISTRIBUTION AND REPRODUCTION OF THIS LIBRARY SOURCE IS *
|
||||
* GOVERNED BY A BSD-STYLE SOURCE LICENSE INCLUDED WITH THIS SOURCE *
|
||||
* IN 'COPYING'. PLEASE READ THESE TERMS BEFORE DISTRIBUTING. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THE OggVorbis SOURCE CODE IS (C) COPYRIGHT 1994-2002 *
|
||||
* by the Xiph.Org Foundation http://www.xiph.org/ *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
********************************************************************
|
||||
|
||||
function: #ifdef jail to whip a few platforms into the UNIX ideal.
|
||||
last mod: $Id$
|
||||
|
||||
********************************************************************/
|
||||
#ifndef _OS_TYPES_H
|
||||
#define _OS_TYPES_H
|
||||
|
||||
/* make it easy on the folks that want to compile the libs with a
|
||||
different malloc than stdlib */
|
||||
#define _ogg_malloc malloc
|
||||
#define _ogg_calloc calloc
|
||||
#define _ogg_realloc realloc
|
||||
#define _ogg_free free
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(_WIN32)
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(__CYGWIN__)
|
||||
# include <stdint.h>
|
||||
typedef int16_t ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef uint16_t ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int32_t ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef uint32_t ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef int64_t ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef uint64_t ogg_uint64_t;
|
||||
# elif defined(__MINGW32__)
|
||||
# include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned long long ogg_uint64_t;
|
||||
# elif defined(__MWERKS__)
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# if defined(_MSC_VER) && (_MSC_VER >= 1800) /* MSVC 2013 and newer */
|
||||
# include <stdint.h>
|
||||
typedef int16_t ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef uint16_t ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int32_t ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef uint32_t ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef int64_t ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef uint64_t ogg_uint64_t;
|
||||
# else
|
||||
/* MSVC/Borland */
|
||||
typedef __int64 ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef __int32 ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned __int32 ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef __int16 ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned __int16 ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
#elif (defined(__APPLE__) && defined(__MACH__)) /* MacOS X Framework build */
|
||||
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
typedef int16_t ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef uint16_t ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int32_t ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef uint32_t ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef int64_t ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(__HAIKU__)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Haiku */
|
||||
# include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(__BEOS__)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Be */
|
||||
# include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
typedef int16_t ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef uint16_t ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int32_t ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef uint32_t ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef int64_t ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined (__EMX__)
|
||||
|
||||
/* OS/2 GCC */
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined (DJGPP)
|
||||
|
||||
/* DJGPP */
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(R5900)
|
||||
|
||||
/* PS2 EE */
|
||||
typedef long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(__SYMBIAN32__)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Symbian GCC */
|
||||
typedef signed short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef signed int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long int ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#elif defined(__TMS320C6X__)
|
||||
|
||||
/* TI C64x compiler */
|
||||
typedef signed short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned short ogg_uint16_t;
|
||||
typedef signed int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef long long int ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#else
|
||||
|
||||
# include <ogg/config_types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _OS_TYPES_H */
|
2658
portlibs/include/png.h
Normal file
2658
portlibs/include/png.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
596
portlibs/include/pngconf.h
Normal file
596
portlibs/include/pngconf.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,596 @@
|
||||
|
||||
/* pngconf.h - machine configurable file for libpng
|
||||
*
|
||||
* libpng version 1.5.9 - February 18, 2012
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 1998-2012 Glenn Randers-Pehrson
|
||||
* (Version 0.96 Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 Andreas Dilger)
|
||||
* (Version 0.88 Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Guy Eric Schalnat, Group 42, Inc.)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This code is released under the libpng license.
|
||||
* For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer
|
||||
* and license in png.h
|
||||
*
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Any machine specific code is near the front of this file, so if you
|
||||
* are configuring libpng for a machine, you may want to read the section
|
||||
* starting here down to where it starts to typedef png_color, png_text,
|
||||
* and png_info.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNGCONF_H
|
||||
#define PNGCONF_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_BUILDING_SYMBOL_TABLE
|
||||
/* PNG_NO_LIMITS_H may be used to turn off the use of the standard C
|
||||
* definition file for machine specific limits, this may impact the
|
||||
* correctness of the definitons below (see uses of INT_MAX).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_NO_LIMITS_H
|
||||
# include <limits.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* For the memory copy APIs (i.e. the standard definitions of these),
|
||||
* because this file defines png_memcpy and so on the base APIs must
|
||||
* be defined here.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifdef BSD
|
||||
# include <strings.h>
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# include <string.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* For png_FILE_p - this provides the standard definition of a
|
||||
* FILE
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifdef PNG_STDIO_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# include <stdio.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* This controls optimization of the reading of 16 and 32 bit values
|
||||
* from PNG files. It can be set on a per-app-file basis - it
|
||||
* just changes whether a macro is used to the function is called.
|
||||
* The library builder sets the default, if read functions are not
|
||||
* built into the library the macro implementation is forced on.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_READ_INT_FUNCTIONS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# define PNG_USE_READ_MACROS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !defined(PNG_NO_USE_READ_MACROS) && !defined(PNG_USE_READ_MACROS)
|
||||
# if PNG_DEFAULT_READ_MACROS
|
||||
# define PNG_USE_READ_MACROS
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* COMPILER SPECIFIC OPTIONS.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* These options are provided so that a variety of difficult compilers
|
||||
* can be used. Some are fixed at build time (e.g. PNG_API_RULE
|
||||
* below) but still have compiler specific implementations, others
|
||||
* may be changed on a per-file basis when compiling against libpng.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* The PNGARG macro protects us against machines that don't have function
|
||||
* prototypes (ie K&R style headers). If your compiler does not handle
|
||||
* function prototypes, define this macro and use the included ansi2knr.
|
||||
* I've always been able to use _NO_PROTO as the indicator, but you may
|
||||
* need to drag the empty declaration out in front of here, or change the
|
||||
* ifdef to suit your own needs.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNGARG
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef OF /* zlib prototype munger */
|
||||
# define PNGARG(arglist) OF(arglist)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
|
||||
# ifdef _NO_PROTO
|
||||
# define PNGARG(arglist) ()
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PNGARG(arglist) arglist
|
||||
# endif /* _NO_PROTO */
|
||||
|
||||
# endif /* OF */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* PNGARG */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Function calling conventions.
|
||||
* =============================
|
||||
* Normally it is not necessary to specify to the compiler how to call
|
||||
* a function - it just does it - however on x86 systems derived from
|
||||
* Microsoft and Borland C compilers ('IBM PC', 'DOS', 'Windows' systems
|
||||
* and some others) there are multiple ways to call a function and the
|
||||
* default can be changed on the compiler command line. For this reason
|
||||
* libpng specifies the calling convention of every exported function and
|
||||
* every function called via a user supplied function pointer. This is
|
||||
* done in this file by defining the following macros:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNGAPI Calling convention for exported functions.
|
||||
* PNGCBAPI Calling convention for user provided (callback) functions.
|
||||
* PNGCAPI Calling convention used by the ANSI-C library (required
|
||||
* for longjmp callbacks and sometimes used internally to
|
||||
* specify the calling convention for zlib).
|
||||
*
|
||||
* These macros should never be overridden. If it is necessary to
|
||||
* change calling convention in a private build this can be done
|
||||
* by setting PNG_API_RULE (which defaults to 0) to one of the values
|
||||
* below to select the correct 'API' variants.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNG_API_RULE=0 Use PNGCAPI - the 'C' calling convention - throughout.
|
||||
* This is correct in every known environment.
|
||||
* PNG_API_RULE=1 Use the operating system convention for PNGAPI and
|
||||
* the 'C' calling convention (from PNGCAPI) for
|
||||
* callbacks (PNGCBAPI). This is no longer required
|
||||
* in any known environment - if it has to be used
|
||||
* please post an explanation of the problem to the
|
||||
* libpng mailing list.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* These cases only differ if the operating system does not use the C
|
||||
* calling convention, at present this just means the above cases
|
||||
* (x86 DOS/Windows sytems) and, even then, this does not apply to
|
||||
* Cygwin running on those systems.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Note that the value must be defined in pnglibconf.h so that what
|
||||
* the application uses to call the library matches the conventions
|
||||
* set when building the library.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Symbol export
|
||||
* =============
|
||||
* When building a shared library it is almost always necessary to tell
|
||||
* the compiler which symbols to export. The png.h macro 'PNG_EXPORT'
|
||||
* is used to mark the symbols. On some systems these symbols can be
|
||||
* extracted at link time and need no special processing by the compiler,
|
||||
* on other systems the symbols are flagged by the compiler and just
|
||||
* the declaration requires a special tag applied (unfortunately) in a
|
||||
* compiler dependent way. Some systems can do either.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* A small number of older systems also require a symbol from a DLL to
|
||||
* be flagged to the program that calls it. This is a problem because
|
||||
* we do not know in the header file included by application code that
|
||||
* the symbol will come from a shared library, as opposed to a statically
|
||||
* linked one. For this reason the application must tell us by setting
|
||||
* the magic flag PNG_USE_DLL to turn on the special processing before
|
||||
* it includes png.h.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Four additional macros are used to make this happen:
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNG_IMPEXP The magic (if any) to cause a symbol to be exported from
|
||||
* the build or imported if PNG_USE_DLL is set - compiler
|
||||
* and system specific.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNG_EXPORT_TYPE(type) A macro that pre or appends PNG_IMPEXP to
|
||||
* 'type', compiler specific.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNG_DLL_EXPORT Set to the magic to use during a libpng build to
|
||||
* make a symbol exported from the DLL. Not used in the
|
||||
* public header files; see pngpriv.h for how it is used
|
||||
* in the libpng build.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* PNG_DLL_IMPORT Set to the magic to force the libpng symbols to come
|
||||
* from a DLL - used to define PNG_IMPEXP when
|
||||
* PNG_USE_DLL is set.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* System specific discovery.
|
||||
* ==========================
|
||||
* This code is used at build time to find PNG_IMPEXP, the API settings
|
||||
* and PNG_EXPORT_TYPE(), it may also set a macro to indicate the DLL
|
||||
* import processing is possible. On Windows/x86 systems it also sets
|
||||
* compiler-specific macros to the values required to change the calling
|
||||
* conventions of the various functions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if ( defined(_Windows) || defined(_WINDOWS) || defined(WIN32) ||\
|
||||
defined(_WIN32) || defined(__WIN32__) || defined(__CYGWIN__) ) &&\
|
||||
( defined(_X86_) || defined(_X64_) || defined(_M_IX86) ||\
|
||||
defined(_M_X64) || defined(_M_IA64) )
|
||||
/* Windows system (DOS doesn't support DLLs) running on x86/x64. Includes
|
||||
* builds under Cygwin or MinGW. Also includes Watcom builds but these need
|
||||
* special treatment because they are not compatible with GCC or Visual C
|
||||
* because of different calling conventions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# if PNG_API_RULE == 2
|
||||
/* If this line results in an error, either because __watcall is not
|
||||
* understood or because of a redefine just below you cannot use *this*
|
||||
* build of the library with the compiler you are using. *This* build was
|
||||
* build using Watcom and applications must also be built using Watcom!
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# define PNGCAPI __watcall
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(__GNUC__) || (defined (_MSC_VER) && (_MSC_VER >= 800))
|
||||
# define PNGCAPI __cdecl
|
||||
# if PNG_API_RULE == 1
|
||||
# define PNGAPI __stdcall
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# else
|
||||
/* An older compiler, or one not detected (erroneously) above,
|
||||
* if necessary override on the command line to get the correct
|
||||
* variants for the compiler.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifndef PNGCAPI
|
||||
# define PNGCAPI _cdecl
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if PNG_API_RULE == 1 && !defined(PNGAPI)
|
||||
# define PNGAPI _stdcall
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif /* compiler/api */
|
||||
/* NOTE: PNGCBAPI always defaults to PNGCAPI. */
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(PNGAPI) && !defined(PNG_USER_PRIVATEBUILD)
|
||||
ERROR: PNG_USER_PRIVATEBUILD must be defined if PNGAPI is changed
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# if (defined(_MSC_VER) && _MSC_VER < 800) ||\
|
||||
(defined(__BORLANDC__) && __BORLANDC__ < 0x500)
|
||||
/* older Borland and MSC
|
||||
* compilers used '__export' and required this to be after
|
||||
* the type.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_EXPORT_TYPE
|
||||
# define PNG_EXPORT_TYPE(type) type PNG_IMPEXP
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define PNG_DLL_EXPORT __export
|
||||
# else /* newer compiler */
|
||||
# define PNG_DLL_EXPORT __declspec(dllexport)
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_DLL_IMPORT
|
||||
# define PNG_DLL_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif /* compiler */
|
||||
|
||||
#else /* !Windows/x86 */
|
||||
# if (defined(__IBMC__) || defined(__IBMCPP__)) && defined(__OS2__)
|
||||
# define PNGAPI _System
|
||||
# else /* !Windows/x86 && !OS/2 */
|
||||
/* Use the defaults, or define PNG*API on the command line (but
|
||||
* this will have to be done for every compile!)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# endif /* other system, !OS/2 */
|
||||
#endif /* !Windows/x86 */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Now do all the defaulting . */
|
||||
#ifndef PNGCAPI
|
||||
# define PNGCAPI
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNGCBAPI
|
||||
# define PNGCBAPI PNGCAPI
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNGAPI
|
||||
# define PNGAPI PNGCAPI
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* PNG_IMPEXP may be set on the compilation system command line or (if not set)
|
||||
* then in an internal header file when building the library, otherwise (when
|
||||
* using the library) it is set here.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_IMPEXP
|
||||
# if defined(PNG_USE_DLL) && defined(PNG_DLL_IMPORT)
|
||||
/* This forces use of a DLL, disallowing static linking */
|
||||
# define PNG_IMPEXP PNG_DLL_IMPORT
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_IMPEXP
|
||||
# define PNG_IMPEXP
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* In 1.5.2 the definition of PNG_FUNCTION has been changed to always treat
|
||||
* 'attributes' as a storage class - the attributes go at the start of the
|
||||
* function definition, and attributes are always appended regardless of the
|
||||
* compiler. This considerably simplifies these macros but may cause problems
|
||||
* if any compilers both need function attributes and fail to handle them as
|
||||
* a storage class (this is unlikely.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_FUNCTION
|
||||
# define PNG_FUNCTION(type, name, args, attributes) attributes type name args
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_EXPORT_TYPE
|
||||
# define PNG_EXPORT_TYPE(type) PNG_IMPEXP type
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The ordinal value is only relevant when preprocessing png.h for symbol
|
||||
* table entries, so we discard it here. See the .dfn files in the
|
||||
* scripts directory.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_EXPORTA
|
||||
|
||||
# define PNG_EXPORTA(ordinal, type, name, args, attributes)\
|
||||
PNG_FUNCTION(PNG_EXPORT_TYPE(type),(PNGAPI name),PNGARG(args), \
|
||||
extern attributes)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* ANSI-C (C90) does not permit a macro to be invoked with an empty argument,
|
||||
* so make something non-empty to satisfy the requirement:
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define PNG_EMPTY /*empty list*/
|
||||
|
||||
#define PNG_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)\
|
||||
PNG_EXPORTA(ordinal, type, name, args, PNG_EMPTY)
|
||||
|
||||
/* Use PNG_REMOVED to comment out a removed interface. */
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_REMOVED
|
||||
# define PNG_REMOVED(ordinal, type, name, args, attributes)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_CALLBACK
|
||||
# define PNG_CALLBACK(type, name, args) type (PNGCBAPI name) PNGARG(args)
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Support for compiler specific function attributes. These are used
|
||||
* so that where compiler support is available incorrect use of API
|
||||
* functions in png.h will generate compiler warnings.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* Added at libpng-1.2.41.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_NO_PEDANTIC_WARNINGS
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_PEDANTIC_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# define PNG_PEDANTIC_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef PNG_PEDANTIC_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
/* Support for compiler specific function attributes. These are used
|
||||
* so that where compiler support is available incorrect use of API
|
||||
* functions in png.h will generate compiler warnings. Added at libpng
|
||||
* version 1.2.41.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# if defined(__GNUC__)
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_USE_RESULT
|
||||
# define PNG_USE_RESULT __attribute__((__warn_unused_result__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_NORETURN
|
||||
# define PNG_NORETURN __attribute__((__noreturn__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_ALLOCATED
|
||||
# define PNG_ALLOCATED __attribute__((__malloc__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_DEPRECATED
|
||||
# define PNG_DEPRECATED __attribute__((__deprecated__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_PRIVATE
|
||||
# if 0 /* Doesn't work so we use deprecated instead*/
|
||||
# define PNG_PRIVATE \
|
||||
__attribute__((warning("This function is not exported by libpng.")))
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PNG_PRIVATE \
|
||||
__attribute__((__deprecated__))
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif /* __GNUC__ */
|
||||
|
||||
# if defined(_MSC_VER) && (_MSC_VER >= 1300)
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_USE_RESULT
|
||||
# define PNG_USE_RESULT /* not supported */
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_NORETURN
|
||||
# define PNG_NORETURN __declspec(noreturn)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_ALLOCATED
|
||||
# if (_MSC_VER >= 1400)
|
||||
# define PNG_ALLOCATED __declspec(restrict)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_DEPRECATED
|
||||
# define PNG_DEPRECATED __declspec(deprecated)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_PRIVATE
|
||||
# define PNG_PRIVATE __declspec(deprecated)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif /* _MSC_VER */
|
||||
#endif /* PNG_PEDANTIC_WARNINGS */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_DEPRECATED
|
||||
# define PNG_DEPRECATED /* Use of this function is deprecated */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_USE_RESULT
|
||||
# define PNG_USE_RESULT /* The result of this function must be checked */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_NORETURN
|
||||
# define PNG_NORETURN /* This function does not return */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_ALLOCATED
|
||||
# define PNG_ALLOCATED /* The result of the function is new memory */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_PRIVATE
|
||||
# define PNG_PRIVATE /* This is a private libpng function */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_FP_EXPORT /* A floating point API. */
|
||||
# ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# define PNG_FP_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)\
|
||||
PNG_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)
|
||||
# else /* No floating point APIs */
|
||||
# define PNG_FP_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_FIXED_EXPORT /* A fixed point API. */
|
||||
# ifdef PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
# define PNG_FIXED_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)\
|
||||
PNG_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)
|
||||
# else /* No fixed point APIs */
|
||||
# define PNG_FIXED_EXPORT(ordinal, type, name, args)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following uses const char * instead of char * for error
|
||||
* and warning message functions, so some compilers won't complain.
|
||||
* If you do not want to use const, define PNG_NO_CONST here.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* This should not change how the APIs are called, so it can be done
|
||||
* on a per-file basis in the application.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef PNG_CONST
|
||||
# ifndef PNG_NO_CONST
|
||||
# define PNG_CONST const
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define PNG_CONST
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Some typedefs to get us started. These should be safe on most of the
|
||||
* common platforms. The typedefs should be at least as large as the
|
||||
* numbers suggest (a png_uint_32 must be at least 32 bits long), but they
|
||||
* don't have to be exactly that size. Some compilers dislike passing
|
||||
* unsigned shorts as function parameters, so you may be better off using
|
||||
* unsigned int for png_uint_16.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(INT_MAX) && (INT_MAX > 0x7ffffffeL)
|
||||
typedef unsigned int png_uint_32;
|
||||
typedef int png_int_32;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef unsigned long png_uint_32;
|
||||
typedef long png_int_32;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
typedef unsigned short png_uint_16;
|
||||
typedef short png_int_16;
|
||||
typedef unsigned char png_byte;
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef PNG_NO_SIZE_T
|
||||
typedef unsigned int png_size_t;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef size_t png_size_t;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#define png_sizeof(x) (sizeof (x))
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following is needed for medium model support. It cannot be in the
|
||||
* pngpriv.h header. Needs modification for other compilers besides
|
||||
* MSC. Model independent support declares all arrays and pointers to be
|
||||
* large using the far keyword. The zlib version used must also support
|
||||
* model independent data. As of version zlib 1.0.4, the necessary changes
|
||||
* have been made in zlib. The USE_FAR_KEYWORD define triggers other
|
||||
* changes that are needed. (Tim Wegner)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Separate compiler dependencies (problem here is that zlib.h always
|
||||
* defines FAR. (SJT)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
|
||||
# if defined(__LARGE__) || defined(__HUGE__) || defined(__COMPACT__)
|
||||
# define LDATA 1
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define LDATA 0
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
/* GRR: why is Cygwin in here? Cygwin is not Borland C... */
|
||||
# if !defined(__WIN32__) && !defined(__FLAT__) && !defined(__CYGWIN__)
|
||||
# define PNG_MAX_MALLOC_64K /* only used in build */
|
||||
# if (LDATA != 1)
|
||||
# ifndef FAR
|
||||
# define FAR __far
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# define USE_FAR_KEYWORD
|
||||
# endif /* LDATA != 1 */
|
||||
/* Possibly useful for moving data out of default segment.
|
||||
* Uncomment it if you want. Could also define FARDATA as
|
||||
* const if your compiler supports it. (SJT)
|
||||
# define FARDATA FAR
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# endif /* __WIN32__, __FLAT__, __CYGWIN__ */
|
||||
#endif /* __BORLANDC__ */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Suggest testing for specific compiler first before testing for
|
||||
* FAR. The Watcom compiler defines both __MEDIUM__ and M_I86MM,
|
||||
* making reliance oncertain keywords suspect. (SJT)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* MSC Medium model */
|
||||
#ifdef FAR
|
||||
# ifdef M_I86MM
|
||||
# define USE_FAR_KEYWORD
|
||||
# define FARDATA FAR
|
||||
# include <dos.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* SJT: default case */
|
||||
#ifndef FAR
|
||||
# define FAR
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* At this point FAR is always defined */
|
||||
#ifndef FARDATA
|
||||
# define FARDATA
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Typedef for floating-point numbers that are converted
|
||||
* to fixed-point with a multiple of 100,000, e.g., gamma
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef png_int_32 png_fixed_point;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Add typedefs for pointers */
|
||||
typedef void FAR * png_voidp;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST void FAR * png_const_voidp;
|
||||
typedef png_byte FAR * png_bytep;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_byte FAR * png_const_bytep;
|
||||
typedef png_uint_32 FAR * png_uint_32p;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_uint_32 FAR * png_const_uint_32p;
|
||||
typedef png_int_32 FAR * png_int_32p;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_int_32 FAR * png_const_int_32p;
|
||||
typedef png_uint_16 FAR * png_uint_16p;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_uint_16 FAR * png_const_uint_16p;
|
||||
typedef png_int_16 FAR * png_int_16p;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_int_16 FAR * png_const_int_16p;
|
||||
typedef char FAR * png_charp;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST char FAR * png_const_charp;
|
||||
typedef png_fixed_point FAR * png_fixed_point_p;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_fixed_point FAR * png_const_fixed_point_p;
|
||||
typedef png_size_t FAR * png_size_tp;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST png_size_t FAR * png_const_size_tp;
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef PNG_STDIO_SUPPORTED
|
||||
typedef FILE * png_FILE_p;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
typedef double FAR * png_doublep;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST double FAR * png_const_doublep;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Pointers to pointers; i.e. arrays */
|
||||
typedef png_byte FAR * FAR * png_bytepp;
|
||||
typedef png_uint_32 FAR * FAR * png_uint_32pp;
|
||||
typedef png_int_32 FAR * FAR * png_int_32pp;
|
||||
typedef png_uint_16 FAR * FAR * png_uint_16pp;
|
||||
typedef png_int_16 FAR * FAR * png_int_16pp;
|
||||
typedef PNG_CONST char FAR * FAR * png_const_charpp;
|
||||
typedef char FAR * FAR * png_charpp;
|
||||
typedef png_fixed_point FAR * FAR * png_fixed_point_pp;
|
||||
#ifdef PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
typedef double FAR * FAR * png_doublepp;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Pointers to pointers to pointers; i.e., pointer to array */
|
||||
typedef char FAR * FAR * FAR * png_charppp;
|
||||
|
||||
/* png_alloc_size_t is guaranteed to be no smaller than png_size_t,
|
||||
* and no smaller than png_uint_32. Casts from png_size_t or png_uint_32
|
||||
* to png_alloc_size_t are not necessary; in fact, it is recommended
|
||||
* not to use them at all so that the compiler can complain when something
|
||||
* turns out to be problematic.
|
||||
* Casts in the other direction (from png_alloc_size_t to png_size_t or
|
||||
* png_uint_32) should be explicitly applied; however, we do not expect
|
||||
* to encounter practical situations that require such conversions.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if defined(__TURBOC__) && !defined(__FLAT__)
|
||||
typedef unsigned long png_alloc_size_t;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# if defined(_MSC_VER) && defined(MAXSEG_64K)
|
||||
typedef unsigned long png_alloc_size_t;
|
||||
# else
|
||||
/* This is an attempt to detect an old Windows system where (int) is
|
||||
* actually 16 bits, in that case png_malloc must have an argument with a
|
||||
* bigger size to accomodate the requirements of the library.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# if (defined(_Windows) || defined(_WINDOWS) || defined(_WINDOWS_)) && \
|
||||
(!defined(INT_MAX) || INT_MAX <= 0x7ffffffeL)
|
||||
typedef DWORD png_alloc_size_t;
|
||||
# else
|
||||
typedef png_size_t png_alloc_size_t;
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* PNGCONF_H */
|
180
portlibs/include/pnglibconf.h
Normal file
180
portlibs/include/pnglibconf.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,180 @@
|
||||
/* pnglibconf.h - library build configuration */
|
||||
|
||||
/* libpng version 1.5.9 - February 18, 2012 */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Copyright (c) 1998-2011 Glenn Randers-Pehrson */
|
||||
|
||||
/* This code is released under the libpng license. */
|
||||
/* For conditions of distribution and use, see the disclaimer */
|
||||
/* and license in png.h */
|
||||
|
||||
/* pnglibconf.h */
|
||||
/* Machine generated file: DO NOT EDIT */
|
||||
/* Derived from: scripts/pnglibconf.dfa */
|
||||
#ifndef PNGLCONF_H
|
||||
#define PNGLCONF_H
|
||||
/* settings */
|
||||
#define PNG_MAX_GAMMA_8 11
|
||||
#define PNG_CALLOC_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_QUANTIZE_RED_BITS 5
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_WIDTH_MAX 1000000
|
||||
#define PNG_QUANTIZE_GREEN_BITS 5
|
||||
#define PNG_API_RULE 0
|
||||
#define PNG_QUANTIZE_BLUE_BITS 5
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_CHUNK_CACHE_MAX 0
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_HEIGHT_MAX 1000000
|
||||
#define PNG_sCAL_PRECISION 5
|
||||
#define PNG_COST_SHIFT 3
|
||||
#define PNG_WEIGHT_SHIFT 8
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_CHUNK_MALLOC_MAX 0
|
||||
#define PNG_DEFAULT_READ_MACROS 1
|
||||
#define PNG_ZBUF_SIZE 8192
|
||||
#define PNG_GAMMA_THRESHOLD_FIXED 5000
|
||||
/* end of settings */
|
||||
/* options */
|
||||
#define PNG_INFO_IMAGE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_HANDLE_AS_UNKNOWN_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_POINTER_INDEXING_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WARNINGS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_FLOATING_ARITHMETIC_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_16BIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_EASY_ACCESS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_ALIGN_MEMORY_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_WEIGHTED_FILTER_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_BUILD_GRAYSCALE_PALETTE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_LIMITS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
/*#undef PNG_ERROR_NUMBERS_SUPPORTED*/
|
||||
#define PNG_ERROR_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_BENIGN_ERRORS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SETJMP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_TIME_RFC1123_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_FLUSH_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_MNG_FEATURES_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_FLOATING_POINT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_OPTIMIZE_CMF_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_INCH_CONVERSIONS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_STDIO_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_MEM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_IO_STATE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SET_USER_LIMITS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_INT_FUNCTIONS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_ANCILLARY_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_FILTER_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_zTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SET_CHUNK_CACHE_LIMIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_iCCP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_bKGD_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_UNKNOWN_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_sCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_hIST_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_OPT_PLTE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SET_CHUNK_MALLOC_LIMIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_gAMA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_GRAY_TO_RGB_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_pCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_INVERT_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_TRANSFORMS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_ALPHA_MODE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_sBIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_CUSTOMIZE_ZTXT_COMPRESSION_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_PACK_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_iTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_SWAP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_cHRM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_STRIP_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_tIME_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_INTERLACING_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_tRNS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_pHYs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_INVERT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_RGB_TO_GRAY_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_sRGB_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_oFFs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_FILLER_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_SHIFT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_PROGRESSIVE_READ_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_SHIFT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_CONVERT_tIME_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_USER_TRANSFORM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_INT_FUNCTIONS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_USER_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_hIST_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_16BIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_SWAP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_COMPOSITE_NODIV_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SEQUENTIAL_READ_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_BACKGROUND_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_QUANTIZE_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_zTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_iCCP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_STRIP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_PACKSWAP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_sRGB_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_pCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_sPLT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_iTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_SWAP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_tIME_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_pHYs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_SWAP_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_SCALE_16_TO_8_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_BGR_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_CHUNKS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_CONSOLE_IO_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_COMPRESSED_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_PACK_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_FILLER_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_bKGD_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_tRNS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_sPLT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_sCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_oFFs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_sBIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_INVERT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_cHRM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_16BIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_USER_TRANSFORM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_BGR_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_PACKSWAP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_INVERT_ALPHA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_sCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_GAMMA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_TRANSFORM_INFO_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_sBIT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_cHRM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_bKGD_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_tRNS_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_oFFs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_EXPAND_16_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_USER_TRANSFORM_PTR_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_COMPRESSED_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_hIST_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_zTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_iCCP_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_sRGB_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_pCAL_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_WRITE_tEXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_CHECK_cHRM_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_gAMA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_iTXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_tIME_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_EXPAND_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_pHYs_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_SAVE_INT_32_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_sPLT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_READ_tEXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_gAMA_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_TEXT_SUPPORTED
|
||||
#define PNG_tEXt_SUPPORTED
|
||||
/* end of options */
|
||||
#endif /* PNGLCONF_H */
|
203
portlibs/include/sys/socket.h
Normal file
203
portlibs/include/sys/socket.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,203 @@
|
||||
/* sys/socket.h
|
||||
|
||||
netport
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _SYS_SOCKET_H
|
||||
#define _SYS_SOCKET_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#include <inttypes.h>
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
#include <gctypes.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C"
|
||||
{
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef socklen_t
|
||||
typedef uint8_t socklen_t;
|
||||
#define socklen_t socklen_t
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
typedef uint8_t sa_family_t;
|
||||
|
||||
struct sockaddr {
|
||||
u8 sa_len;
|
||||
sa_family_t sa_family; /* address family, AF_xxx */
|
||||
char sa_data[14]; /* 14 bytes of protocol address */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* Definition of sockaddr_storage according to SUSv3. */
|
||||
#define _SS_MAXSIZE 128 /* Maximum size. */
|
||||
#define _SS_ALIGNSIZE (sizeof (int64_t))/* Desired alignment. */
|
||||
#define _SS_PAD1SIZE (_SS_ALIGNSIZE - sizeof (sa_family_t))
|
||||
#define _SS_PAD2SIZE (_SS_MAXSIZE - (sizeof (sa_family_t) \
|
||||
+ _SS_PAD1SIZE + _SS_ALIGNSIZE))
|
||||
|
||||
struct sockaddr_storage {
|
||||
sa_family_t ss_family;
|
||||
char _ss_pad1[_SS_PAD1SIZE];
|
||||
int64_t __ss_align;
|
||||
char _ss_pad2[_SS_PAD2SIZE];
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#include <sys/uio.h>
|
||||
|
||||
struct msghdr
|
||||
{
|
||||
void * msg_name; /* Socket name */
|
||||
socklen_t msg_namelen; /* Length of name */
|
||||
struct iovec * msg_iov; /* Data blocks */
|
||||
int msg_iovlen; /* Number of blocks */
|
||||
void * msg_control; /* Ancillary data */
|
||||
socklen_t msg_controllen; /* Ancillary data buffer length */
|
||||
int msg_flags; /* Received flags on recvmsg */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
struct cmsghdr
|
||||
{
|
||||
socklen_t cmsg_len; /* Length of cmsghdr + data */
|
||||
int cmsg_level; /* Protocol */
|
||||
int cmsg_type; /* Protocol type */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
#define CMSG_ALIGN(len) \
|
||||
(((len) + sizeof (size_t) - 1) & ~(sizeof (size_t) - 1))
|
||||
#define CMSG_LEN(len) \
|
||||
(CMSG_ALIGN (sizeof (struct cmsghdr)) + (len))
|
||||
#define CMSG_SPACE(len) \
|
||||
(CMSG_ALIGN (sizeof (struct cmsghdr)) + CMSG_ALIGN(len))
|
||||
#define CMSG_FIRSTHDR(mhdr) \
|
||||
({ \
|
||||
struct msghdr *_m = (struct msghdr *) mhdr; \
|
||||
(unsigned) (_m)->msg_controllen >= sizeof (struct cmsghdr) \
|
||||
? (struct cmsghdr *) (_m)->msg_control \
|
||||
: (struct cmsghdr *) NULL; \
|
||||
})
|
||||
#define CMSG_NXTHDR(mhdr,cmsg) \
|
||||
({ \
|
||||
struct msghdr *_m = (struct msghdr *) mhdr; \
|
||||
struct cmsghdr *_c = (struct cmsghdr *) cmsg; \
|
||||
((char *) _c + CMSG_SPACE (_c->cmsg_len) \
|
||||
> (char *) _m->msg_control + _m->msg_controllen) \
|
||||
? (struct cmsghdr *) NULL \
|
||||
: (struct cmsghdr *) ((char *) _c + CMSG_ALIGN (_c->cmsg_len)); \
|
||||
})
|
||||
#define CMSG_DATA(cmsg) \
|
||||
((unsigned char *) ((struct cmsghdr *)(cmsg) + 1))
|
||||
|
||||
/* "Socket"-level control message types: */
|
||||
#define SCM_RIGHTS 0x01 /* access rights (array of int) */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Structure used for manipulating linger option.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
struct linger {
|
||||
int l_onoff; /* option on/off */
|
||||
int l_linger; /* linger time */
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define SOCK_STREAM 1
|
||||
#define SOCK_DGRAM 2
|
||||
#define SOCK_RAW 3
|
||||
#if(0)
|
||||
#define SOCK_SEQPACKET 5
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define SOL_SOCKET 0xffff /* options for socket level */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Option flags per-socket.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define SO_DEBUG 0x0001 /* turn on debugging info recording */
|
||||
#define SO_ACCEPTCONN 0x0002 /* socket has had listen() */
|
||||
#define SO_REUSEADDR 0x0004 /* allow local address reuse */
|
||||
#define SO_KEEPALIVE 0x0008 /* keep connections alive */
|
||||
#define SO_DONTROUTE 0x0010 /* just use interface addresses */
|
||||
#define SO_BROADCAST 0x0020 /* permit sending of broadcast msgs */
|
||||
#define SO_USELOOPBACK 0x0040 /* bypass hardware when possible */
|
||||
#define SO_LINGER 0x0080 /* linger on close if data present */
|
||||
#define SO_OOBINLINE 0x0100 /* leave received OOB data in line */
|
||||
#define SO_REUSEPORT 0x0200 /* allow local address & port reuse */
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Additional options, not kept in so_options.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define SO_SNDBUF 0x1001 /* send buffer size */
|
||||
#define SO_RCVBUF 0x1002 /* receive buffer size */
|
||||
#define SO_SNDLOWAT 0x1003 /* send low-water mark */
|
||||
#define SO_RCVLOWAT 0x1004 /* receive low-water mark */
|
||||
#define SO_SNDTIMEO 0x1005 /* send timeout */
|
||||
#define SO_RCVTIMEO 0x1006 /* receive timeout */
|
||||
#define SO_ERROR 0x1007 /* get error status and clear */
|
||||
#define SO_TYPE 0x1008 /* get socket type */
|
||||
|
||||
#if(0)
|
||||
#define SOMAXCONN 0x7fffffff
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Flags we can use with send/ and recv. */
|
||||
// Flags that are made up
|
||||
#define MSG_OOB 0x1 /* process out-of-band data */
|
||||
#define MSG_PEEK 0x2 /* peek at incoming message */
|
||||
#define MSG_DONTROUTE 0x4 /* send without using routing tables */
|
||||
#define MSG_WINMASK 0x7 /* flags understood by WinSock calls */
|
||||
#define MSG_NOSIGNAL 0x20 /* Don't raise SIGPIPE */
|
||||
#define MSG_TRUNC 0x0100 /* Normal data truncated */
|
||||
#define MSG_CTRUNC 0x0200 /* Control data truncated */
|
||||
|
||||
// Flag not made up
|
||||
#define MSG_DONTWAIT 0x40 /* Nonblocking i/o for this operation only */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* Supported address families. */
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Address families.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define AF_UNSPEC 0
|
||||
#define AF_INET 2
|
||||
#if(0)
|
||||
#define AF_UNIX 1 /* local to host (pipes, portals) */
|
||||
#define AF_INET6 23 /* IP version 6 */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#if(0)
|
||||
/* SUS symbolic values for the second parm to shutdown(2) */
|
||||
#define SHUT_RD 0
|
||||
#define SHUT_WR 1
|
||||
#define SHUT_RDWR 2
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
int accept(int, struct sockaddr *__restrict__, socklen_t *__restrict__);
|
||||
int bind(int, const struct sockaddr *, socklen_t);
|
||||
int connect(int, const struct sockaddr *, socklen_t);
|
||||
int getpeername(int, struct sockaddr *__restrict__, socklen_t *__restrict__);
|
||||
int getsockname(int, struct sockaddr *__restrict__, socklen_t *__restrict__);
|
||||
int getsockopt(int, int, int, void *__restrict__, socklen_t *__restrict__);
|
||||
int listen(int, int);
|
||||
ssize_t recv(int, void *, size_t, int);
|
||||
ssize_t recvfrom(int, void *__restrict__, size_t, int,
|
||||
struct sockaddr *__restrict__, socklen_t *__restrict__);
|
||||
ssize_t recvmsg(int, struct msghdr *, int);
|
||||
ssize_t send(int, const void *, size_t, int);
|
||||
ssize_t sendmsg(int, const struct msghdr *, int);
|
||||
ssize_t sendto(int, const void *, size_t, int, const struct sockaddr *,
|
||||
socklen_t);
|
||||
int setsockopt(int, int, int, const void *, socklen_t);
|
||||
int close(int);
|
||||
int shutdown(int, int);
|
||||
int socket(int, int, int);
|
||||
int sockatmark(int);
|
||||
int socketpair(int, int, int, int[2]);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
};
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _SYS_SOCKET_H */
|
27
portlibs/include/sys/uio.h
Normal file
27
portlibs/include/sys/uio.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
|
||||
/* sys/uio.h
|
||||
|
||||
netport
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _UIO_H_
|
||||
#define _UIO_H_
|
||||
|
||||
/* For size_t */
|
||||
#include <stddef.h>
|
||||
/* For ssize_t */
|
||||
#include <sys/types.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Define the uio buffers used for writev, readv.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
struct iovec
|
||||
{
|
||||
void *iov_base;
|
||||
size_t iov_len;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
extern ssize_t readv (int filedes, const struct iovec *vector, int count);
|
||||
extern ssize_t writev(int filedes, const struct iovec *vector, int count);
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _UIO_H_ */
|
25
portlibs/include/tremor/config_types.h
Normal file
25
portlibs/include/tremor/config_types.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THIS FILE IS PART OF THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' CODEC SOURCE CODE. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* USE, DISTRIBUTION AND REPRODUCTION OF THIS LIBRARY SOURCE IS *
|
||||
* GOVERNED BY A BSD-STYLE SOURCE LICENSE INCLUDED WITH THIS SOURCE *
|
||||
* IN 'COPYING'. PLEASE READ THESE TERMS BEFORE DISTRIBUTING. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' SOURCE CODE IS (C) COPYRIGHT 1994-2002 *
|
||||
* BY THE Xiph.Org FOUNDATION http://www.xiph.org/ *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
********************************************************************
|
||||
|
||||
function: #ifdef jail to whip a few platforms into the UNIX ideal.
|
||||
|
||||
********************************************************************/
|
||||
#ifndef _OS_CVTYPES_H
|
||||
#define _OS_CVTYPES_H
|
||||
|
||||
typedef long long ogg_int64_t;
|
||||
typedef int ogg_int32_t;
|
||||
typedef unsigned int ogg_uint32_t;
|
||||
typedef short ogg_int16_t;
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
204
portlibs/include/tremor/ivorbiscodec.h
Normal file
204
portlibs/include/tremor/ivorbiscodec.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,204 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THIS FILE IS PART OF THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' CODEC SOURCE CODE. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* USE, DISTRIBUTION AND REPRODUCTION OF THIS LIBRARY SOURCE IS *
|
||||
* GOVERNED BY A BSD-STYLE SOURCE LICENSE INCLUDED WITH THIS SOURCE *
|
||||
* IN 'COPYING'. PLEASE READ THESE TERMS BEFORE DISTRIBUTING. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' SOURCE CODE IS (C) COPYRIGHT 1994-2002 *
|
||||
* BY THE Xiph.Org FOUNDATION http://www.xiph.org/ *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
********************************************************************
|
||||
|
||||
function: libvorbis codec headers
|
||||
|
||||
********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _vorbis_codec_h_
|
||||
#define _vorbis_codec_h_
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C"
|
||||
{
|
||||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||||
|
||||
#include <ogg/ogg.h>
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct vorbis_info{
|
||||
int version;
|
||||
int channels;
|
||||
long rate;
|
||||
|
||||
/* The below bitrate declarations are *hints*.
|
||||
Combinations of the three values carry the following implications:
|
||||
|
||||
all three set to the same value:
|
||||
implies a fixed rate bitstream
|
||||
only nominal set:
|
||||
implies a VBR stream that averages the nominal bitrate. No hard
|
||||
upper/lower limit
|
||||
upper and or lower set:
|
||||
implies a VBR bitstream that obeys the bitrate limits. nominal
|
||||
may also be set to give a nominal rate.
|
||||
none set:
|
||||
the coder does not care to speculate.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
long bitrate_upper;
|
||||
long bitrate_nominal;
|
||||
long bitrate_lower;
|
||||
long bitrate_window;
|
||||
|
||||
void *codec_setup;
|
||||
} vorbis_info;
|
||||
|
||||
/* vorbis_dsp_state buffers the current vorbis audio
|
||||
analysis/synthesis state. The DSP state belongs to a specific
|
||||
logical bitstream ****************************************************/
|
||||
typedef struct vorbis_dsp_state{
|
||||
int analysisp;
|
||||
vorbis_info *vi;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_int32_t **pcm;
|
||||
ogg_int32_t **pcmret;
|
||||
int pcm_storage;
|
||||
int pcm_current;
|
||||
int pcm_returned;
|
||||
|
||||
int preextrapolate;
|
||||
int eofflag;
|
||||
|
||||
long lW;
|
||||
long W;
|
||||
long nW;
|
||||
long centerW;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_int64_t granulepos;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t sequence;
|
||||
|
||||
void *backend_state;
|
||||
} vorbis_dsp_state;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct vorbis_block{
|
||||
/* necessary stream state for linking to the framing abstraction */
|
||||
ogg_int32_t **pcm; /* this is a pointer into local storage */
|
||||
oggpack_buffer opb;
|
||||
|
||||
long lW;
|
||||
long W;
|
||||
long nW;
|
||||
int pcmend;
|
||||
int mode;
|
||||
|
||||
int eofflag;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t granulepos;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t sequence;
|
||||
vorbis_dsp_state *vd; /* For read-only access of configuration */
|
||||
|
||||
/* local storage to avoid remallocing; it's up to the mapping to
|
||||
structure it */
|
||||
void *localstore;
|
||||
long localtop;
|
||||
long localalloc;
|
||||
long totaluse;
|
||||
struct alloc_chain *reap;
|
||||
|
||||
} vorbis_block;
|
||||
|
||||
/* vorbis_block is a single block of data to be processed as part of
|
||||
the analysis/synthesis stream; it belongs to a specific logical
|
||||
bitstream, but is independant from other vorbis_blocks belonging to
|
||||
that logical bitstream. *************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
struct alloc_chain{
|
||||
void *ptr;
|
||||
struct alloc_chain *next;
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
/* vorbis_info contains all the setup information specific to the
|
||||
specific compression/decompression mode in progress (eg,
|
||||
psychoacoustic settings, channel setup, options, codebook
|
||||
etc). vorbis_info and substructures are in backends.h.
|
||||
*********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/* the comments are not part of vorbis_info so that vorbis_info can be
|
||||
static storage */
|
||||
typedef struct vorbis_comment{
|
||||
/* unlimited user comment fields. libvorbis writes 'libvorbis'
|
||||
whatever vendor is set to in encode */
|
||||
char **user_comments;
|
||||
int *comment_lengths;
|
||||
int comments;
|
||||
char *vendor;
|
||||
|
||||
} vorbis_comment;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* libvorbis encodes in two abstraction layers; first we perform DSP
|
||||
and produce a packet (see docs/analysis.txt). The packet is then
|
||||
coded into a framed OggSquish bitstream by the second layer (see
|
||||
docs/framing.txt). Decode is the reverse process; we sync/frame
|
||||
the bitstream and extract individual packets, then decode the
|
||||
packet back into PCM audio.
|
||||
|
||||
The extra framing/packetizing is used in streaming formats, such as
|
||||
files. Over the net (such as with UDP), the framing and
|
||||
packetization aren't necessary as they're provided by the transport
|
||||
and the streaming layer is not used */
|
||||
|
||||
/* Vorbis PRIMITIVES: general ***************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
extern void vorbis_info_init(vorbis_info *vi);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_info_clear(vorbis_info *vi);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_info_blocksize(vorbis_info *vi,int zo);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_comment_init(vorbis_comment *vc);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_comment_add(vorbis_comment *vc, char *comment);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_comment_add_tag(vorbis_comment *vc,
|
||||
char *tag, char *contents);
|
||||
extern char *vorbis_comment_query(vorbis_comment *vc, char *tag, int count);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_comment_query_count(vorbis_comment *vc, char *tag);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_comment_clear(vorbis_comment *vc);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int vorbis_block_init(vorbis_dsp_state *v, vorbis_block *vb);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_block_clear(vorbis_block *vb);
|
||||
extern void vorbis_dsp_clear(vorbis_dsp_state *v);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Vorbis PRIMITIVES: synthesis layer *******************************/
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_idheader(ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_headerin(vorbis_info *vi,vorbis_comment *vc,
|
||||
ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_init(vorbis_dsp_state *v,vorbis_info *vi);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_restart(vorbis_dsp_state *v);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis(vorbis_block *vb,ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_trackonly(vorbis_block *vb,ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_blockin(vorbis_dsp_state *v,vorbis_block *vb);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_pcmout(vorbis_dsp_state *v,ogg_int32_t ***pcm);
|
||||
extern int vorbis_synthesis_read(vorbis_dsp_state *v,int samples);
|
||||
extern long vorbis_packet_blocksize(vorbis_info *vi,ogg_packet *op);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Vorbis ERRORS and return codes ***********************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#define OV_FALSE -1
|
||||
#define OV_EOF -2
|
||||
#define OV_HOLE -3
|
||||
|
||||
#define OV_EREAD -128
|
||||
#define OV_EFAULT -129
|
||||
#define OV_EIMPL -130
|
||||
#define OV_EINVAL -131
|
||||
#define OV_ENOTVORBIS -132
|
||||
#define OV_EBADHEADER -133
|
||||
#define OV_EVERSION -134
|
||||
#define OV_ENOTAUDIO -135
|
||||
#define OV_EBADPACKET -136
|
||||
#define OV_EBADLINK -137
|
||||
#define OV_ENOSEEK -138
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
131
portlibs/include/tremor/ivorbisfile.h
Normal file
131
portlibs/include/tremor/ivorbisfile.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,131 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THIS FILE IS PART OF THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' CODEC SOURCE CODE. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* USE, DISTRIBUTION AND REPRODUCTION OF THIS LIBRARY SOURCE IS *
|
||||
* GOVERNED BY A BSD-STYLE SOURCE LICENSE INCLUDED WITH THIS SOURCE *
|
||||
* IN 'COPYING'. PLEASE READ THESE TERMS BEFORE DISTRIBUTING. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* THE OggVorbis 'TREMOR' SOURCE CODE IS (C) COPYRIGHT 1994-2002 *
|
||||
* BY THE Xiph.Org FOUNDATION http://www.xiph.org/ *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
********************************************************************
|
||||
|
||||
function: stdio-based convenience library for opening/seeking/decoding
|
||||
|
||||
********************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _OV_FILE_H_
|
||||
#define _OV_FILE_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C"
|
||||
{
|
||||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include "ivorbiscodec.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#define CHUNKSIZE 65535
|
||||
#define READSIZE 1024
|
||||
/* The function prototypes for the callbacks are basically the same as for
|
||||
* the stdio functions fread, fseek, fclose, ftell.
|
||||
* The one difference is that the FILE * arguments have been replaced with
|
||||
* a void * - this is to be used as a pointer to whatever internal data these
|
||||
* functions might need. In the stdio case, it's just a FILE * cast to a void *
|
||||
*
|
||||
* If you use other functions, check the docs for these functions and return
|
||||
* the right values. For seek_func(), you *MUST* return -1 if the stream is
|
||||
* unseekable
|
||||
*/
|
||||
typedef struct {
|
||||
size_t (*read_func) (void *ptr, size_t size, size_t nmemb, void *datasource);
|
||||
int (*seek_func) (void *datasource, ogg_int64_t offset, int whence);
|
||||
int (*close_func) (void *datasource);
|
||||
long (*tell_func) (void *datasource);
|
||||
} ov_callbacks;
|
||||
|
||||
#define NOTOPEN 0
|
||||
#define PARTOPEN 1
|
||||
#define OPENED 2
|
||||
#define STREAMSET 3
|
||||
#define INITSET 4
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct OggVorbis_File {
|
||||
void *datasource; /* Pointer to a FILE *, etc. */
|
||||
int seekable;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t offset;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t end;
|
||||
ogg_sync_state oy;
|
||||
|
||||
/* If the FILE handle isn't seekable (eg, a pipe), only the current
|
||||
stream appears */
|
||||
int links;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t *offsets;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t *dataoffsets;
|
||||
ogg_uint32_t *serialnos;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t *pcmlengths;
|
||||
vorbis_info *vi;
|
||||
vorbis_comment *vc;
|
||||
|
||||
/* Decoding working state local storage */
|
||||
ogg_int64_t pcm_offset;
|
||||
int ready_state;
|
||||
ogg_uint32_t current_serialno;
|
||||
int current_link;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_int64_t bittrack;
|
||||
ogg_int64_t samptrack;
|
||||
|
||||
ogg_stream_state os; /* take physical pages, weld into a logical
|
||||
stream of packets */
|
||||
vorbis_dsp_state vd; /* central working state for the packet->PCM decoder */
|
||||
vorbis_block vb; /* local working space for packet->PCM decode */
|
||||
|
||||
ov_callbacks callbacks;
|
||||
|
||||
} OggVorbis_File;
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ov_clear(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern int ov_open(FILE *f,OggVorbis_File *vf,const char *initial,long ibytes);
|
||||
extern int ov_open_callbacks(void *datasource, OggVorbis_File *vf,
|
||||
const char *initial, long ibytes, ov_callbacks callbacks);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ov_test(FILE *f,OggVorbis_File *vf,const char *initial,long ibytes);
|
||||
extern int ov_test_callbacks(void *datasource, OggVorbis_File *vf,
|
||||
const char *initial, long ibytes, ov_callbacks callbacks);
|
||||
extern int ov_test_open(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
|
||||
extern long ov_bitrate(OggVorbis_File *vf,int i);
|
||||
extern long ov_bitrate_instant(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern long ov_streams(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern long ov_seekable(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern long ov_serialnumber(OggVorbis_File *vf,int i);
|
||||
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_raw_total(OggVorbis_File *vf,int i);
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_pcm_total(OggVorbis_File *vf,int i);
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_time_total(OggVorbis_File *vf,int i);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ov_raw_seek(OggVorbis_File *vf,ogg_int64_t pos);
|
||||
extern int ov_pcm_seek(OggVorbis_File *vf,ogg_int64_t pos);
|
||||
extern int ov_pcm_seek_page(OggVorbis_File *vf,ogg_int64_t pos);
|
||||
extern int ov_time_seek(OggVorbis_File *vf,ogg_int64_t pos);
|
||||
extern int ov_time_seek_page(OggVorbis_File *vf,ogg_int64_t pos);
|
||||
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_raw_tell(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_pcm_tell(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
extern ogg_int64_t ov_time_tell(OggVorbis_File *vf);
|
||||
|
||||
extern vorbis_info *ov_info(OggVorbis_File *vf,int link);
|
||||
extern vorbis_comment *ov_comment(OggVorbis_File *vf,int link);
|
||||
|
||||
extern long ov_read(OggVorbis_File *vf,char *buffer,int length,
|
||||
int *bitstream);
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif /* __cplusplus */
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
428
portlibs/include/zconf.h
Normal file
428
portlibs/include/zconf.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,428 @@
|
||||
/* zconf.h -- configuration of the zlib compression library
|
||||
* Copyright (C) 1995-2010 Jean-loup Gailly.
|
||||
* For conditions of distribution and use, see copyright notice in zlib.h
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* @(#) $Id$ */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef ZCONF_H
|
||||
#define ZCONF_H
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* If you *really* need a unique prefix for all types and library functions,
|
||||
* compile with -DZ_PREFIX. The "standard" zlib should be compiled without it.
|
||||
* Even better than compiling with -DZ_PREFIX would be to use configure to set
|
||||
* this permanently in zconf.h using "./configure --zprefix".
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef Z_PREFIX /* may be set to #if 1 by ./configure */
|
||||
|
||||
/* all linked symbols */
|
||||
# define _dist_code z__dist_code
|
||||
# define _length_code z__length_code
|
||||
# define _tr_align z__tr_align
|
||||
# define _tr_flush_block z__tr_flush_block
|
||||
# define _tr_init z__tr_init
|
||||
# define _tr_stored_block z__tr_stored_block
|
||||
# define _tr_tally z__tr_tally
|
||||
# define adler32 z_adler32
|
||||
# define adler32_combine z_adler32_combine
|
||||
# define adler32_combine64 z_adler32_combine64
|
||||
# define compress z_compress
|
||||
# define compress2 z_compress2
|
||||
# define compressBound z_compressBound
|
||||
# define crc32 z_crc32
|
||||
# define crc32_combine z_crc32_combine
|
||||
# define crc32_combine64 z_crc32_combine64
|
||||
# define deflate z_deflate
|
||||
# define deflateBound z_deflateBound
|
||||
# define deflateCopy z_deflateCopy
|
||||
# define deflateEnd z_deflateEnd
|
||||
# define deflateInit2_ z_deflateInit2_
|
||||
# define deflateInit_ z_deflateInit_
|
||||
# define deflateParams z_deflateParams
|
||||
# define deflatePrime z_deflatePrime
|
||||
# define deflateReset z_deflateReset
|
||||
# define deflateSetDictionary z_deflateSetDictionary
|
||||
# define deflateSetHeader z_deflateSetHeader
|
||||
# define deflateTune z_deflateTune
|
||||
# define deflate_copyright z_deflate_copyright
|
||||
# define get_crc_table z_get_crc_table
|
||||
# define gz_error z_gz_error
|
||||
# define gz_intmax z_gz_intmax
|
||||
# define gz_strwinerror z_gz_strwinerror
|
||||
# define gzbuffer z_gzbuffer
|
||||
# define gzclearerr z_gzclearerr
|
||||
# define gzclose z_gzclose
|
||||
# define gzclose_r z_gzclose_r
|
||||
# define gzclose_w z_gzclose_w
|
||||
# define gzdirect z_gzdirect
|
||||
# define gzdopen z_gzdopen
|
||||
# define gzeof z_gzeof
|
||||
# define gzerror z_gzerror
|
||||
# define gzflush z_gzflush
|
||||
# define gzgetc z_gzgetc
|
||||
# define gzgets z_gzgets
|
||||
# define gzoffset z_gzoffset
|
||||
# define gzoffset64 z_gzoffset64
|
||||
# define gzopen z_gzopen
|
||||
# define gzopen64 z_gzopen64
|
||||
# define gzprintf z_gzprintf
|
||||
# define gzputc z_gzputc
|
||||
# define gzputs z_gzputs
|
||||
# define gzread z_gzread
|
||||
# define gzrewind z_gzrewind
|
||||
# define gzseek z_gzseek
|
||||
# define gzseek64 z_gzseek64
|
||||
# define gzsetparams z_gzsetparams
|
||||
# define gztell z_gztell
|
||||
# define gztell64 z_gztell64
|
||||
# define gzungetc z_gzungetc
|
||||
# define gzwrite z_gzwrite
|
||||
# define inflate z_inflate
|
||||
# define inflateBack z_inflateBack
|
||||
# define inflateBackEnd z_inflateBackEnd
|
||||
# define inflateBackInit_ z_inflateBackInit_
|
||||
# define inflateCopy z_inflateCopy
|
||||
# define inflateEnd z_inflateEnd
|
||||
# define inflateGetHeader z_inflateGetHeader
|
||||
# define inflateInit2_ z_inflateInit2_
|
||||
# define inflateInit_ z_inflateInit_
|
||||
# define inflateMark z_inflateMark
|
||||
# define inflatePrime z_inflatePrime
|
||||
# define inflateReset z_inflateReset
|
||||
# define inflateReset2 z_inflateReset2
|
||||
# define inflateSetDictionary z_inflateSetDictionary
|
||||
# define inflateSync z_inflateSync
|
||||
# define inflateSyncPoint z_inflateSyncPoint
|
||||
# define inflateUndermine z_inflateUndermine
|
||||
# define inflate_copyright z_inflate_copyright
|
||||
# define inflate_fast z_inflate_fast
|
||||
# define inflate_table z_inflate_table
|
||||
# define uncompress z_uncompress
|
||||
# define zError z_zError
|
||||
# define zcalloc z_zcalloc
|
||||
# define zcfree z_zcfree
|
||||
# define zlibCompileFlags z_zlibCompileFlags
|
||||
# define zlibVersion z_zlibVersion
|
||||
|
||||
/* all zlib typedefs in zlib.h and zconf.h */
|
||||
# define Byte z_Byte
|
||||
# define Bytef z_Bytef
|
||||
# define alloc_func z_alloc_func
|
||||
# define charf z_charf
|
||||
# define free_func z_free_func
|
||||
# define gzFile z_gzFile
|
||||
# define gz_header z_gz_header
|
||||
# define gz_headerp z_gz_headerp
|
||||
# define in_func z_in_func
|
||||
# define intf z_intf
|
||||
# define out_func z_out_func
|
||||
# define uInt z_uInt
|
||||
# define uIntf z_uIntf
|
||||
# define uLong z_uLong
|
||||
# define uLongf z_uLongf
|
||||
# define voidp z_voidp
|
||||
# define voidpc z_voidpc
|
||||
# define voidpf z_voidpf
|
||||
|
||||
/* all zlib structs in zlib.h and zconf.h */
|
||||
# define gz_header_s z_gz_header_s
|
||||
# define internal_state z_internal_state
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__MSDOS__) && !defined(MSDOS)
|
||||
# define MSDOS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if (defined(OS_2) || defined(__OS2__)) && !defined(OS2)
|
||||
# define OS2
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if defined(_WINDOWS) && !defined(WINDOWS)
|
||||
# define WINDOWS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if defined(_WIN32) || defined(_WIN32_WCE) || defined(__WIN32__)
|
||||
# ifndef WIN32
|
||||
# define WIN32
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if (defined(MSDOS) || defined(OS2) || defined(WINDOWS)) && !defined(WIN32)
|
||||
# if !defined(__GNUC__) && !defined(__FLAT__) && !defined(__386__)
|
||||
# ifndef SYS16BIT
|
||||
# define SYS16BIT
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
* Compile with -DMAXSEG_64K if the alloc function cannot allocate more
|
||||
* than 64k bytes at a time (needed on systems with 16-bit int).
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef SYS16BIT
|
||||
# define MAXSEG_64K
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifdef MSDOS
|
||||
# define UNALIGNED_OK
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __STDC_VERSION__
|
||||
# ifndef STDC
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if __STDC_VERSION__ >= 199901L
|
||||
# ifndef STDC99
|
||||
# define STDC99
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !defined(STDC) && (defined(__STDC__) || defined(__cplusplus))
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !defined(STDC) && (defined(__GNUC__) || defined(__BORLANDC__))
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !defined(STDC) && (defined(MSDOS) || defined(WINDOWS) || defined(WIN32))
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#if !defined(STDC) && (defined(OS2) || defined(__HOS_AIX__))
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__OS400__) && !defined(STDC) /* iSeries (formerly AS/400). */
|
||||
# define STDC
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef STDC
|
||||
# ifndef const /* cannot use !defined(STDC) && !defined(const) on Mac */
|
||||
# define const /* note: need a more gentle solution here */
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Some Mac compilers merge all .h files incorrectly: */
|
||||
#if defined(__MWERKS__)||defined(applec)||defined(THINK_C)||defined(__SC__)
|
||||
# define NO_DUMMY_DECL
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Maximum value for memLevel in deflateInit2 */
|
||||
#ifndef MAX_MEM_LEVEL
|
||||
# ifdef MAXSEG_64K
|
||||
# define MAX_MEM_LEVEL 8
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define MAX_MEM_LEVEL 9
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* Maximum value for windowBits in deflateInit2 and inflateInit2.
|
||||
* WARNING: reducing MAX_WBITS makes minigzip unable to extract .gz files
|
||||
* created by gzip. (Files created by minigzip can still be extracted by
|
||||
* gzip.)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifndef MAX_WBITS
|
||||
# define MAX_WBITS 15 /* 32K LZ77 window */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The memory requirements for deflate are (in bytes):
|
||||
(1 << (windowBits+2)) + (1 << (memLevel+9))
|
||||
that is: 128K for windowBits=15 + 128K for memLevel = 8 (default values)
|
||||
plus a few kilobytes for small objects. For example, if you want to reduce
|
||||
the default memory requirements from 256K to 128K, compile with
|
||||
make CFLAGS="-O -DMAX_WBITS=14 -DMAX_MEM_LEVEL=7"
|
||||
Of course this will generally degrade compression (there's no free lunch).
|
||||
|
||||
The memory requirements for inflate are (in bytes) 1 << windowBits
|
||||
that is, 32K for windowBits=15 (default value) plus a few kilobytes
|
||||
for small objects.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Type declarations */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef OF /* function prototypes */
|
||||
# ifdef STDC
|
||||
# define OF(args) args
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define OF(args) ()
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* The following definitions for FAR are needed only for MSDOS mixed
|
||||
* model programming (small or medium model with some far allocations).
|
||||
* This was tested only with MSC; for other MSDOS compilers you may have
|
||||
* to define NO_MEMCPY in zutil.h. If you don't need the mixed model,
|
||||
* just define FAR to be empty.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#ifdef SYS16BIT
|
||||
# if defined(M_I86SM) || defined(M_I86MM)
|
||||
/* MSC small or medium model */
|
||||
# define SMALL_MEDIUM
|
||||
# ifdef _MSC_VER
|
||||
# define FAR _far
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define FAR far
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# if (defined(__SMALL__) || defined(__MEDIUM__))
|
||||
/* Turbo C small or medium model */
|
||||
# define SMALL_MEDIUM
|
||||
# ifdef __BORLANDC__
|
||||
# define FAR _far
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define FAR far
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(WINDOWS) || defined(WIN32)
|
||||
/* If building or using zlib as a DLL, define ZLIB_DLL.
|
||||
* This is not mandatory, but it offers a little performance increase.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifdef ZLIB_DLL
|
||||
# if defined(WIN32) && (!defined(__BORLANDC__) || (__BORLANDC__ >= 0x500))
|
||||
# ifdef ZLIB_INTERNAL
|
||||
# define ZEXTERN extern __declspec(dllexport)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ZEXTERN extern __declspec(dllimport)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif /* ZLIB_DLL */
|
||||
/* If building or using zlib with the WINAPI/WINAPIV calling convention,
|
||||
* define ZLIB_WINAPI.
|
||||
* Caution: the standard ZLIB1.DLL is NOT compiled using ZLIB_WINAPI.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
# ifdef ZLIB_WINAPI
|
||||
# ifdef FAR
|
||||
# undef FAR
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# include <windows.h>
|
||||
/* No need for _export, use ZLIB.DEF instead. */
|
||||
/* For complete Windows compatibility, use WINAPI, not __stdcall. */
|
||||
# define ZEXPORT WINAPI
|
||||
# ifdef WIN32
|
||||
# define ZEXPORTVA WINAPIV
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ZEXPORTVA FAR CDECL
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined (__BEOS__)
|
||||
# ifdef ZLIB_DLL
|
||||
# ifdef ZLIB_INTERNAL
|
||||
# define ZEXPORT __declspec(dllexport)
|
||||
# define ZEXPORTVA __declspec(dllexport)
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define ZEXPORT __declspec(dllimport)
|
||||
# define ZEXPORTVA __declspec(dllimport)
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef ZEXTERN
|
||||
# define ZEXTERN extern
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef ZEXPORT
|
||||
# define ZEXPORT
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#ifndef ZEXPORTVA
|
||||
# define ZEXPORTVA
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef FAR
|
||||
# define FAR
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if !defined(__MACTYPES__)
|
||||
typedef unsigned char Byte; /* 8 bits */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
typedef unsigned int uInt; /* 16 bits or more */
|
||||
typedef unsigned long uLong; /* 32 bits or more */
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef SMALL_MEDIUM
|
||||
/* Borland C/C++ and some old MSC versions ignore FAR inside typedef */
|
||||
# define Bytef Byte FAR
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef Byte FAR Bytef;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
typedef char FAR charf;
|
||||
typedef int FAR intf;
|
||||
typedef uInt FAR uIntf;
|
||||
typedef uLong FAR uLongf;
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef STDC
|
||||
typedef void const *voidpc;
|
||||
typedef void FAR *voidpf;
|
||||
typedef void *voidp;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef Byte const *voidpc;
|
||||
typedef Byte FAR *voidpf;
|
||||
typedef Byte *voidp;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if 1 /* was set to #if 1 by ./configure */
|
||||
# define Z_HAVE_UNISTD_H
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef STDC
|
||||
# include <sys/types.h> /* for off_t */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* a little trick to accommodate both "#define _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE" and
|
||||
* "#define _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE 1" as requesting 64-bit operations, (even
|
||||
* though the former does not conform to the LFS document), but considering
|
||||
* both "#undef _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE" and "#define _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE 0" as
|
||||
* equivalently requesting no 64-bit operations
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if -_LARGEFILE64_SOURCE - -1 == 1
|
||||
# undef _LARGEFILE64_SOURCE
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(Z_HAVE_UNISTD_H) || defined(_LARGEFILE64_SOURCE)
|
||||
# include <unistd.h> /* for SEEK_* and off_t */
|
||||
# ifdef VMS
|
||||
# include <unixio.h> /* for off_t */
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
# ifndef z_off_t
|
||||
# define z_off_t off_t
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef SEEK_SET
|
||||
# define SEEK_SET 0 /* Seek from beginning of file. */
|
||||
# define SEEK_CUR 1 /* Seek from current position. */
|
||||
# define SEEK_END 2 /* Set file pointer to EOF plus "offset" */
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef z_off_t
|
||||
# define z_off_t long
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(_LARGEFILE64_SOURCE) && _LFS64_LARGEFILE-0
|
||||
# define z_off64_t off64_t
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# define z_off64_t z_off_t
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__OS400__)
|
||||
# define NO_vsnprintf
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__MVS__)
|
||||
# define NO_vsnprintf
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/* MVS linker does not support external names larger than 8 bytes */
|
||||
#if defined(__MVS__)
|
||||
#pragma map(deflateInit_,"DEIN")
|
||||
#pragma map(deflateInit2_,"DEIN2")
|
||||
#pragma map(deflateEnd,"DEEND")
|
||||
#pragma map(deflateBound,"DEBND")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflateInit_,"ININ")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflateInit2_,"ININ2")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflateEnd,"INEND")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflateSync,"INSY")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflateSetDictionary,"INSEDI")
|
||||
#pragma map(compressBound,"CMBND")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflate_table,"INTABL")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflate_fast,"INFA")
|
||||
#pragma map(inflate_copyright,"INCOPY")
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* ZCONF_H */
|
75
portlibs/include/zip/ioapi.h
Normal file
75
portlibs/include/zip/ioapi.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
|
||||
/* ioapi.h -- IO base function header for compress/uncompress .zip
|
||||
files using zlib + zip or unzip API
|
||||
|
||||
Version 1.01e, February 12th, 2005
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1998-2005 Gilles Vollant
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _ZLIBIOAPI_H
|
||||
#define _ZLIBIOAPI_H
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_SEEK_CUR (1)
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_SEEK_END (2)
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_SEEK_SET (0)
|
||||
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_MODE_READ (1)
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_MODE_WRITE (2)
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_MODE_READWRITEFILTER (3)
|
||||
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_MODE_EXISTING (4)
|
||||
#define ZLIB_FILEFUNC_MODE_CREATE (8)
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef ZCALLBACK
|
||||
|
||||
#if (defined(WIN32) || defined (WINDOWS) || defined (_WINDOWS)) && defined(CALLBACK) && defined (USEWINDOWS_CALLBACK)
|
||||
#define ZCALLBACK CALLBACK
|
||||
#else
|
||||
#define ZCALLBACK
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
typedef voidpf (ZCALLBACK *open_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, const char* filename, int mode));
|
||||
typedef uLong (ZCALLBACK *read_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream, void* buf, uLong size));
|
||||
typedef uLong (ZCALLBACK *write_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream, const void* buf, uLong size));
|
||||
typedef long (ZCALLBACK *tell_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream));
|
||||
typedef long (ZCALLBACK *seek_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream, uLong offset, int origin));
|
||||
typedef int (ZCALLBACK *close_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream));
|
||||
typedef int (ZCALLBACK *testerror_file_func) OF((voidpf opaque, voidpf stream));
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct zlib_filefunc_def_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
open_file_func zopen_file;
|
||||
read_file_func zread_file;
|
||||
write_file_func zwrite_file;
|
||||
tell_file_func ztell_file;
|
||||
seek_file_func zseek_file;
|
||||
close_file_func zclose_file;
|
||||
testerror_file_func zerror_file;
|
||||
voidpf opaque;
|
||||
} zlib_filefunc_def;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
void fill_fopen_filefunc OF((zlib_filefunc_def* pzlib_filefunc_def));
|
||||
|
||||
#define ZREAD(filefunc,filestream,buf,size) ((*((filefunc).zread_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream,buf,size))
|
||||
#define ZWRITE(filefunc,filestream,buf,size) ((*((filefunc).zwrite_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream,buf,size))
|
||||
#define ZTELL(filefunc,filestream) ((*((filefunc).ztell_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream))
|
||||
#define ZSEEK(filefunc,filestream,pos,mode) ((*((filefunc).zseek_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream,pos,mode))
|
||||
#define ZCLOSE(filefunc,filestream) ((*((filefunc).zclose_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream))
|
||||
#define ZERROR(filefunc,filestream) ((*((filefunc).zerror_file))((filefunc).opaque,filestream))
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
354
portlibs/include/zip/unzip.h
Normal file
354
portlibs/include/zip/unzip.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,354 @@
|
||||
/* unzip.h -- IO for uncompress .zip files using zlib
|
||||
Version 1.01e, February 12th, 2005
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1998-2005 Gilles Vollant
|
||||
|
||||
This unzip package allow extract file from .ZIP file, compatible with PKZip 2.04g
|
||||
WinZip, InfoZip tools and compatible.
|
||||
|
||||
Multi volume ZipFile (span) are not supported.
|
||||
Encryption compatible with pkzip 2.04g only supported
|
||||
Old compressions used by old PKZip 1.x are not supported
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
I WAIT FEEDBACK at mail info@winimage.com
|
||||
Visit also http://www.winimage.com/zLibDll/unzip.htm for evolution
|
||||
|
||||
Condition of use and distribution are the same than zlib :
|
||||
|
||||
This software is provided 'as-is', without any express or implied
|
||||
warranty. In no event will the authors be held liable for any damages
|
||||
arising from the use of this software.
|
||||
|
||||
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose,
|
||||
including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it
|
||||
freely, subject to the following restrictions:
|
||||
|
||||
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not
|
||||
claim that you wrote the original software. If you use this software
|
||||
in a product, an acknowledgment in the product documentation would be
|
||||
appreciated but is not required.
|
||||
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
|
||||
misrepresented as being the original software.
|
||||
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* for more info about .ZIP format, see
|
||||
http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/doc/appnote-981119-iz.zip
|
||||
http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/doc/
|
||||
PkWare has also a specification at :
|
||||
ftp://ftp.pkware.com/probdesc.zip
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _unz_H
|
||||
#define _unz_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _ZLIB_H
|
||||
#include "zlib.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _ZLIBIOAPI_H
|
||||
#include "ioapi.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(STRICTUNZIP) || defined(STRICTZIPUNZIP)
|
||||
/* like the STRICT of WIN32, we define a pointer that cannot be converted
|
||||
from (void*) without cast */
|
||||
typedef struct TagunzFile__ { int unused; } unzFile__;
|
||||
typedef unzFile__ *unzFile;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef voidp unzFile;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define UNZ_OK (0)
|
||||
#define UNZ_END_OF_LIST_OF_FILE (-100)
|
||||
#define UNZ_ERRNO (Z_ERRNO)
|
||||
#define UNZ_EOF (0)
|
||||
#define UNZ_PARAMERROR (-102)
|
||||
#define UNZ_BADZIPFILE (-103)
|
||||
#define UNZ_INTERNALERROR (-104)
|
||||
#define UNZ_CRCERROR (-105)
|
||||
|
||||
/* tm_unz contain date/time info */
|
||||
typedef struct tm_unz_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
uInt tm_sec; /* seconds after the minute - [0,59] */
|
||||
uInt tm_min; /* minutes after the hour - [0,59] */
|
||||
uInt tm_hour; /* hours since midnight - [0,23] */
|
||||
uInt tm_mday; /* day of the month - [1,31] */
|
||||
uInt tm_mon; /* months since January - [0,11] */
|
||||
uInt tm_year; /* years - [1980..2044] */
|
||||
} tm_unz;
|
||||
|
||||
/* unz_global_info structure contain global data about the ZIPfile
|
||||
These data comes from the end of central dir */
|
||||
typedef struct unz_global_info_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
uLong number_entry; /* total number of entries in
|
||||
the central dir on this disk */
|
||||
uLong size_comment; /* size of the global comment of the zipfile */
|
||||
} unz_global_info;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* unz_file_info contain information about a file in the zipfile */
|
||||
typedef struct unz_file_info_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
uLong version; /* version made by 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong version_needed; /* version needed to extract 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong flag; /* general purpose bit flag 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong compression_method; /* compression method 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong dosDate; /* last mod file date in Dos fmt 4 bytes */
|
||||
uLong crc; /* crc-32 4 bytes */
|
||||
uLong compressed_size; /* compressed size 4 bytes */
|
||||
uLong uncompressed_size; /* uncompressed size 4 bytes */
|
||||
uLong size_filename; /* filename length 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong size_file_extra; /* extra field length 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong size_file_comment; /* file comment length 2 bytes */
|
||||
|
||||
uLong disk_num_start; /* disk number start 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong internal_fa; /* internal file attributes 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong external_fa; /* external file attributes 4 bytes */
|
||||
|
||||
tm_unz tmu_date;
|
||||
} unz_file_info;
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzStringFileNameCompare OF ((const char* fileName1,
|
||||
const char* fileName2,
|
||||
int iCaseSensitivity));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Compare two filename (fileName1,fileName2).
|
||||
If iCaseSenisivity = 1, comparision is case sensitivity (like strcmp)
|
||||
If iCaseSenisivity = 2, comparision is not case sensitivity (like strcmpi
|
||||
or strcasecmp)
|
||||
If iCaseSenisivity = 0, case sensitivity is defaut of your operating system
|
||||
(like 1 on Unix, 2 on Windows)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern unzFile ZEXPORT unzOpen OF((const char *path));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Open a Zip file. path contain the full pathname (by example,
|
||||
on a Windows XP computer "c:\\zlib\\zlib113.zip" or on an Unix computer
|
||||
"zlib/zlib113.zip".
|
||||
If the zipfile cannot be opened (file don't exist or in not valid), the
|
||||
return value is NULL.
|
||||
Else, the return value is a unzFile Handle, usable with other function
|
||||
of this unzip package.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern unzFile ZEXPORT unzOpen2 OF((const char *path,
|
||||
zlib_filefunc_def* pzlib_filefunc_def));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Open a Zip file, like unzOpen, but provide a set of file low level API
|
||||
for read/write the zip file (see ioapi.h)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzClose OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Close a ZipFile opened with unzipOpen.
|
||||
If there is files inside the .Zip opened with unzOpenCurrentFile (see later),
|
||||
these files MUST be closed with unzipCloseCurrentFile before call unzipClose.
|
||||
return UNZ_OK if there is no problem. */
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGetGlobalInfo OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
unz_global_info *pglobal_info));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Write info about the ZipFile in the *pglobal_info structure.
|
||||
No preparation of the structure is needed
|
||||
return UNZ_OK if there is no problem. */
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGetGlobalComment OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
char *szComment,
|
||||
uLong uSizeBuf));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Get the global comment string of the ZipFile, in the szComment buffer.
|
||||
uSizeBuf is the size of the szComment buffer.
|
||||
return the number of byte copied or an error code <0
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* Unzip package allow you browse the directory of the zipfile */
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGoToFirstFile OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Set the current file of the zipfile to the first file.
|
||||
return UNZ_OK if there is no problem
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGoToNextFile OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Set the current file of the zipfile to the next file.
|
||||
return UNZ_OK if there is no problem
|
||||
return UNZ_END_OF_LIST_OF_FILE if the actual file was the latest.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzLocateFile OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
const char *szFileName,
|
||||
int iCaseSensitivity));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Try locate the file szFileName in the zipfile.
|
||||
For the iCaseSensitivity signification, see unzStringFileNameCompare
|
||||
|
||||
return value :
|
||||
UNZ_OK if the file is found. It becomes the current file.
|
||||
UNZ_END_OF_LIST_OF_FILE if the file is not found
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
/* ****************************************** */
|
||||
/* Ryan supplied functions */
|
||||
/* unz_file_info contain information about a file in the zipfile */
|
||||
typedef struct unz_file_pos_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
uLong pos_in_zip_directory; /* offset in zip file directory */
|
||||
uLong num_of_file; /* # of file */
|
||||
} unz_file_pos;
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGetFilePos(
|
||||
unzFile file,
|
||||
unz_file_pos* file_pos);
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGoToFilePos(
|
||||
unzFile file,
|
||||
unz_file_pos* file_pos);
|
||||
|
||||
/* ****************************************** */
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGetCurrentFileInfo OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
unz_file_info *pfile_info,
|
||||
char *szFileName,
|
||||
uLong fileNameBufferSize,
|
||||
void *extraField,
|
||||
uLong extraFieldBufferSize,
|
||||
char *szComment,
|
||||
uLong commentBufferSize));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Get Info about the current file
|
||||
if pfile_info!=NULL, the *pfile_info structure will contain somes info about
|
||||
the current file
|
||||
if szFileName!=NULL, the filemane string will be copied in szFileName
|
||||
(fileNameBufferSize is the size of the buffer)
|
||||
if extraField!=NULL, the extra field information will be copied in extraField
|
||||
(extraFieldBufferSize is the size of the buffer).
|
||||
This is the Central-header version of the extra field
|
||||
if szComment!=NULL, the comment string of the file will be copied in szComment
|
||||
(commentBufferSize is the size of the buffer)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
/* for reading the content of the current zipfile, you can open it, read data
|
||||
from it, and close it (you can close it before reading all the file)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzOpenCurrentFile OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Open for reading data the current file in the zipfile.
|
||||
If there is no error, the return value is UNZ_OK.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzOpenCurrentFilePassword OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
const char* password));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Open for reading data the current file in the zipfile.
|
||||
password is a crypting password
|
||||
If there is no error, the return value is UNZ_OK.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzOpenCurrentFile2 OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
int* method,
|
||||
int* level,
|
||||
int raw));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Same than unzOpenCurrentFile, but open for read raw the file (not uncompress)
|
||||
if raw==1
|
||||
*method will receive method of compression, *level will receive level of
|
||||
compression
|
||||
note : you can set level parameter as NULL (if you did not want known level,
|
||||
but you CANNOT set method parameter as NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzOpenCurrentFile3 OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
int* method,
|
||||
int* level,
|
||||
int raw,
|
||||
const char* password));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Same than unzOpenCurrentFile, but open for read raw the file (not uncompress)
|
||||
if raw==1
|
||||
*method will receive method of compression, *level will receive level of
|
||||
compression
|
||||
note : you can set level parameter as NULL (if you did not want known level,
|
||||
but you CANNOT set method parameter as NULL
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzCloseCurrentFile OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Close the file in zip opened with unzOpenCurrentFile
|
||||
Return UNZ_CRCERROR if all the file was read but the CRC is not good
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzReadCurrentFile OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
voidp buf,
|
||||
unsigned len));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Read bytes from the current file (opened by unzOpenCurrentFile)
|
||||
buf contain buffer where data must be copied
|
||||
len the size of buf.
|
||||
|
||||
return the number of byte copied if somes bytes are copied
|
||||
return 0 if the end of file was reached
|
||||
return <0 with error code if there is an error
|
||||
(UNZ_ERRNO for IO error, or zLib error for uncompress error)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern z_off_t ZEXPORT unztell OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Give the current position in uncompressed data
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzeof OF((unzFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
return 1 if the end of file was reached, 0 elsewhere
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzGetLocalExtrafield OF((unzFile file,
|
||||
voidp buf,
|
||||
unsigned len));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Read extra field from the current file (opened by unzOpenCurrentFile)
|
||||
This is the local-header version of the extra field (sometimes, there is
|
||||
more info in the local-header version than in the central-header)
|
||||
|
||||
if buf==NULL, it return the size of the local extra field
|
||||
|
||||
if buf!=NULL, len is the size of the buffer, the extra header is copied in
|
||||
buf.
|
||||
the return value is the number of bytes copied in buf, or (if <0)
|
||||
the error code
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/***************************************************************************/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Get the current file offset */
|
||||
extern uLong ZEXPORT unzGetOffset (unzFile file);
|
||||
|
||||
/* Set the current file offset */
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT unzSetOffset (unzFile file, uLong pos);
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _unz_H */
|
235
portlibs/include/zip/zip.h
Normal file
235
portlibs/include/zip/zip.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,235 @@
|
||||
/* zip.h -- IO for compress .zip files using zlib
|
||||
Version 1.01e, February 12th, 2005
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (C) 1998-2005 Gilles Vollant
|
||||
|
||||
This unzip package allow creates .ZIP file, compatible with PKZip 2.04g
|
||||
WinZip, InfoZip tools and compatible.
|
||||
Multi volume ZipFile (span) are not supported.
|
||||
Encryption compatible with pkzip 2.04g only supported
|
||||
Old compressions used by old PKZip 1.x are not supported
|
||||
|
||||
For uncompress .zip file, look at unzip.h
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
I WAIT FEEDBACK at mail info@winimage.com
|
||||
Visit also http://www.winimage.com/zLibDll/unzip.html for evolution
|
||||
|
||||
Condition of use and distribution are the same than zlib :
|
||||
|
||||
This software is provided 'as-is', without any express or implied
|
||||
warranty. In no event will the authors be held liable for any damages
|
||||
arising from the use of this software.
|
||||
|
||||
Permission is granted to anyone to use this software for any purpose,
|
||||
including commercial applications, and to alter it and redistribute it
|
||||
freely, subject to the following restrictions:
|
||||
|
||||
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not
|
||||
claim that you wrote the original software. If you use this software
|
||||
in a product, an acknowledgment in the product documentation would be
|
||||
appreciated but is not required.
|
||||
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked as such, and must not be
|
||||
misrepresented as being the original software.
|
||||
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source distribution.
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* for more info about .ZIP format, see
|
||||
http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/doc/appnote-981119-iz.zip
|
||||
http://www.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/doc/
|
||||
PkWare has also a specification at :
|
||||
ftp://ftp.pkware.com/probdesc.zip
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _zip_H
|
||||
#define _zip_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _ZLIB_H
|
||||
#include "zlib.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _ZLIBIOAPI_H
|
||||
#include "ioapi.h"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(STRICTZIP) || defined(STRICTZIPUNZIP)
|
||||
/* like the STRICT of WIN32, we define a pointer that cannot be converted
|
||||
from (void*) without cast */
|
||||
typedef struct TagzipFile__ { int unused; } zipFile__;
|
||||
typedef zipFile__ *zipFile;
|
||||
#else
|
||||
typedef voidp zipFile;
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#define ZIP_OK (0)
|
||||
#define ZIP_EOF (0)
|
||||
#define ZIP_ERRNO (Z_ERRNO)
|
||||
#define ZIP_PARAMERROR (-102)
|
||||
#define ZIP_BADZIPFILE (-103)
|
||||
#define ZIP_INTERNALERROR (-104)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef DEF_MEM_LEVEL
|
||||
# if MAX_MEM_LEVEL >= 8
|
||||
# define DEF_MEM_LEVEL 8
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# define DEF_MEM_LEVEL MAX_MEM_LEVEL
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
/* default memLevel */
|
||||
|
||||
/* tm_zip contain date/time info */
|
||||
typedef struct tm_zip_s
|
||||
{
|
||||
uInt tm_sec; /* seconds after the minute - [0,59] */
|
||||
uInt tm_min; /* minutes after the hour - [0,59] */
|
||||
uInt tm_hour; /* hours since midnight - [0,23] */
|
||||
uInt tm_mday; /* day of the month - [1,31] */
|
||||
uInt tm_mon; /* months since January - [0,11] */
|
||||
uInt tm_year; /* years - [1980..2044] */
|
||||
} tm_zip;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
tm_zip tmz_date; /* date in understandable format */
|
||||
uLong dosDate; /* if dos_date == 0, tmu_date is used */
|
||||
/* uLong flag; */ /* general purpose bit flag 2 bytes */
|
||||
|
||||
uLong internal_fa; /* internal file attributes 2 bytes */
|
||||
uLong external_fa; /* external file attributes 4 bytes */
|
||||
} zip_fileinfo;
|
||||
|
||||
typedef const char* zipcharpc;
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#define APPEND_STATUS_CREATE (0)
|
||||
#define APPEND_STATUS_CREATEAFTER (1)
|
||||
#define APPEND_STATUS_ADDINZIP (2)
|
||||
|
||||
extern zipFile ZEXPORT zipOpen OF((const char *pathname, int append));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Create a zipfile.
|
||||
pathname contain on Windows XP a filename like "c:\\zlib\\zlib113.zip" or on
|
||||
an Unix computer "zlib/zlib113.zip".
|
||||
if the file pathname exist and append==APPEND_STATUS_CREATEAFTER, the zip
|
||||
will be created at the end of the file.
|
||||
(useful if the file contain a self extractor code)
|
||||
if the file pathname exist and append==APPEND_STATUS_ADDINZIP, we will
|
||||
add files in existing zip (be sure you don't add file that doesn't exist)
|
||||
If the zipfile cannot be opened, the return value is NULL.
|
||||
Else, the return value is a zipFile Handle, usable with other function
|
||||
of this zip package.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
/* Note : there is no delete function into a zipfile.
|
||||
If you want delete file into a zipfile, you must open a zipfile, and create another
|
||||
Of couse, you can use RAW reading and writing to copy the file you did not want delte
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern zipFile ZEXPORT zipOpen2 OF((const char *pathname,
|
||||
int append,
|
||||
zipcharpc* globalcomment,
|
||||
zlib_filefunc_def* pzlib_filefunc_def));
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipOpenNewFileInZip OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
const char* filename,
|
||||
const zip_fileinfo* zipfi,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_local,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_local,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_global,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_global,
|
||||
const char* comment,
|
||||
int method,
|
||||
int level));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Open a file in the ZIP for writing.
|
||||
filename : the filename in zip (if NULL, '-' without quote will be used
|
||||
*zipfi contain supplemental information
|
||||
if extrafield_local!=NULL and size_extrafield_local>0, extrafield_local
|
||||
contains the extrafield data the the local header
|
||||
if extrafield_global!=NULL and size_extrafield_global>0, extrafield_global
|
||||
contains the extrafield data the the local header
|
||||
if comment != NULL, comment contain the comment string
|
||||
method contain the compression method (0 for store, Z_DEFLATED for deflate)
|
||||
level contain the level of compression (can be Z_DEFAULT_COMPRESSION)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipOpenNewFileInZip2 OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
const char* filename,
|
||||
const zip_fileinfo* zipfi,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_local,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_local,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_global,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_global,
|
||||
const char* comment,
|
||||
int method,
|
||||
int level,
|
||||
int raw));
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Same than zipOpenNewFileInZip, except if raw=1, we write raw file
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipOpenNewFileInZip3 OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
const char* filename,
|
||||
const zip_fileinfo* zipfi,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_local,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_local,
|
||||
const void* extrafield_global,
|
||||
uInt size_extrafield_global,
|
||||
const char* comment,
|
||||
int method,
|
||||
int level,
|
||||
int raw,
|
||||
int windowBits,
|
||||
int memLevel,
|
||||
int strategy,
|
||||
const char* password,
|
||||
uLong crcForCtypting));
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Same than zipOpenNewFileInZip2, except
|
||||
windowBits,memLevel,,strategy : see parameter strategy in deflateInit2
|
||||
password : crypting password (NULL for no crypting)
|
||||
crcForCtypting : crc of file to compress (needed for crypting)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipWriteInFileInZip OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
const void* buf,
|
||||
unsigned len));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Write data in the zipfile
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipCloseFileInZip OF((zipFile file));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Close the current file in the zipfile
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipCloseFileInZipRaw OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
uLong uncompressed_size,
|
||||
uLong crc32));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Close the current file in the zipfile, for fiel opened with
|
||||
parameter raw=1 in zipOpenNewFileInZip2
|
||||
uncompressed_size and crc32 are value for the uncompressed size
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
extern int ZEXPORT zipClose OF((zipFile file,
|
||||
const char* global_comment));
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Close the zipfile
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif /* _zip_H */
|
1613
portlibs/include/zlib.h
Normal file
1613
portlibs/include/zlib.h
Normal file
File diff suppressed because it is too large
Load Diff
BIN
portlibs/lib/libfreetype.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libfreetype.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libgd.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libgd.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libjpeg.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libjpeg.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libogg.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libogg.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libpng.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libpng.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libvorbisidec.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libvorbisidec.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libz.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libz.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
BIN
portlibs/lib/libzip.a
Normal file
BIN
portlibs/lib/libzip.a
Normal file
Binary file not shown.
@ -24,12 +24,13 @@
|
||||
* for WiiXplorer 2010
|
||||
***************************************************************************/
|
||||
#include <gccore.h>
|
||||
#include <fat.h>
|
||||
#include <ntfs.h>
|
||||
#include <ext2.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include <string.h>
|
||||
#include <malloc.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libs/libfat/fat.h"
|
||||
#include "libs/libntfs/ntfs.h"
|
||||
#include "libs/libext2fs/ext2.h"
|
||||
#include "libs/libwbfs/libwbfs.h"
|
||||
#include "utils/uncompress.h"
|
||||
#include "PartitionHandle.h"
|
||||
|
@ -242,23 +242,24 @@ void FreeTypeGX::loadGlyphData(FT_Bitmap *bmp, ftgxCharData *charData)
|
||||
|
||||
uint8_t *src = (uint8_t *)bmp->buffer;
|
||||
uint8_t *dst = glyphData;
|
||||
int32_t pos, x1, y1, x, y;
|
||||
// Old FreeType uses int32_t and new versions use uint32_t
|
||||
int64_t pos, x1, y1, x, y;
|
||||
|
||||
for(y1 = 0; y1 < bmp->rows; y1 += 8)
|
||||
for(y1 = 0; y1 < (int64_t)bmp->rows; y1 += 8)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for(x1 = 0; x1 < bmp->width; x1 += 8)
|
||||
for(x1 = 0; x1 < (int64_t)bmp->width; x1 += 8)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for(y = y1; y < (y1 + 8); y++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
for(x = x1; x < (x1 + 8); x += 2, dst++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if(x >= bmp->width || y >= bmp->rows)
|
||||
if(x >= (int64_t)bmp->width || y >= (int64_t)bmp->rows)
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
|
||||
pos = y * bmp->width + x;
|
||||
*dst = (src[pos] & 0xF0);
|
||||
|
||||
if(x+1 < bmp->width)
|
||||
if(x+1 < (int64_t)bmp->width)
|
||||
*dst |= (src[pos + 1] >> 4);
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
@ -9,15 +9,16 @@
|
||||
***************************************************************************/
|
||||
GuiImageData *LoadCoverImage(struct discHdr *header, bool Prefere3D, bool noCover)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!header) return NULL;
|
||||
if (!header)
|
||||
return NULL;
|
||||
GuiImageData *Cover = NULL;
|
||||
char ID3[4];
|
||||
char ID3[4] = {};
|
||||
char IDfull[7];
|
||||
char Path[255];
|
||||
bool flag = Prefere3D;
|
||||
|
||||
snprintf(ID3, sizeof(ID3), "%s", (char *) header->id);
|
||||
snprintf(IDfull, sizeof(IDfull), "%s", (char *) header->id);
|
||||
memcpy(ID3, (char *)header->id, sizeof(ID3) - 1);
|
||||
snprintf(IDfull, sizeof(IDfull), "%s", (char *)header->id);
|
||||
|
||||
for (int i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
|
||||
{
|
||||
@ -26,10 +27,10 @@ GuiImageData *LoadCoverImage(struct discHdr *header, bool Prefere3D, bool noCove
|
||||
//Load full id image
|
||||
snprintf(Path, sizeof(Path), "%s%s.png", coverPath, IDfull);
|
||||
|
||||
if(!CheckFile(Path))
|
||||
if (!CheckFile(Path))
|
||||
{
|
||||
snprintf(Path, sizeof(Path), "%s%s.png", coverPath, ID3);
|
||||
if(!CheckFile(Path))
|
||||
if (!CheckFile(Path))
|
||||
continue;
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
@ -42,7 +43,8 @@ GuiImageData *LoadCoverImage(struct discHdr *header, bool Prefere3D, bool noCove
|
||||
delete Cover;
|
||||
Cover = new (std::nothrow) GuiImageData(Path);
|
||||
}
|
||||
if (Cover && Cover->GetImage()) break;
|
||||
if (Cover && Cover->GetImage())
|
||||
break;
|
||||
}
|
||||
//Load no image
|
||||
if (noCover && (!Cover || !Cover->GetImage()))
|
||||
@ -52,7 +54,8 @@ GuiImageData *LoadCoverImage(struct discHdr *header, bool Prefere3D, bool noCove
|
||||
{
|
||||
delete Cover;
|
||||
Cover = Resources::GetImageData(flag ? "nocover.png" : "nocoverFlat.png");
|
||||
if (Cover && Cover->GetImage()) break;
|
||||
if (Cover && Cover->GetImage())
|
||||
break;
|
||||
flag = !flag;
|
||||
}
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
@ -185,8 +185,8 @@ void GCGames::LoadGameList(const string &path, vector<struct discHdr> &headerLis
|
||||
{
|
||||
string gamePath = string(path) + dirname + (extracted ? "/" : strrchr(fpath, '/'));
|
||||
memset(&tmpHdr, 0, sizeof(tmpHdr));
|
||||
memcpy(tmpHdr.id, id, 6);
|
||||
strncpy(tmpHdr.title, title, sizeof(tmpHdr.title) - 1);
|
||||
memcpy(tmpHdr.id, id, sizeof(tmpHdr.id));
|
||||
snprintf(tmpHdr.title, sizeof(tmpHdr.title), "%s", title);
|
||||
tmpHdr.magic = GCGames::MAGIC;
|
||||
tmpHdr.type = extracted ? TYPE_GAME_GC_EXTRACTED : TYPE_GAME_GC_IMG;
|
||||
tmpHdr.disc_no = disc_number;
|
||||
|
@ -521,7 +521,7 @@ u8 * GDImageToRGBA8(gdImagePtr * gdImg, int * w, int * h)
|
||||
|
||||
u8 a;
|
||||
int x, y;
|
||||
u32 pixel, offset;
|
||||
int pixel, offset;
|
||||
|
||||
for(y = 0; y < height; ++y)
|
||||
{
|
||||
|
@ -85,7 +85,7 @@ bool ZipFile::FindFilePart(const char *partfilename, std::string &realname)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if (!File) return false;
|
||||
|
||||
char filename[MAXPATHLEN];
|
||||
char filename[256];
|
||||
|
||||
int ret = unzGoToFirstFile(File);
|
||||
if (ret != UNZ_OK) return false;
|
||||
@ -117,7 +117,7 @@ bool ZipFile::ExtractAll(const char *dest)
|
||||
if (!buffer) return false;
|
||||
|
||||
char writepath[MAXPATHLEN];
|
||||
char filename[MAXPATHLEN];
|
||||
char filename[256];
|
||||
memset(filename, 0, sizeof(filename));
|
||||
|
||||
int ret = unzGoToFirstFile(File);
|
||||
|
@ -185,7 +185,7 @@ private:
|
||||
u32 tevregid : 2;
|
||||
u32 clamp : 1;
|
||||
|
||||
} __attribute__((packed)) color_in, __attribute__((packed)) alpha_in;
|
||||
} __attribute__((packed)) color_in, alpha_in;
|
||||
|
||||
struct
|
||||
{
|
||||
|
@ -20,6 +20,10 @@ misrepresented as being the original software.
|
||||
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from any source
|
||||
distribution.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#if __GNUC__ > 8
|
||||
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Waddress-of-packed-member"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <malloc.h>
|
||||
#include <stdio.h>
|
||||
#include "Channels/channels.h"
|
||||
@ -245,7 +249,7 @@ const u16 * OpeningBNR::GetIMETTitle(int lang)
|
||||
if(imetHdr->names[lang][0] == 0)
|
||||
lang = CONF_LANG_ENGLISH;
|
||||
|
||||
return imetHdr->names[lang];
|
||||
return imetHdr->names[lang]; // possible unaligned pointer value
|
||||
}
|
||||
|
||||
static s32 GC_Disc_Read(void *fp, u32 offset, u32 count, void*iobuf)
|
||||
|
@ -22,6 +22,10 @@ misrepresented as being the original software.
|
||||
distribution.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
#if __GNUC__ > 8
|
||||
#pragma GCC diagnostic ignored "-Waddress-of-packed-member"
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <malloc.h>
|
||||
#include "WiiFont.h"
|
||||
|
||||
@ -139,7 +143,7 @@ bool WiiFont::ParseCmap(CmapEntry *cmapEntry)
|
||||
case 1:
|
||||
{
|
||||
u16 idx = 0;
|
||||
u16 *idxPointer = &cmapEntry->charCode;
|
||||
u16 *idxPointer = &cmapEntry->charCode; // possible unaligned pointer value
|
||||
for(u32 i = cmapEntry->start; i < cmapEntry->end; i++)
|
||||
{
|
||||
u16 m_idx = idxPointer[idx++];
|
||||
|
@ -48,7 +48,7 @@ int CheatMenu(const char * gameID)
|
||||
GuiButton createBtn(&createBtnImg, &createBtnImg, 2, 3, 195, 400, &trigA, NULL, btnSoundClick2, 1);
|
||||
createBtn.SetLabel(&createBtnTxt);
|
||||
|
||||
char txtfilename[55];
|
||||
char txtfilename[120];
|
||||
snprintf(txtfilename, sizeof(txtfilename), "%s%s.txt", Settings.TxtCheatcodespath, gameID);
|
||||
|
||||
GCTCheats gctCheats;
|
||||
|
@ -131,6 +131,10 @@ static const devoptab_t gecko_out = {
|
||||
NULL, // device chmod_r
|
||||
NULL, // device fchmod_r
|
||||
NULL, // device rmdir_r
|
||||
#if __GNUC__ > 8
|
||||
NULL, // lstat_r
|
||||
NULL, // utimes_r
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
};
|
||||
|
||||
void USBGeckoOutput()
|
||||
|
@ -15,8 +15,8 @@
|
||||
#include <ogcsys.h>
|
||||
#include <unistd.h>
|
||||
#include <wiiuse/wpad.h>
|
||||
#include "libs/libdrc/wiidrc.h"
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libs/libdrc/wiidrc.h"
|
||||
#include "menu.h"
|
||||
#include "video.h"
|
||||
#include "input.h"
|
||||
|
@ -43,7 +43,7 @@ int DownloadAllLanguageFiles(int revision)
|
||||
URL_List LinkList(LanguagesURL);
|
||||
int listsize = LinkList.GetURLCount();
|
||||
int files_downloaded = 0;
|
||||
char target[6];
|
||||
char target[11];
|
||||
if(revision > 0)
|
||||
snprintf(target, sizeof(target), "%d", revision);
|
||||
else
|
||||
|
@ -231,7 +231,7 @@ bool gettextLoadLanguage(const char* langFile)
|
||||
fclose(f);
|
||||
return true;
|
||||
}
|
||||
const char *gettext(const char *msgid)
|
||||
const char *get_text(const char *msgid)
|
||||
{
|
||||
if(!msgid[0]) return NULL;
|
||||
MSG *msg = findMSG(hash_string(msgid));
|
||||
|
@ -12,8 +12,8 @@ extern "C"
|
||||
* input msg = a text in ASCII
|
||||
* output = the translated msg in utf-8
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *gettext(const char *msg);
|
||||
#define tr(s) gettext(s)
|
||||
const char *get_text(const char *msg);
|
||||
#define tr(s) get_text(s)
|
||||
#define trNOOP(s) (s)
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
|
Binary file not shown.
106
source/libs/libext2fs/ext2.h
Normal file
106
source/libs/libext2fs/ext2.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,106 @@
|
||||
/********************************************************************************
|
||||
* ext2.h - devoptab file routines for EXT2/3/4-based devices. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* Copyright (c) 2010 Dimok *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* This program/include file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or *
|
||||
* modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published *
|
||||
* by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or *
|
||||
* (at your option) any later version. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* This program/include file is distributed in the hope that it will be *
|
||||
* useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty *
|
||||
* of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the *
|
||||
* GNU General Public License for more details. *
|
||||
* *
|
||||
* You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License *
|
||||
* along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, *
|
||||
* Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA *
|
||||
********************************************************************************/
|
||||
#ifndef __EXT2_H_
|
||||
#define __EXT2_H_
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <gctypes.h>
|
||||
#include <gccore.h>
|
||||
#include <ogc/disc_io.h>
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* EXT2 cache options
|
||||
*
|
||||
* It is recommended to use more pages instead of large page sizes for cache due to the sporadic write behaviour of ext file system.
|
||||
* It will significantly increase the speed. A page size of 32 is mostly suffiecient. The larger the page count the faster the
|
||||
* read/write between smaller files will be. Larger page sizes result in faster read/write of single big files.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
#define EXT2_CACHE_DEFAULT_PAGE_COUNT 64 /* The default number of pages in the cache */
|
||||
#define EXT2_CACHE_DEFAULT_PAGE_SIZE 32 /* The default number of sectors per cache page */
|
||||
|
||||
/* EXT2 mount flags */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_RW 0x00001 /* Open the filesystem for reading and writing. Without this flag, the filesystem is opened for reading only. */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_FORCE 0x00400 /* Open the filesystem regardless of the feature sets listed in the superblock */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_JOURNAL_DEV_OK 0x01000 /* Only open external journal devices if this flag is set (e.g. ext3/ext4) */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_64BITS 0x20000 /* Use the new style 64-Bit bitmaps. For more information see gen_bitmap64.c */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_PRINT_PROGRESS 0x40000 /* If this flag is set the progress of file operations will be printed to stdout */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_SKIP_MMP 0x100000 /* Open without multi-mount protection check. */
|
||||
#define EXT2_FLAG_DEFAULT (EXT2_FLAG_RW | EXT2_FLAG_64BITS | EXT2_FLAG_JOURNAL_DEV_OK | EXT2_FLAG_SKIP_MMP)
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Find all EXT2/3/4 partitions on a block device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param INTERFACE The block device to search
|
||||
* @param PARTITIONS (out) A pointer to receive the array of partition start sectors
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The number of entries in PARTITIONS or -1 if an error occurred (see errno)
|
||||
* @note The caller is responsible for freeing PARTITIONS when finished with it
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int ext2FindPartitions(const DISC_INTERFACE *interface, sec_t **partitions);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Mount a EXT2/3/4 partition from a specific sector on a block device.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param NAME The name to mount the device under (can then be accessed as "NAME:/")
|
||||
* @param INTERFACE The block device to mount
|
||||
* @param STARTSECTOR The sector the partition begins at
|
||||
* @param CACHEPAGECOUNT The total number of pages in the device cache
|
||||
* @param CACHEPAGESIZE The number of sectors per cache page
|
||||
* @param FLAGS Additional mounting flags (see above)
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return True if mount was successful, false if no partition was found or an error occurred (see errno)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool ext2Mount(const char *name, const DISC_INTERFACE *interface, sec_t startSector, u32 cachePageCount, u32 cachePageSize, u32 flags);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Unmount a EXT2/3/4 partition.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param NAME The name of mount used in ext2Mount()
|
||||
*/
|
||||
void ext2Unmount(const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Get the volume name of a mounted EXT2/3/4 partition.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param NAME The name of mount
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return The volumes name if successful or NULL if an error occurred (see errno)
|
||||
*/
|
||||
const char *ext2GetVolumeName (const char *name);
|
||||
|
||||
/**
|
||||
* Set the volume name of a mounted EXT2/3/4 partition.
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @param NAME The name of mount
|
||||
* @param VOLUMENAME The new volume name
|
||||
*
|
||||
* @return True if mount was successful, false if an error occurred (see errno)
|
||||
* @note The mount must be write-enabled else this will fail
|
||||
*/
|
||||
bool ext2SetVolumeName (const char *name, const char *volumeName);
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif
|
122
source/libs/libfat/fat.h
Normal file
122
source/libs/libfat/fat.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,122 @@
|
||||
/*
|
||||
fat.h
|
||||
Simple functionality for startup, mounting and unmounting of FAT-based devices.
|
||||
|
||||
Copyright (c) 2006 - 2012
|
||||
Michael "Chishm" Chisholm
|
||||
Dave "WinterMute" Murphy
|
||||
|
||||
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification,
|
||||
are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
|
||||
|
||||
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,
|
||||
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
|
||||
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,
|
||||
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or
|
||||
other materials provided with the distribution.
|
||||
3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote products derived
|
||||
from this software without specific prior written permission.
|
||||
|
||||
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED
|
||||
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
|
||||
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE
|
||||
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
|
||||
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
|
||||
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY
|
||||
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
|
||||
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
|
||||
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
|
||||
|
||||
#ifndef _LIBFAT_H
|
||||
#define _LIBFAT_H
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
extern "C" {
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include "libfatversion.h"
|
||||
|
||||
// When compiling for NDS, make sure NDS is defined
|
||||
#ifndef NDS
|
||||
#if defined ARM9 || defined ARM7
|
||||
#define NDS
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#include <stdint.h>
|
||||
|
||||
#if defined(__gamecube__) || defined (__wii__)
|
||||
# include <ogc/disc_io.h>
|
||||
#else
|
||||
# ifdef NDS
|
||||
# include <nds/disc_io.h>
|
||||
# else
|
||||
# include <disc_io.h>
|
||||
# endif
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Initialise any inserted block-devices.
|
||||
Add the fat device driver to the devoptab, making it available for standard file functions.
|
||||
cacheSize: The number of pages to allocate for each inserted block-device
|
||||
setAsDefaultDevice: if true, make this the default device driver for file operations
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern bool fatInit (uint32_t cacheSize, bool setAsDefaultDevice);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Calls fatInit with setAsDefaultDevice = true and cacheSize optimised for the host system.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern bool fatInitDefault (void);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Mount the device pointed to by interface, and set up a devoptab entry for it as "name:".
|
||||
You can then access the filesystem using "name:/".
|
||||
This will mount the active partition or the first valid partition on the disc,
|
||||
and will use a cache size optimized for the host system.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern bool fatMountSimple (const char* name, const DISC_INTERFACE* interface);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Mount the device pointed to by interface, and set up a devoptab entry for it as "name:".
|
||||
You can then access the filesystem using "name:/".
|
||||
If startSector = 0, it will mount the active partition of the first valid partition on
|
||||
the disc. Otherwise it will try to mount the partition starting at startSector.
|
||||
cacheSize specifies the number of pages to allocate for the cache.
|
||||
This will not startup the disc, so you need to call interface->startup(); first.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern bool fatMount (const char* name, const DISC_INTERFACE* interface, sec_t startSector, uint32_t cacheSize, uint32_t SectorsPerPage);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Unmount the partition specified by name.
|
||||
If there are open files, it will attempt to synchronise them to disc.
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern void fatUnmount (const char* name);
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Get Volume Label
|
||||
*/
|
||||
extern void fatGetVolumeLabel (const char* name, char *label);
|
||||
|
||||
// File attributes
|
||||
#define ATTR_ARCHIVE 0x20 // Archive
|
||||
#define ATTR_DIRECTORY 0x10 // Directory
|
||||
#define ATTR_VOLUME 0x08 // Volume
|
||||
#define ATTR_SYSTEM 0x04 // System
|
||||
#define ATTR_HIDDEN 0x02 // Hidden
|
||||
#define ATTR_READONLY 0x01 // Read only
|
||||
|
||||
/*
|
||||
Methods to modify DOS File Attributes
|
||||
*/
|
||||
int FAT_getAttr(const char *file);
|
||||
int FAT_setAttr(const char *file, uint8_t attr );
|
||||
|
||||
#define LIBFAT_FEOS_MULTICWD
|
||||
|
||||
#ifdef __cplusplus
|
||||
}
|
||||
#endif
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // _LIBFAT_H
|
Binary file not shown.
10
source/libs/libfat/libfatversion.h
Normal file
10
source/libs/libfat/libfatversion.h
Normal file
@ -0,0 +1,10 @@
|
||||
#ifndef __LIBFATVERSION_H__
|
||||
#define __LIBFATVERSION_H__
|
||||
|
||||
#define _LIBFAT_MAJOR_ 1
|
||||
#define _LIBFAT_MINOR_ 1
|
||||
#define _LIBFAT_PATCH_ 5
|
||||
|
||||
#define _LIBFAT_STRING "libFAT Release 1.1.5"
|
||||
|
||||
#endif // __LIBFATVERSION_H__
|
Some files were not shown because too many files have changed in this diff Show More
Loading…
Reference in New Issue
Block a user